Home
        Avaya IP Office User and Administration CD Set 4.2
         Contents
1.      4601 Telephone       Works on  Communication    Manager    5601     w Re Go p E     Note the 5601 is no longer sold by Avaya but is supported on IP Office Release 4 2        Common Features     Display  None     Fixed Feature Buttons  8   Conference  Transfer  Drop  Redial  Messages  Hold  Volume Up  Volume  Down     Programmable Feature Buttons  2 with single color indicator lamps    Key Labels  Icons used on fixed feature keys  None on programmable feature keys   Speakerphone  No    Hearing Aid Compatible  Yes    Message Waiting Indicator  Yes    Personalized Ring Patterns  No    Headset Socket  No  this phone does not support headset operation    Embedded Applications  None    Upgradeable Firmware  Yes    Expansion  None    Color  Multi gray    Power Supply  IEEE 802 11af Power over Ethernet  PoE  or individual Avaya power supply unit  1151    Connect to  LAN using H 323 VoIP    Mounting  Desk or wall mountable    Adjustable Desk Stand  No    Codecs  G 711  G 729a b    QoS Options  UDP Port Selection  DiffServ and 802 1p B  VLAN    SNMP Support  Yes    IP Address Assignment  Dynamic IP address assignment only    Ethernet Ports  Single 10 100 BaseT Ethernet port        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 55    IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        5402  5602 SW  2402  4602 SW Telephone          Works on IP Office Works on IP Office and    Communication Manager    soz KK        Early 2402 telephones can make and receive call but the d
2.      The 3641 supports the following features     Slim lightweight design with large display    Backlight display with Icons    Simple to use with improved user interface    Navigation and soft keys for simple access to frequently used operations   Office quality speakerphone for handsfree operation    802 11a b g standard compatible    Radio Frequency 2 4000 GHz  b g  or 5 8 GHz  a     FCC certification Part 15 247    Management of telephones via DHCP and TFTP    Voice encoding G711  G 729a    Wired Equivalent Privacy  WEP   40bit and 128 bit and 802 11i  PSK  for secure communication   Lithium Ion Battery pack with up to 8 hours talk time and 160 hours standby   IP 53 Design  Liquid dust protection     MIL 810F Design  Shock protection      Clips  cases  lanyard        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 78    IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        3645 Ruggedized Wireless Telephone    The Avaya 3645 Wireless Telephone is a WiFi standard  802 11a b g  telephone that runs using H 323        The 3645 supports all of the features of 3641 with the following additions   e Push to talk  PTT  functionality for workgroup communication  e Enlarged earpiece for operation in noisy environments    e Rubberized grips for improved ergonomics and durability       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 79  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        3701 IP DECT    This handset is supported on the Avaya IP DECT system only  This ha
3.      e DS Phones  24   arranged in 3 switchable display pages of 8 matching the 8 physical display  buttons     e IP Phones  24   arranged in 2 switchable display pages of 12 matching the 12 physical display  buttons     Key Labels  Icons used on fixed feature keys    Speakerphone  Two way handsfree speaker and microphone    Hearing Aid Compatible  Yes    Message Waiting Indicator  Yes   also used as ringing call alert indicator   Personalized Ring Patterns  Yes   8    Headset Socket  Yes     Embedded Applications  Speed Dial List  104  and Call Log  Missed  Incoming  Outgoing   Also WAP  WML browser supported on IP phone models     Upgradeable Firmware  Yes    Expansion  Supports the EU24 DSS expansion module  with additional Avaya 1151 power supply    Color  Multi gray    Mounting  Desk or wall mountable     Adjustable Desk Stand  Yes   Supplied with phone        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 60    IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Special Features for the 5420 and 2420     e Messages Button  Dedicated button to collect voicemail     Requirements for 5420 and 2420   e Connect to  Digital Station  DS  port     e Power Supply  From phone system     Requirements for 5621 SW  4621 SW  4625 SW     e Power Supply  IEEE 802 3af Power over Ethernet  PoE  or individual power supply unit  Avaya 1151  series      e Codecs  G 711  G 729a b    e QoS Options  UDP Port Selection  DiffServ and 802 1p q  VLAN    e SNMP Support  Yes    e IP Address 
4.     Index       Conferencing Center Web Scheduler 233  Conferencing Center Web Scheduler offers 233  conferencing service 6   Conferencing tone 101   Conferencing tone depending 101  congestion control 138   Connected Line Identification Restriction 143  connection oriented 150   Contact Activity 254    Contact Center 20  24  32  46  97  123  177  210   216  252  253  254  258    Contact Center Features 123   Contact Center Summary 254   Contact Management 20  177  252  Contact ability 212   contactable 68   ContactStore 22  25  201  217  218  224  ContactStore Search 201   Continuous Loop Greeting 220   Control Unit Conference Capabilities 231  controlled according 218   controlling calls 115   copier scanner 206    CoS 137   Country Availability 277  CPE 166   CPU 218   CPU loading 218  CRC 143   Create    214    CreateCall 282  CRM 32  206  254  CRM application    Small 254  Crystal 252  types 254    Crystal Design 254  Crystal Reports 252  purchase 254  Crystal Reports products 254  Crystal Reports Training 254  Crystal Training  World Wide Source 254  Crystal Business Objects 254  CS ACELP 138  CSU 30  34  143  266  CSU Loop Back 266  CSU DSU 30  34  143  CSV 252  254  CTI 20  25  106  194  195  196  232  CTI interoperability  levels 194  CTI Link Lite 194  CTI Link Pro 25  194  195  CTI Link Pro RFA 195    CTI middleware 194    CTR3   ETSI T Bus Interface 290  CTR4   ETSI T Bus Interface 290  CU 254  258  cust 105    Custom Reporting 252  254  Customer Contact 242  Cust
5.     lt  lt  lt   lt  lt  RE  lt  lt  z     00l o 0 o oO  nn NnNIWn Wn wn   lt  lt  lt   lt  lt   lt    O D   D   D   D oO oO  nn nn Wn wn wn    z  lt  Z   lt    lt   oO oO oO o  wn un un in  z AAIE  oO oO oO o  wn wn nw      lt   oO  7      oO    o sixa oo TETE RTE  x 3 0 00 M mm o 0 mMm mm omo m mooom moog   D oO   D D LD oO   D LD  DO onu JH Jo po wn Un EU EU EU EU EU EU EU TW IN In wn nn wn nn wn    2   2  a  o        a    nternal only    User Definable PIN Code  Known Caller ID PIN Code By Pass    Breakout to Reception Internal and    external     Internal only    Repeat Message      les Yes  Remote Access to Mail Box    ZZ  lo  un wn  ZZ  0 LD   D  nu nn       1  Intuity mode only   2  Remote access can be provided via the embedded Auto Attendant on the Small Office Edition     3  Not on Small Office Edition        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 221  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     In Queue Announcements    Embedded  VoiceMail  VoiceMail  Voicemail  Lite Pro    Queue Entry Announcement    Queue Update Announcement Yes Yes Yes  Queue Position Announcement No No Yes  Time in Queue Announcement No No Yes  Time in System Announcement No No Yes  Estimated Time to Answer  ETA  No No Yes  Exit Queue to alternative answer point No No Yes    Auto Attendant  Audiotex    Embedded VoiceMail  VoiceMail  Voicemail Lite Pro    Multi Level Tree Structure    Message Announcements No No Yes  Whisper Announce No No Yes  Alarm Calls No No Yes  Assist
6.    165  Unshielded Twisted Pair 287  Unstructured Private Circuit 150  Upgrade License 25  231  upgradeable 55  56  58  60  64  65  66  72  Upgradeable Firmware 55  56  58  60  64  65  66  Upgrade Kit    69  upgrade license 69  Upn 63  98  287  UPS 133  287  URL 233  US T1 PRI 273  USA 277  290  USA Interfaces 290  USB 169  180  use depending 30  Use mailing 220  user according  type 191  user acquiring  call 123  User Agents 71  User CD Rom 195  user chooses 198  user collecting 164  User Datagram Protocol  Simple Traversal 291  user determines 113  user ensuring 98  user executing 123  User Interface 20  78  129  198  201  user interface offering 129  user making 117  user name 10  185  284  User Recording 217       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 340  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       user restricting 169  USER RIGHT 262    User Rights 115  177  262  Using Text To Speech 20  211  UTP 287     V     V 24 165  273  290   V 24 Interface  19 2Kbps 290   V 24 V 28 290   V 24 V 35 X 21 273   V 32 30  164   V 35 150  162  165  273  290   V 90 21  32  36  164  273   V 90 56Kbps 164   V110 291   V120 291   V24 165   V24 V35 X21 273   V35 165   V5 0 218   v90 19   VAC 133   Variable Routing    10   VB 22 201  211   VB Scripts 22 201  211   VC 273   VCM 18  25  27  32  36  63  69  109  135  137    147  150  153  220  266  269  278  279   VCN 233   Virtual 84  129  150  166  229  Voicemail 220   Virtual Office 84   Visual Basic 2
7.    22 May 2009     Index       Power Supply 55  56  58  60  62  64  65  66  88   133  273  287  Power Supply Units 55  88  287  Powered Data Unit 133  Powered LAN 46  PowerPoint   reviewing 238  PPP 138  162  166  170  291  PPP Fragmentation 138  PPP MP 291  PPP Multilink Protocol 291  PR 143  Pre licensed IP DECT 10  PRI 10  18  19  25  27  30  32  34  141  143  278   279  290  PRI30E1 27  PRI 30 E1R2 RJ45 27  PRI 48 T1 278  279  PRI 60 E1 278  279  PRIE 290  PRI ISDN Services 290  PRI ISDN Switch 290  PRI T1 19  27  279  290  PRI T1 Service 290  PRIT1 J1 290  prices   Avaya 6  Primary Rate ISDN 143  Primary Rate Trunks 30  34  143  prioritization 72  Priority 6  56  58  60  72  120  126  129  215  283  Priority Call 120  126  Priority Processors 72  Privacy Mechanism   Session Initiation Protocol 291    Private 6  30  34  108  114  126  129  141  142   150  155  162  168  214  215  238  273    Private Call 108  126  Private Call Off 126  Private CallOn 126  Private Circuit Switched 142  Private Circuit Switched Voice Networking 142  Private Networking 155  Private Voice Networks 30  34  141  Pro 10  20  94  203  224  232  259  upgrades 22  Pro provides 20  Product 6  10  34  71  84  85  91  123  126  155   182  191  194  195  196  206  224  239  254  273  receiving 6  time during 22  product configuration documents 126    Product Configurations 126  273  Product Description 34  123  239  Operating System 182  191  224    Product Documentation 71  Professional Edition 10  22
8.    ECT is supported on the SO interface  A Call to an SO Endpoint can be transferred to any other device  such as an analog  digital or IP endpoint or to any trunk  The normal usage of this feature is by a third  party application connected via one or more SO interfaces to IP Office  One example is the  VoiceDirector  an automatic call assistant        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 144  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     North American T1  Provided by the IP400 PRI T1 and IP500 Universal PRI cards     Ti Primary Rate provides up to 24 64K channels over a 1 54M circuit  Each channel of the T1 trunk can be  independently configured  channelized  to support the following signaling emulations with handshake types of  immediate  delay or wink     e Loop Start   e Ground Start   e E amp M Tie Line   e E amp M DID   e E amp M Switched 56K    e DID   Channels configured for DID DDI support incoming calls only  The carrier or Central Office will  provide the last x digits that were dialed to be used for call routing     e Wink Start    IP Office T1 trunks support both DNIS and ANI services  where available from the central office     e Dialed Number Identification String  DNIS  Provides a string of digits to the IP Office depending on the  number dialed by the incoming caller  This string can then be used to route callers to individual  extensions  groups or services     e Automatic Number Identification  ANI  Provides IP Office with a number ide
9.    PO TRIAL CONF CENTER RFA LIC DS  189780     e   IP End Points  IPO TRIAL 3RD PRTY TTS RFA LIC CU  189781     e   Voicemail Pro  4 Ports   IPO TRIAL VM PRO RFA LIC DS  189782     e   SoftConsole  Users   IPO TRIAL SOFTCONSOLE BLF RFA LIC CU  189783     e   Phone Manager Pro IP Audio Enabled  IPO TRIAL IPPRO RFA 10 LIC CU  189784    e   Phone Manager Pro  IPO TRIAL PMGR PRO RFA 10 LIC CU  189785     e   Audix Voicemail  IPO TRIAL ACM CENTRAL VM LIC DS  189786     e   Integrated Messaging  IPO TRIAL INTG MSGING PRO RFA LIC DS  189787     e   IPSec Tunneling  IPO TRIAL IPSec VPN RFA LIC DS  189806     e   Mobility Features   PO LIC MOBILE TWINNING TRIAL RFA 5  195574     e   SIP Trunk Channels  JPO LIC SIP TRUNKING TRIAL RFA 1  205820     e   Advanced Small Community Networking  IPO LIC ADVANCED NTWKG TRIAL  205821      e   IP500 Upgrade Standard to Professional Trial   PO LIC IP500 STD UPG TO PRO TRIAL   205822      e   IP500 Voice Networking  IPO LIC IP500 VCE NTWK START 4 TRIAL  205823    e   VPN IP Extension  IPO LIC VPN PHONE 10 TRIAL  213987    e  UMS Web Services  IPO TRIAL UMS 10 USER  217890         Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 302  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Compact Contact Center  CCC   The following licenses are applicable to use of the current IP Office call center applications  Both applications  use data relayed by the IP Office Delta Server application     e   Compact Contact Center  CCC  License  IPO LIC IP400 CC
10.    Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 136    IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        What is the Maximum Number of Simultaneous VoIP Calls    Each IP Office can be fitted with an optional Voice Compression Module  VCM  to support VoIP connections   e The IP406 can be fitted with a single module offering up to 30 simultaneous calls   e The IP412 is capable of supporting two modules of all types  allowing up to 60 simultaneous calls     e The IP500 is capable of supporting two VCM 32 64 modules allowing up to 128 simultaneous calls        Does the IP Office support Fax over IP      The IP Office has a proprietary method for carrying Fax traffic on a VoIP call  IP Office does not currently  support the T 38 Fax standard  IP Office supports Fax speeds up to 14 4 Kbps  The bandwidth requirements  for a Fax call will initially be as per the specified or negotiated compression method and then the bandwidth  requirement will change to accommodate the Fax data  The Fax bandwidth will vary depending on the speed  with which the Fax devices are communicating and the type of link  at 14 4 Kbps the bandwidth requirement  will be approximately 27 Kbps on the LAN or 19 Kbps on a Point to Point WAN link with header compression  enabled        Network Assessment    With IP Office  optimum network configurations can support VoIP with a perceived voice quality equivalent to  that of the Public Switched Telephone Network  PSTN   However  not every network is able 
11.    Requirements for IP interface     e Power Supply  IEEE 802 3af Power over Ethernet  PoE  class 2 device or optional wall plug local power  supply     e Codecs audio  G 711  G 729a b  Dynamic Jitter buffer  Echo cancellation  Comfort Noise  Automatic Gain  control     e QoS Options  UDP Port Selection  DiffServ and 802 1p q  VLAN    e SNMP Support  Yes   e IP Address Assignment  Static or dynamic IP address assignment     e Ethernet Ports  Ethernet  10 100  line interface with a secondary 10 100 port for collocated laptop or PC  with VLAN separation     o Well suited for everyday use  where typically smaller sized data files transferred  web  email file  attachments  or less demanding data transfer application usage   thus less sensitive to data transfer  completion times      o For highly demanding data traffic processing with large amounts of small packets we recommend the  1616 phone     o Support of optional Gigabit Ethernet Adapter     Language Support     e Supports the following languages  English  French  Spanish  German  Italian  Dutch  Portuguese and Russian   English and 4 of the other languages at once in the phone        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 51  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     1616 IP Telephone    LL  CONTACTS    t    omi LOG    Communication  Manager     1616 i x  HE do            The Avaya 1616 supports 16 line appearances feature keys on the phone itself   and 1 x 32 button expansion  modules  providing acce
12.    Small license and  resources Office Edition  platform  IP406 V2 and  IP Office    IP412 Small Office  Edition 10   IP406 V2  20   IP412 30   IP500   30    Recording Time IP Office 50 and IP406 V2  15 hours  PC dependent PC dependent  IP Office   Small Office Edition  10 hours   Requires 1MB  Requires 1MB  per minute  per minute   Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 220    IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Features    Embedded VoiceMail VoiceMail  Voicemail Lite Pro    Runs as a Service  No Nes    Group Broadcast  No Nes    Centralized Voicemail Services  No Nes      Voicemail Ringback Internal only Internal only  Internal and  external    Voicemail Help TUI Noes es o  Message Waiting Indication    Visual Voice  interactive menu on phone display   ntegration with Phone Manager Pro  ersonalized Greeting  xtended personal Greetings   Continuous Loop Greeting  orward to Email   Copy to Email  isten To Email  Text To Speech   end Email notification   Unified Messaging Service  UMS   ave Message   Delete Message  orward Message to another Mailbox  orward to Multiple Mailboxes  orward with a Header Message   Repeat Message   Rewind Message  ast Forward Message  ause Message  kip Message  IFO FIFO Message Playback Option  et Message Priority  et automatic message deletion timeframe   Alphanumeric Data Collection   Callers Caller ID  time and date announced   Call Back Sender  if Caller ID available      lt   M  7     oO oO  La  La      lt   M  7  
13.    e Control Unit Audit   details the last 15 accesses from Manager  e Feature Key and License Status  e Directory  including Users on the SCN  e Real time Voicemail port status  e Voicemail Summary Detail information  e Real time Mailbox status  e IP Route and Service status    e Tunnel Status    The new option    IP Phone Forced Re Registration    within SSA permits the remote re registration of individual  or groups of Avaya IP telephones for firmware upgrade and maintenance purposes        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 12  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Manager Enhancements  All Multi Line Options are now grouped together under a new tab under User Telephony     Manager now displays the system default values for No Answer Time and Ring Delay   DSS Status and Beep on Listen have been moved to the System Telephony Tab     The Conferencing Tone checkbox has been replaced with two options     Entry and Exit tones    and    Repeating  Tone    are now found in the new Tones and Music options section under System Telephony     IP Office 4 2 Manager can now limit the number of BAK files to keep   under Manager Preferences     Embedded Voicemail Enhancements    Voicemail to Email  IP500 and IP406 V2 only   IP Office 4 2 supports the ability to send an email containing either notification or the complete voicemail  message from the Embedded Voicemail when using IP406 V2 and IP500 units only     Cantonese Voicemail Prompts  IP500 and IP406 
14.   1  i Q Remote  Telecommuter Mode       Home v      Remote Profile Name Home      Contact Number 9416      Continuous Mode      Save Profile          aoe          Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 177  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     e Integration with Contact Management packages  To facilitate screen popping of the contact details of an incoming caller  dialing from the contact record  with a simple mouse click and simple creation of new contact records with auto insertion of the  telephone number while on a call  The user can select which Contact Management should be popped     e Outlook  e GoldMine    e ACT    ACT  7 0 and higher requires the TAPI NET add on from various providers plus the IP  Office TAPI driver from Avaya      e Maximizer   e VoiceMail Pro mailbox control    e Manage voicemails  Phone Manager Pro allows users to play  rewind  fast forward  save or delete their voice messages     e Manage Personal Distribution Lists  Phone Manager Pro allows users to configure their Personal Distribution Lists  VoiceMail Pro Intuity  mode only      e Manage voicemail greetings  Users can record and select which of the personal greetings is active  VoiceMail Pro Intuity mode  only      e Personal Directory  Personal phone number directory which allows further personalization and improves productivity     e Name matching  If the Caller ID is recognized in the local PC directory  the caller   s name can be displayed  Up to 1000  entries 
15.   231  254  278    Standard Edition 25   upgrade 25  prompting   PIN 198   Voicemail Pro 209  Protocol Applicability Statement 291  protocol passing 168    Protocols 30  34  69  72  129  131  132  135  138   150  155  166  168  169  206  265  291    protocols including 168  Proxy Address Resolution Protocol 168  PSK 78  PSTN 112  135  137  IP Office connects 129  SCN 115  158  PSU 287  PTT 79  Public 6  10  19  30  34  84  103  114  115  122   129  131  137  141  143  150  165  168  170  201   214  238  291    Public Network 114  115  131  150  Public Switched 137  network called 129  Public Switched Telephone Network 137  called 129  Public Voice Networking 143  Pulse 41  109  125  143  Pulsed High Voltage 41  Push 94  push to talk    72  Put_EventFilter 282  PVCs 150  166   Q   Q 931 138  143  150  152  Q 931 signaling 143  Q2 2007 Maintenance Release 10  Q3 2007 Maintenance Release 10    QoS 18  55  56  58  60  64  65  66  72  135  137   150  182  269    QoS Options 55  56  58  60  64  65  66  QoS Class   Service 137  QSIG 18  112  143  153  155   following 142   limit 25   running 219    terminates 142  QSIG Networking 18  QSIG provides   level 142  QSIG signaling 142  Quad Chargers   3641 72  Quality Assurance 109  Questions  amp  Voting 238       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 335  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       Queue Announcements 10  198  201  220  Queue Based Screens 253  Queue Entry Announcement 220  Queue
16.   91  102  135  273  290  Menu Bar 185  MERLIN MAGIX 46  85  Message Announcements 220  message archiving 224  message handling   individuals 201  message informing 259  Message light 90  message recording 224  Message Storage Capacity 198  message taking 259  Message Waiting 22  64  65  66  82  91  103  142   214  219  Message Waiting Indication 41  91  103  155  220  Message Waiting Indicator 55  56  58  60  85  message waitinglamps 103  Message Waiting Light 90  155  Messages Button 58  60  messages consume 224  Messaging Card 21  266  Microsoft application 167  Microsoft CRM 254  Microsoft CRM Sales Reports 254    Microsoft Live 174  181  182   Mid Span Power 133   Middle East 277   Mid Span 133   Mid Span Power Distribution Units 133  Miercom 6   milli seconds 136   ML PPP 166  291   MM 262   mm inches 287   Mobile Twinned Call Pickup 126   Mobile Twinning 22  25  126  212   mobile cell 110  116  174  198  201  203  215  Mobile Cell Phone 110  116  174  198  201  203  Mobility 10  68  69  71  72  82  100  108  180  Mobility Solutions 68   Modify 214   Modify    existing lists 214   Modular 21  24  198  219  252   Modular Messaging 219   Modular Messaging Voicemail 198    Monitor 10  30  34  108  119  123  143  177  181   190  195  196  217  218  231  252  253  258  261   265  266  269    Monitor Calls 123  252  Monitoring   Call Center View 252  month day 267  Most Avaya 118  Most Common Destination  Outgoing 254  mounting desk 85  86  MP 291  MPPC 291  MS CRM 254  MSDE 
17.   Direct Sequence Spread Spectrum 75  Direct Station Select 40  42  118  174  Direct Station Select icon 174  Directory 6  19  85  91  101  118  119  141  169   177  185  190  283  Directory Entry 119  185  Directory List 119  Directory Panel 185  Directory csv 262  Disable ARS Form 126  Disable Internal Forward Busy 126  Disable Internal Forward Unconditional 126  Disable Internal Forwards 126  Disable Speakerphone    10  discover  NAT 147  Disk Space 218  224  254  Display Backlight 60  76  Display Msg 126  Display Navigation Keys 86  87  Display Soft Keys 86  87  Distinctive 103 177  181  Distinctive Ringing 103  177  181  distinguish  doorphone 94  distribute 121 153  177  195  206  258  voicemail 214  Distributed Hunt Groups 121  153       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 324    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       Disturb 105  196  DMS100 143  DMS 100 290  DMS 250 290  DMZ 147  DND 107  116  bypass 107  DNIS 143  218  DNS 165  167    Do Not Disturb  196  283    Do Not Disturb Exception Add 126  Do Not Disturb Exception Delete 126  Do Not Disturb Off 126  Do Not Disturb On 126  Domain 165  167  224  238  Domain Name Service 165  167  Door Entry 25  32  94  109  125  177  190  doorphone  distinguish 94  doorphone calls 94  Doorphone Entry 94  Doorphones 94  DS 21  27  40  42  46  56  58  60  64  65  66  82   287  291  DS 16 Module 287  DS 30 Module 287    105  107  110  116  118  126  174     DS Field 291   DS Phones 56  5
18.   HUNT GROUP NAME 262  Hunt Group Recording 217  HuntGroup csv 262  Hybrid    PBX 129  Hz 133   I   155 155  Iceland 277  ICLID 143  Illuminated 3 line 80  Illuminated 5 line 81  IM 181   send 174  Immediate Reboot 262  Improved IP DECT Licensing 10  IMS 224  IMS Pro Connection 224  IMSAdmin 224  Inbound Call Handling 120    Incoming Call 10  106  119  120  143  167  174   177  181  185  198  201  217    Incoming Call Routes 10  106  120  198  201  217  incoming call scripting 177  181  IND CP CCM WALLBRD 258  IND DISP CCM WALLBRD 22 GB 258  India 277  indicating   Talk 82  Individual Agent Details 253  Individual DDI DID Details 253  Individual Group Details 253  Individual Trunk Details 253  individual team 254  industry standard 155  Information Bulletin Boards 210  Information Protocol   Routing 169  291  Information within Call Flows 210  Inhibits   COLP 143  Inline Power 10 100 BaseT Switching Module 133  input rating       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 328  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       input rating  power 287  In Queue Announcements 220  Insert 101  210  218  Installation Guide 71  82  Instant Messaging 174  182  INT 273  Integral 10 100 Mbit Layer 165  Integral Static 19  IntegralT3 46  Integral T3 IP 46  integrated conferencing 233  Integrated H 323 Gatekeeper 18  Integrated Management Suite 266  Integrated Messaging 20  220  Integrated Messaging Pro 20  22  224  Intelligent 6  120  Interaction 6 210  21
19.   It responds to business needs that every company faces     e More meetings but less time available   e Increasing pressure to be at two locations at once     e Travel restrictions     As a result of using conferencing  the benefits gained are   e Reduction in travel  leading to lower costs and less wasted time   e Increased worker productivity and personal security     e More effective working practices  leading to shorter project times  and supporting dispersed  organizations and complex supply chains     Furthermore  the Return On Investment  ROI  is very short as Meet Me conferencing is a built in feature of IP  Office  The typical ROI of just 4 to 6 months compared to Service Provider conferencing services based upon 2  hourly conferences with 5 participants per week        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 229  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        IP Office Meet Me Conferencing Solution       The conferencing solution built in to IP Office enables multiple callers to talk in an audio conference  Callers  can be on site personnel as well as external parties whether field based engineers  sales staff on the road   customers or suppliers  Conference calls can be planned in advance or established ad hoc as and when  required              Purchasing     Manager  Please ente London Office ag  1 your PIN code y N        Zz  VoiceMail Pro      New vor We  ofice e ee  _           1    Supplier    Mobile  Worker       Wr  Home Worker    IP Off
20.   VoIP is often referred to as IP Telephony because it uses the IP  protocols to make possible enhanced voice communications throughout the world  wherever IP connections  have been delivered  IP Telephony unites a company   s many locations   including mobile workers    into a  single converged communications network  Telephony calls using VoIP go above and beyond what s been  possible in the past  When it comes to placing telephone calls  VoIP provides a range of support services and  features unequalled in the world of telephony  but above all deliver them at low cost     How Does VoIP Work     Voice over Internet Protocol means basically what the acronym states  Voice travels over an Internet Protocol   Internet Protocol refers to the type of rules that the network uses to send and receive signals  IP Telephony  works by converting voice communications into data packets  Conveniently  it runs on the popular Ethernet  LAN  local area network  technology  which currently supports over 96 percent of the worlds companies    LANs     Circuit switched or Time Division Multiplexed Telephony    Before digital networking with the Internet took off  everyone had to use the    Plain Old Telephone   Services     POTS   These run over a network called the Public Switched Telephone Network  PSTN   The PSTN  has been around since the telephone was invented in either analog or digital form using circuit switched  technology where the telephone call gets exclusive bi directional use of a 
21.   e   50 Additional PC Wallboards  IPO LIC IP400 CCC PCW RFA 50 LIC CU  174474     e   CCC Wallboard License   4 Wallboards  IPO LIC IP400 CCC WALLBRD 4 RFA LIC CU  176196    Enables 4 physical wallboard devices to connect to the CCC Wallboard server  Multiple license can  be combined to enable up to a maximum of 16 physical wallboards     e CCC Reporter Licenses   The CCC Reporter application can be used to run historical reports  The number of CCC Reporter  licenses control how may users can simultaneous access the CCC Reporter  These users do not need  CCC supervisor or agent licenses  Multiple licenses can be combined for the number of simultaneous  users required    e   5 Additional Reporter Licenses  IPO LIC CCC RPT RFA 5 LIC CU  184726    e   10 Additional Reporter Licenses   PO LIC CCC RPT RFA 10 LIC CU  184727    e    20 Additional Reporter Licenses  IPO LIC CCC RPT RFA 20 LIC CU  184728     e CCC Report Designer License   PO LIC IP400 CCC DESIGNER RFA LIC CU  171999   Allows custom reports to be created from CCC data  Those reports are then available to users of  the CCC Reporter        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 303  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Orderable License Sets   The following section lists the core licenses available for IP Office  Those are licenses where the orderable  license item results in a matching single license entry in the IP Office system configuration  Additional  orderable items exist where the si
22.   e   Phone Manager Pro  per seat    20 Users  IPO LIC IP400 PMGR PRO RFA 20 LIC CU    177471   e Phone Manager Pro  per seat    50 Users  IPO LIC IP400 PMGR PRO RFA 50 LIC CU  177472     e Phone Manager Softphone Licenses  These licenses control how many users configured for Phone Manager Pro PC Softphone can  simultaneously run Phone Manager in that mode  Note that running Phone Manager in this mode also  requires and consumes a Phone Manager Pro license for each user  Multiple license can be combined   e   Phone Manager Pro IP Audio Enabled   1 User  IPO LIC PMGR SFTPHN RFA 1 LIC CU    171992   e   Phone Manager Pro IP Audio Enabled   5 Users  IPO LIC PMGR SFTPHN RFA 5 LIC CU    174463   e   Phone Manager Pro IP Audio Enabled   10 Users  IPO LIC PMGR SFTPHN RFA 10  LIC CU  174464   e   Phone Manager Pro IP Audio Enabled   20 Users  IPO LIC PMGR SFTPHN RFA 20  LIC CU  174465   e   Phone Manager Pro IP Audio Enabled   50 Users  IPO LIC PMGR SFTPHN RFA 50  LIC CU  174466        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 298  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     SoftConsole Licenses  IP Office SoftConsole is a Windows PC application intended for receptionists and operators  Up to 4  SoftConsoles can be licensed on a single IP Office system   e  SoftConsole Users License  IPO LIC IP400 SOFTCONSOLE BLF RFA LIC CU  171987   Enables the 1st instance of the operator console  Additional licenses can be added for up to 4 SoftConsoles  running at any time     M
23.   for example the user   s Direct Dial  number  or a specific department  for example switchboard  sales  support or administration     This feature allows users to answer the call appropriately and gives the flexibility to participate in multiple hunt  groups  particularly important for small businesses  The same information is also displayed should a second  incoming call be presented  allowing users to easily switch between calls or allow the second call to go to  voicemail  Users can choose to have the information pop up on their PC automatically as soon as a call is  presented  or when the call is answered     Call History      Number   From   To  Tag   Date  amp  Time   Ring Time       204 Betty Edmunds Anne Webb 06 Dec 2006 16 33 01 00 00 13  207 Shander Lear Anne Webb 06 Dec 2006 16 32 58 00 00 15  203 Abbey Nortin Anne Webb 06 Dec 2006 16 32 37 00 00 01  204 Betty Edmunds Anne Webb 06 Dec 2006 16 31 41 00 00 05          207 Shander Lear Anne Webb 06 Dec 2006 16 31 07 00 00 05    203 Abbey Nortin Anne Webb 06 Dec 2006 16 30 46 00 00 03  209 Betty Edmunds Anne Webb Paul Smith 06 Dec 2006 15 53 38 00 00 01    mm nanm ar mm mm       Phone Manager s call history keeps a combined record of up to 100 calls while the application is active   Double clicking any logged call dials that number  If Advice Of Charge service is available from the ISDN  service provider  this will also be displayed for outgoing calls        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page
24.   outbound calls and the total number of external inbound calls     e Call Summary Report  The Call Summary Report contains details of the total calls presented and answered  the average speed  to answer percentage and average speed to answer time  the number of calls overflowed and lost  the  average abandon time as well as the grade of service     e Trace Reports  The Trace Report lists in chronological order all the events  date and time stamped that involved the  subject selected     e Alarm Reports  Alarm reports can be created for the Supervisor Views  All the alarms for the selected subject are listed  over a user specified time period  Totals are included that show the number of warning and critical  alarms received for each unique alarm type included in the report     e Voicemail Reports  The report shows the following information  Total calls answered by the Auto Attendant  VMPro   total  calls abandoned  lost  in Auto Attendant  and a table of unique call flow trigger names with a tally of  the number of times the trigger has been received  e g  who pressed 1 for sales in the Auto Attendant         Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 246  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Creating an IP Office Customer Call Reporter Report   From the seven basic report templates within IP Office Customer Call Reporter  a user can create over 100  different reports depending upon how they want to see the information that is most useful for their bus
25.   ports for selected Avaya 2400  4400  5400   6400  T3  EMEA only  series phones and 3810 wireless phones  North America only   The IP500 Digital Station  module is available in 2 variants  16 or 30 extensions     For installations in a rack  this module requires the IP500 Rack Mounting Kit  The IP500 Digital Station Module  is functionally identical to the IP400 Digital Station V2 Module     IP Office 500  17 16 19 20 21 22 23 24    1 24 5 30  0000000 00000000  PARLERA aA    EERS RAA    EERS    DC WP         OTE EXPANSION  cap       24 DC     5 04 MAX   DIGITAL STATION 2  24 DC     1 54   PHONE V2       e Telephones can be located up to 1km from the control unit  For extensions located  out of the building   additional line protection will be needed  For more information on cabling and out of building guidelines   see the IP Office Installation Manual     e For systems where Direct Station Select  DSS  Units are being used  IP Office supports a maximum of   e Eight EU24 and or EU24BL per system     e Two XM24 units on each Digital Station expansion module to a maximum of 10 x XM24 units per  system     e Two 4450 units on each Digital Station expansion module to a maximum of 10 x 4450 units per  system     e T3 DSS units     See the Telephones Section  46 for specific limits on the number of each type of telephone supported on DS  modules           Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 40  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        IP400 Phone Modul
26.   printing and exporting  Crystal Enterprise Embedded for offloading report processing from o  web Server   For more information on how to purchase Crystal Reports products  go to   www businessobjects com products reporting crystalreports  Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 256    IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Crystal Reports Training   Training is available from a number of providers  the following is a sample list   1  Learning Tree International   www learningtree com  2  World Wide Source for Crystal Training   www crystal reports com    3  Stafford Technology   www crystaltraining com    Microsoft CRM    Reporting Integration New for CCC Version 5    Microsoft CRM    was introduced in January 2003 and has quickly become the premier CRM application for the  Small and Medium Enterprise  SME   Avaya and Microsoft are working together to provide a complete CRM   Communications  and Networking solution for any size of business     In Compact Contact Center Version 5  in conjunction with the introduction of the IP Office Customer  Management solution  Avaya has taken this integration one step further by integrating several Microsoft CRM  reports with CCC  Supervisors who operate both systems can now drive any of the 73 CCC reports from the  MS CRM interface  and there are 7 combined reports that utilize both systems data to present a 360   view of  the contact center  The 7 MS CRM reports are listed below     e Microsoft CRM Sales Report
27.  0x0000 pcol 6 TCP  sum 0x7a0d   TCP Header info   DstPort 50794 IP0 Monitor  SrcPort 1039 Seq 1928386035 Ack 4156189367 Code 0x10     Header 5 Window 64874 Sum 0x667c Urgent 0             Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 265  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Simple Network Management Protocol  SNMP        SNMP is an industry standard designed to allow the management of data equipment from different vendors  using a single Network Manager application  The Network Manager will periodically poll equipment to solicit a  response  if no response is received an alarm is raised  In addition to responding to polls  IP Office monitors  the state of its Extensions  Trunk cards  Expansion Modules  except WAN3 module  and Media cards so that if  an error is detected IP Office will notify the Network Manager  IP Office allows two separate Network Managers  to be configured so that both a customers Network Manager and a Maintainers Network Manager to be notified  of the same alarm condition  As the IP Office solution comprises many applications  the core software notifies  SNMP events from both VoiceMail Pro and Embedded voicemail to warn of approaching storage capacity limits     IP Office has been tested against CastleRock s SNMPc EE    and HP s Network Node Manager  part of the  OpenView application suite   Avaya s  Integrated Management Suite    also uses HP s Network Node Manager        SNMPc Management Console E  5  x     File Edit View Inser
28.  126   Group Monitor 253   Group Status 253   Group working 69    H    Handover 69   Hands Free Pouch 72   Handset 10  25  64  65  66  69  71  72  80  81  82     90  100  104  109  119  121  150  166  180  194  195   201 215    Handset Liquid Crystal Display 82  handset offers   high resolution 72  Handset Volume Control 82  90  Hands free  Speakerphone 81  Hardware 10  24  32  69  182  191  224  239  Hardware provides 24  Hardware Support 10  Head Office 21 119  Header Compression  Header Message 220  Headset 10  55  56  58  60  64  65  66  72  80  81   82  91  97  125  126  180  182  Headset Socket 55  56  58  60  64  65  66  Headset Toggle 126  headset microphone 129  Heat Dissipation 287  Held Calls Panel 185  Held Panel 185  Help Desks Support Desks 210  HH 262  High Voltage 41 91  Historical Reporting 252  254  Hold 6  55  56  58  60  82  85  86  87  90  101  102   103  107  108  118  126  162  165  174  185  213   220  259  268  282    Hold Call 102  126  185   Hold Call Waiting 102   Hold CW 126   Hold Music 101  102  126  259  Hong Kong 277   Hook 119  125   Hook Dialing 119   Hot Desk 108  153   Hot Desking 108    137  138  291    Hours greeting 122  HP s Network Node Manager 266  HTML 252  HTTP 168  Hunt Group Broadcast Messages 214  hunt group call handling 116  Hunt Group call ringing 109  Hunt Group Calls 109  110  116  121  122  259  Hunt Group Disable 126  Hunt Group Enable 126  Hunt Group Enable Disable 106  Hunt Group exceed 10  124  HUNT GROUP EXTENSION 262
29.  174  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Voicemail Access             iM Anne Webb          Phone Manager Lite provides notification of any new voicemails received and provides access into the user or  group   s mailbox allowing messages to be played     Desktop PC Telephony Controls    Phone Manager has telephony buttons on a tool bar that activate standard telephone functions such as  Answer  Transfer  Hold  Account codes and Conference etc  so that users don   t need to remember IP Office  specific feature codes  Personal settings such as Do Not Disturb  including exceptions list   call forwarding   mobile twinning and voicemail transfer option settings can be easily set up using Phone Manager     Calls can be easily parked using  drag and drop  functionality  Four Call Park slots zones  which can be shared  between users and operators  or within a department on the same IP Office system  further add to the ease  with which the entire call handling process is streamlined with Phone Manager        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 175  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Personal Productivity and Collaboration    All versions of Phone Manager feature a Busy Lamp Field  BLF  and Speed Dials  This allows users to  customize the application to reflect the status of their department  immediate colleagues or the whole  company as desired  The Direct Station Select allows you to dial regularly used internal and external numbers  via a si
30.  202969    e   SIP Trunk Channels   20 Channels  IPO LIC SIP TRNK RFA 20  202970        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 299  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     IP500 Licenses  The following licenses are used to enable features for systems based on the IP500 control unit     e   IP500 Upgrade Standard to Professional License  IPO LIC IP500 IPO STD UPG TO PRO  202959   Upgrades the IP500 system from Standard Edition feature operation to Professional Edition feature  operation  This enables a range of features including support for external expansion modules  support for  external voicemail servers  Voicemail Lite and Voicemail Pro   additional users  up to 272   meet me  conference  CCC and Conferencing Center      e IP500 Voice Networking Licenses  The use of private voice networking trunks between IP500 control units and other systems requires voice  networking channel licenses within the IP500  This applies to H323 IP trunks configured on the IP500  including IP trunks being used for an IP Office Small Community Network  A voice networking license is also  required for the use of trunks configured to for QSIG operation  On H323 IP trunks  a license instance is  consumed for each simultaneous outgoing call  incoming calls do not consume a license   On QSIG trunks  the number of calls is limited by the trunk type rather than available licenses   e   IP500 Voice Networking  Base 4 Channels  License   PO LIC IP500 VCE NTWK START4 LIC DS   202
31.  213   Virtual 220  Voicemail Access 174  Voicemail application 198  Voicemail Box Feature 220  Voicemail Breakout Personal Auto Attendant 200  Voicemail Collect 126  200  Voicemail email 212  224  283  Voicemail Email Connection 224  Voicemail email forwarding 212  Voicemail Email Integration 224  Voicemail Feature Comparison 220  voicemail greeting 20  Voicemail Help TUI 220  VoiceMail Lite 20  25  104  122  198  201  203  220  voicemail needs 198  Voicemail Node 126  Voicemail Off 126  Voicemail On 126  198  212  283  Voicemail PC 224  Voicemail Ports 109  135  217    VoiceMail Pro 10  20  22  25  104  109  122  125   153  155  177  185  198  201  206  207  208  210   211  212  213  214  215  216  217  218  220  230   232  233  259  266   406 32       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 341  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       VoiceMail Pro 10  20  22  25  104  109  122  125   153  155  177  185  198  201  206  207  208  210   211  212  213  214  215  216  217  218  220  230   232  233  259  266   500MB 224   License 224   pool 211   prompting 209  VoiceMail Pro application 94  259  Voicemail Pro Client 201  209  210  215  217  VoiceMail Pro Fax 206  VoiceMail Pro Intuity 177  VoiceMail ProManager 209  220  VoiceMail Pro Networked Messaging 22  155  214  VoiceMail Pro Networked Messaging RFA 155  VoiceMail Pro Server 155  201  207  208  211  224  voicemail ringback 103  126  220  Voicemail Ringback Off 126  Voicemail Ringb
32.  273  287   Phone 16 Module V2 273   Phone 30 Module 273  287   Phone 30 Module V2 273   Phone Manager application 106  107    Phone Manager Conferencing Center Integration  239    Phone Manager Feature Summary 181   Phone Manager GUI 213   Phone Manager Lite 20  25  118  173  174  177  Phone Manager Lite Pro PC Softphone 25    Phone Manager PC Softphone 22  129  173  180   182  252    Phone Manager Pro 10  20  22  25  94  109  118   173  177  180  181  182  213  214  220  252  278   279    Phone Manager Pro PC Softphone  Phone Manger Pro 252  Phone V2 41  physical logical 137  Pickup 109  Pick Up 105  Pilot 254  Pilot Call Duration 254  Pilot Distribution 254  Pilot Response 254  Pilot Routing 254  Pilot Summary  Incoming 254  PIN 20  115  198  210  220  232  233  238  prompted 198  requesting 230  PIN checking 210  233  PIN Code By Pass 220  PIN code menu 232  PIN Restricted Calling 115  Plain Old Telephone Services    129  Plain Ordinary Telephone 273  Platform Support 220    25  278  279    Play Advice  switching 217  played back 10  213  220    PoE 46  55  56  58  60  62  64  65  66  69  129  133  Point Compression  Microsoft Point  Point Protocol  Point 291  Point WAN 137  point to multipoint 39  Point to Point 39  143  150  162  164  166  Point to Point Protocol 162  166  Power Distribution Units 133  Power Fail Ports 290  Power Options  IP Telephones 133    167  291       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 334  Issue 18 s 
33.  278  279  business needs 114  business requiring 180 279  business requiring 190 278  business to business 162  Busy  DND 185  Busy Lamp Field 118  153  174  181  185  Busy Lamp Field Panel 185  Busy On Held 126       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 320  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       Busy Subscriber  Call Completion 143  Busy Engaged 213  buy lease 6  bypass  DND 107  Bytes 136   C   C3000 206  Cable 24  27  30  40  41  42  88  98  133  165  258   287  Cable Lengths 287  Cable Modems 165  CALA 98  273  Call 63 116  121  159  162  169  194  198  218   253  261  Advice of charge during 143  Call Appearance 86  110  112  113  Call Appearance button 110  112  113  Call Appearance Feature 46  62  85  86  87  callarrives 185  CallBack Sender 220  Call Back When Free  Call Barring 114 115  call billing 195  CallCenter 20  84  123  194  206  214  252  253  Call Center View 252  253  Call Center View provides  Supervisors 253  Call Center View Real Time Example 253  Call Completion  Busy Subscriber 143  callcosting 114  Call Coverage 106  112  113  Call Coverage Buttons 112 113  CallData 10  Call Detail Records 261  267  Call Details 261  267  269  Call Details Panel 185  Call Duration 177  185  Call Flow Name 254  call flow programming interface 211  Call Flow Utilizing Database Actions 210  Call Flows 10  210  211  212  230  254  Call Forwarding 18  100  116  174  212  Call Handling 6  20  100  105  174  181  185  254  Ca
34.  3641          AVPP 10 20 100    Application Server NetLink OAI   Optional  Gateway    Users can have a choice of an executive or rugged workplace telephone and all the productivity benefits of  their desk telephone in this next generation of wireless telephone solutions     3645          Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 72  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Wireless IP Terminals  Users can have a choice of 5 WiFi phones to meet their in building mobility needs   e 3 Phones supporting the 802 11b standard and up to 6 lines or selected features     e Avaya 3616 supports a broad range of enterprise applications and is ideally suited for general office   financial or hospitality industries  This compact handset offers a high resolution graphic display and  menu driven functions     e Avaya 3620 is specifically designed to meet the needs of the healthcare vertical  The 3620 comes  standard with a backlit display     e Avaya 3626 is an extremely durable handset for workplace applications in industrial environments   This phone is easy to use and requires minimal training  Push to talk functionality is also available for  broadcast communication between employees  eliminating the need for two way radios or walkie  talkies  The large ear piece seals out background noise and provides comfort for frequent or lengthy  calls     e Access to 6 lines or selected features through the  line  key  no labels     e 2 Phones supporting the 802 11 a b g stand
35.  37 Inbound 01707364416 200 Queue 00 00 01 AgentA 00 00 01  02 12 2008 13 10 18 Inbound 01707364416 200 Queue 00 00 06  AgentA  04 12 2008 12 31 28 Inbound 01707364416 200 Queue 00 00 07 AgentA  04 12 2008 12 32 12 Inbound 01707364416 200 Queue 00 00 02 AgentA 00 00 04  04 12 2008 12 56 14 Inbound 01707364416 200 Queue 00 00 02 AgentA 00 00 07  Summary  Total Calls 28 External Inbound Calls  Internal Calls 5 External Outbound Calls  Call Summary Report  DB SK    gt     fi 11  100  rl  My Call Summary Report  Report Type Target Name  Call Summary Report Queue    Supervisor Name  Mark Gallagher       Ungrouped Presented Answered LostCalls Overflowed Overflowed Routed To No Answer Avg  Speedto Avg  Speedto Avg  Abandon Grade Of  Calls Calls Answered Lost Voicemail Answer     Answer  Time  Time Service       MainB 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 00 0 00  Queue 23 17 9 0 0 0 0 52 94 00 00 01 00 00 08 37 50  Queue2 2 2 0 0 0 0 0 0 00 00 00 02 0 00   Presented Calls 26 Average Speed to Answer     50 00   Answered Calls 20 Average Speed to Answer  Time  00 00 01   Lost Calls 9 Average Abandon Time 00 00 08   Overflowed Answered 0 Grade of Service 36 00   Overflowed Lost 0 Answer Threshold 1   Routed To Voicemail 0 Lost Call Threshold 1   No Answer o External Outbound 0   Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 248    IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Real Time Reporting    Small Business Contact Center provides real time monitoring of call center activity  This is
36.  6000 cr    A 2008 0008 von                 Unit Status LED  Red   Starting   Green   Started     LAH Switch Ports 1 8  Layer 2 unmanaged Ethernet switch     Full duplex 10 00Mbps auto sensing ports   Green LEDs Yellow LEDs    On   Connected  On   100Mbps   Flashing   Activity  Off   10Mbps        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 307  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009                      DTE Serial Port 37 is Port LS Expansion Ports 1 6  9 pin D type socket   pin D Type socket     X21  V35 or V24  Aikio inpiit Port  DC Power Input Socket 3 5mm Stereo jack socket   To external power supply unit  Trunk Interface Card Slots  External Output Socket All trunk card types   3 5mm Stereo jack socket  Dual PRI cards in Slot 4 only   Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 308    IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Expansion Modules    Through support of up to six external Expansion Modules  IP406 can be enhanced to support a mixture of  analog  digital or IP phones  to maximum of 190 phones in any combination     If additional analog trunks are required  these can be aggregated in groups of 16 on each analog expansion  module    Data Channels    A Data Channel is used for Remote Access  RAS   Internet Access  and Voicemail sessions  A data channel is  an internal signaling resource used whenever a call is made from the IP network to an exchange line  Central  Office   For example  four people surfing the Internet will use a
37.  6400 and T3 Series phones plus 3810  wireless  US  phones     e Two Analog telephone ports   e Two Wire  e DTMF signaling  No rotary or Loop Disconnect   e Timed Break Recall  No Earth Loop Recall   e Caller ID capable   a variety of standards  see later  e MWI capable   82 5V and Line Reversal  e Eight 10 100 Mbps LAN Switched ports  Layer 2  unmanaged    e Support for optional embedded voicemail auto attendant  Compact Flash card   e 9 pin DTE Port  for maintenance or Feature Key connection for application licensing    e X 21 V35 WAN interface   e Support for up to 6 IP Office Expansion Modules   e Phone modules  8  16  30   e Digital Station modules  16  30   e Analog Trunk Module 16  e So8 module  e External O P socket supporting two relay on off switch ports  e g  for door entry systems   e Audio input port for external music on hold source   e Two trunk interface card slots for analog  BRI  PRI  Ti  E1  or CAS  E1R2   e Internal socket for IP Telephony expansion   voice compression modules  from 4 to 30 channels   e Internal socket for internal modem  2 or 12  for Remote Access Services  e 50 Data channels    e Up to 20 VoiceMail Pro ports                   AVAYA IP406 Office  os Phone  5 6 7 8 1    1 2 3 4 2    POT  Analog Phone  Ports 1 2    DS  Digital Station  Ports 1 8  Green LED   Phone connected   Yellow LED   Not used  Port Status LEDs  C F  Compact Flash  Slot  On   Present  Slot for Embedded Yoicemail   Flashing   Activity  memory card     TRUNK EXP    n 0006
38.  All rights reserved  Page 69  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Avaya IP DECT System licensing    A license is necessary for this functionality  This license is called the Avaya IP Office IP DECT Mobility Manager  license  This license is entered through the main base station  ADMM  and is NOT entered through the IP Office  System manager  A feature key server is NOT necessary to enable the IP DECT functionality    No separate PC or software is required with this system     In all regions  a    plug and play    licensing mechanism is available  It consists of a pre licensed and ready to go  two base station bundle     IP DECT IPO STARTER KIT      and two pre licensed base stations     IP DECT  RFP32 34 UPG KIT      that can be added to the system independent of the number of licenses in ADMM  This  allows easier deployment and upgrades of systems without the need to buy a separate upgrade license  For IP  Office we recommend to use the    Starter Kits    and the    Upgrade Kits    for new installations for added flexibility  and to minimize the installation effort     The bundles that have previously been available in EMEA will continue to be available and are compatible with  the pre licensed base stations described above  if the latest software is installed on the IP DECT system  e g   upgrade an existing 5 base station system with an    Upgrade Kit    when adding an extra base station instead of  upgrading the system license to a 6  license     Additional upgrad
39.  April 2006 10 29 49  03 April 2006 10 33 29  03 April 2006 13 11 33  04 April 2006 09 32 14  04 April 2006 10 09 42  04 April 2006 10 12 20  04 April 2006 12 52 05  04 April 2006 12 55 59  06 April 2006 15 32 23   lt     Security User  Administrator  Administrator  Administrator  Administrator  Administrator  Administrator  System Reboot  Administrator  Administrator  Administrator  Administrator  Administrator   ill    AccessT ype  Write With Merge  Write With Merge  Write With Merge  Write With Merge  Write With Merge  Write With Merge  Warm Start  Write With Merge  Write With Merge  Write With Merge  Write With Merge  Security Login    Outcome    Success  clean   Success  clean   Success  clean   Success  clean   Success  clean   Success  clean   Success   Success  Warning   Success  Warning   Success  Warning   Success  Warning   Failure          Audit Details    Security User    Date and Time of Access    PC Login   PC IP Address  PC MAC Address  Access Type    Outcome       Administrator          04 April 2006 12 52 05          Ayayal 23          192 168  42   203             UN   ile    164   fae      fa      06          Write With Merge             Success  Warning           Items Changed       ltem Type  User       Extn207  Account Code Account Code    ltem Name                Product Description    IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 263  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Manager is also used for maintenance functions such as   e Upgrade to the 
40.  Call history log   all  missed  messages   eparated incoming outgoing call log   Collect new voicemail messages     Voicemail box control   Intuity and IP Office modes      Personal Distribution List set up   Intuity mode     ncoming call scripting   Time on call   Advice of Charge  ISDN service provider dependent     ueue monitoring   Conference Control Display   Conferencing Center action buttons     Outlook  Goldmine  ACT  and Maximizer    imple Outlook contact record creation   Agent Mode     Distinctive Ringing   WAV file       sending DTMF while connected to another party    VoIP mode  to run as an PC Softphone     Phone Manager Phone Manager Pro  Lite and PC SoftPhone    Yes Yes    Yes Yes  Yes Yes    Yes   100 icons  maximum per tab     Yes   10 tabs  maximum     Yes   15 icons  maximum     Yes   1 tab     Yes  not PC SoftPhone     Yes   1000 entries  maximum     Yes  Yes  Yes  Yes  Yes  Yes  Yes  Yes  Yes    Yes  Yes  Yes  Yes  Yes  Yes  Yes  Yes   es        Optional license          Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 181  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Phone Manager PC Requirements       e Phone support     Any telephones connected to IP Office  although handsfree operation is only supported on suitable  Avaya Digital and IP telephones     e PC requirements     e Always refer to the latest Avaya IP Office Technical Tip or Technical Bulletin for any updated  information with regard to Operating Systems  Service Packs o
41.  Cannot be intruded upon flag e Number of groups that the user is a member of that    e X directory flag are currently out of service    e Number of groups that the user is a member of that  are currently on night service       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 283  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        DevLink Fields       The following table shows the device specific data available via DevLink     CE Field Data   S Message     Field Data   S Message         1 A call id Voicemail disallow   2 B call id 7 Sending complete   3 A state 28 Bc tc bc tm   4 B state 29 Owner hunt group name   5 A connected 30 Original hunt group name   6 A is music 31 Original user name   7 B connected 32 Target hunt group name   8 B is music 33 Target user name   9 A name 34 Target RAS name   10 B name 35 Is internal call   11 B list  possible targets for the call  36 Time stamp   12 A slot  channel 37 Connected time   13 B slot   channel 38 Ring time   14 Called party presentation and type 39 Connected duration   15 Called party number 40 Ring duration   16 Calling party presentation and type 41 Locale   17 Calling party number 42 Park slot number   18 Called sub address 43 Call waiting   19 Calling sub address 44 Tag   20 Dialled party type 45 Transferring   21 Dialled party number 46 Sv active   22 Keypad type 47 Sv quota used   23 Keypad number 48 Sv quota time   z   Ring attempt count   Account code  Cause Unique call identifier   A ET ETS  A call id A call 
42.  Embedded Applications  Navigation Cursor Control  Call signaling via LED and or ringer  Alpha entry  via dialing keypad    e Optional Add Ons  T3 Headset link for wired headsets only   e Color  Graphite gray or polar white    e Mounting  Desk   e Adjustable Desk Stand  Display adjustable    Features for T3 Upn     e Upgradeable Firmware  No    e Optional Add Ons  up to 3 DSS Modules  e Connect to  Digital Station  DS  port    e Power Supply  From phone system     Features for T3 IP     e Upgradeable Firmware  Yes   e Optional Add Ons  up to 3 DSS Modules with AEI Headsetlink   e Power Supply  IEEE 802 3af Power over Ethernet  PoE  or individual power supply unit   e Codecs  G 711  G 729a b   e QoS Options  UDP Port Selection  DiffServ and 802 1p q  VLAN   e SNMP Support  no   e IP Address Assignment  Static or dynamic IP address assignment   e Ethernet Ports  Two port full duplex 10 100 BaseT Ethernet switch   e Auto negotiation provided separately for each port   e 802 3 Flow Control        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 65  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        T3 Comfort       Common Features     Display  graphical 17 lines x 40 characters  Integrated keyboard    Fixed Feature Buttons  5 preprogrammed keys with printed text labels and 2 for Audio Volume  control    Programmable Feature Buttons  6 preprogrammed keys with indicators and printed text labels  6  preprogrammed keys with printed text labels  10 user programmable keys with a
43.  External  I P Socket Port O P Socket    Audio I P Socket             Functional Earth 2 x PCMCIA slots for Wireless  Jack Socket and Embedded Voicemail     Knock out panel s  for trunk module kits  for example     i    WAN X21 V24 V35 Quad BRI trunks T1PRI trunk  Comes with new back panel          Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 313  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     IP Office   Small Office Edition WAN Expansion Interfaces  Both IP Office   Small Office Edition variants provide an expansion slot for an optional WAN interface of the  following types  check locally for availability   Each of these interface cards are now described in more detail     IP400 WAN Expansion   The IP400 WAN Expansion card provides a single WAN connection  X21  V24 or V35 via a 37 way D Type  socket   Line speeds up to and including 2Mbps are supported on the interface  The carrier providing the line  dictates the actual operating speed  i e  in some territories the maximum speed may be 1 544M     IP400 BRI Card  The BRI trunk card provides 4 European Basic Rate ISDN T interfaces  8 trunks      Details of the supported supplementary services on BRI interfaces are given in the    Public and Private Voice  Networks  section     e Not available in all territories  check for availability     IP400 T1 PRI Card    The IP400 T1 PRI card provides a single primary rate trunk interface for supporting voice services and  fractional leased lines  providing up to 256K bandwi
44.  Failure j  Et End         f   age BookShop_SystemPr    ae BookShop_Welcome  Failure a       age BookShop_Search_             Ta BookShop_CurrentBookS peakDetails ao    ae ee pie  Buy or Return this book   Ie BookShop_SystemProblem                                 Example Call Flow Utilizing Database Actions    The database actions that are provided through the VoiceMail Pro Client are     e Database Open   Opens a link to the required database  Multiple databases can be accessed during a  call but only one database can be opened at one time     e Database Execute   Provides the ability to enter a query on the opened database  The query can    Select     data from the open database or can  Insert  data into the database     e Database Get Data   Provides access to the data that has been retrieved from a database through the  Database Execute action  The user can retrieve the next item  previous item  first item in the list or the  last item in the list     e Database Close   This action will close the current database  If the database is open when a call  terminates then the database will be automatically closed     As with other VoiceMail Pro call flow actions  the database actions include the ability to communicate with the  Avaya Compact Contact Center for reporting purposes  the VoiceMail Pro installation includes Microsoft Data  Access Components  MDAC  to simplify connection to most common databases     Interaction with the opened database is done through Structured Quer
45.  Group calls can also follow forward unconditional   Users can select if forwarding is applied to external calls only  or all calls  Call forwarding is processed after Do  Not Disturb and Follow Me conditions are tested     Associated Features Precedence  e Do Not Disturb  DND  e Forward Unconditional  e Voice Mail  VM  e Forward Busy  e Follow Me e Forward No Answer    e Hunt Groups    e No Answer Interval       Forward on Busy    If enabled  this forward will be triggered when the user is busy and another call is routed to them  but does  not include calls for a hunt group that they may be a member of  A user is normally considered to be busy  when they are on a call but depending on call waiting settings and key and lamp features this may not be the  case        Forward on No Answer    This forward is triggered if a call has been ringing for a user but they haven   t answered it within the configured  answer time  this includes calls that have been indicating call waiting if enabled        Forward Unconditional    This sends all calls for the user to the forward unconditional number  but if the call is not answered within a  user   s timeout period the call will be sent to IP Office voicemail  if enabled        Forward Hunt Group    Calls for a hunt group that the user belongs to can also follow forward unconditional  The hunt group must be  set for either hunt or rotary ring type and if the call is not answered at the forward destination it will follow the  hunt group cal
46.  Handling 259  Queue Manager 20  Queue Mode 190  Queue Monitor 253  Queue Panel 185  queue panel displays  bar 185  queue position 10  220  259  Queue Position Announcement 220  Queue Threshold Alert 10  124  Queue Update Announcement 220  QUEUING 262  Quick Charger 72  Quotas 162  164  166  284  Quotas place 162   R   Radio Frequency 2 4000 75 78  Radio Frequency 2 4000 GHz 78  RAID 224  RAS 32  135  169  Rate Adaptation 291  Rating  24VDC 287  reachability 6  reading  email 20  Real Time 20  138  201  252  253  291  Real Time Control Protocol 138  291  real time prompting  supervisor 252  Real Time Reporting 253  Real Time Status 253  Real Time Supervisor Monitoring 252  real time tracking 20  Reattempt 185  Reboot When Free 262  Rec 291  Recall button 90  91  receivers 129  Receiving Door 94  Reception 103  125  Breakout 220  Rechargeable Battery 82  Reclaim Call 106  Record Message 126  216  Record Send 220  recorded message stating 216  Recording 217  Time 220  Recordings 10  216  217  218  224  Redial Button 82  90  Region 68  69  89  98  278  279    RegisterCallNotifications 282  relating  conferencing 232  Relay Off 126  Relay On 126  201  Relay On Off Pulse 109  Relay Pulse 126  Release 4 0 269  Release 4 0 7  69  Release 4 1 10  122  165  Release 4 1  10  Remote Access 19  21  32  36  100  135  162  164   169  180  201  273  Mail Box 220  Remote Access Features 164  Remote Access Server 19  21  169  Remote Access Services 32  100  162  164  Remote Hot Desking 108  1
47.  IP ENDPOINT RFA 100 LIC CU  174961     Avaya VPN Remote Phone Licenses   To run Avaya IP phones over a VPN connection to the IP Office requires the phones to be loaded with Avaya  VPNremote client software  For IP Office this is supported with Avaya 5610 and 5621 telephones  The number  of phones able to register with the IP Office using the Avaya VPNremote client is set using combinations of the  license below  Note  The IP Office cannot be used to terminate the VPN tunnels from the phones  a separate  VPN device must be used    e   VPN IP Extensions License   1 Phone  IPO LIC VPN PHONE 1 LIC CU  213980    e   VPN IP Extensions License   5 Phones  IPO LIC VPN PHONE 5 LIC CU  213981    e   VPN IP Extensions License   10 Phones  IPO LIC VPN PHONE 10 LIC CU  213982    e   VPN IP Extensions License   20 Phones  IPO LIC VPN PHONE 20 LIC CU  213983    e   VPN IP Extensions License   50 Phones  IPO LIC VPN PHONE 50 LIC CU  213984     SIP Trunk Channel Licenses   These licenses are used to enable channels on SIP trunks added to the IP Office system  When a channel is  used it requires a license  Multiple licenses can be combined for the total number of channels required  Note  that SIP calls will require VCM channels during call setup and may require VCM channels during the call    e   SIP Trunk Channels   1 Channel  IPO LIC SIP TRNK RFA 1  202967    e   SIP Trunk Channels   5 Channels  IPO LIC SIP TRNK RFA 5  202968    e   SIP Trunk Channels   10 Channels  IPO LIC SIP TRNK RFA 10 
48.  IP Office provides the  same rich services as enjoyed within a traditional network environment  Our standards based approach allows  interoperability within mixed vendor networks     The basic supplementary service features supported by H 323 on IP Office to IP Office IP trunk links are listed  below     e Basic call set up  voice    e Call Hold  local     e Call Transfer  local     e Called Calling Name    e Called Calling Number     Additional features can be added through the use of IP Office Small Community Networking  see the following  section      On IP trunks to non IP Office systems the Supplementary Service will depend on those also supported by the  non IP Office system        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 152  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Small Community Networking       When connecting IP Offices together over IP or Packet based networks  Small Community Networking  enhances feature transparency  These networks can support up to a maximum of 500 users across 16 sites   The following additional features are available     e Busy Lamp Field    e Camp on    e Call Back When Free   e Paging    e Call Pick up     e Centralized Voice Mail  VoiceMail Pro   Support for mailboxes  call recording  dial by name and auto attendants  Remote queuing on  remote systems is also supported with the Advanced Small Community Networking license  see  below      e Internal Directory   e Absent Text Message     e Anti Tromboning     Branc
49.  IP412 PRI 60 E1 fitted with two 30 channel Voice Compression Modules  VCMs    These two internally fitted cards allow up 60 simultaneous calls to external parties  IP extension calling a non   IP telephone or line   For IP to IP calls  VCM resources are only required for initial call set up  Depending on  the typical utilization of external trunks  a lower capacity VCM variant could be employed  as appropriate     The IP Office softphone is    Phone Manager Pro PC Softphone    which is an enhanced version of the standard  Phone Manager Pro application enabled for each user using two License Keys as listed below     Kit List  e 1 x IP412 control unit   e 1 x PRI 60 E1 trunk card   e 1 x Region specific power cord   e 2 x IP400 VCM 30 cards   e 60 x 5610 IP phones   e 1 x IP Office Feature Key  e 1 x IP400 Phone Manager Pro RFA 50   e 1 x IP400 Phone Manager Pro RFA 10   e 1 x IP400 Phone Manager PC SoftPhone RFA 50   e 1 x IP400 Phone Manager PC SoftPhone RFA 10        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 279  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 280  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Chapter 16   TAPI Functions Supported  by IP Office       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 281  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     16  TAPI Functions Supported by IP Office       TAPI 2 1 Functions Supported       TAPILink Lite provides the following function
50.  IP500 Voice Networking License    QSIG  H 323 and SCN capabilities are not enabled by default in the IP500  An additional license is required to  enable this functionality with 4 simultaneous networking channels  no channel limit for QSIG   Additional  channels can then be licensed in increments of 4  A Voice Networking license is still required to enable QSIG   even though there is no limit to the number of QSIG calls that can be made or received once licensed     IP Office Standard Edition    By default the IP500 control unit runs a subset of full IP Office functionality called IP Office Standard Edition   In this mode the IP500 is restricted to a maximum of 32 users in the base control unit with no expansion   Supported options include Embedded Voicemail  Phone Manager Lite Pro PC Softphone  SoftConsole  TAPI   SMDR  SIP trunking  mobile twinning  VPN Phone and IP DECT  as well as licenses for voice networking  H 323  or SCN   IP Office Standard Edition does not support advanced applications  VoiceMail Pro  CCC  Conference  Center  etc   This restriction can be removed by adding an IP Office Professional Edition Upgrade license to the  configuration     IP Office Professional Edition    By purchasing the upgrade license from Standard Edition to Professional Edition  additional functionality is  enabled  This includes the ability to expand the system using up to eight external Expansion Modules  allowing  the IP500 to support a maximum of 272 extensions through a mixture o
51.  Incoming Call Route setting  Priority  has been modified from a simple 1  2  and 3 to now display the  following making easier understanding of the priority value       e 1 Low  e 2 Medium  e 3 High    A new Call Priority Promotion Timer has been introduced to allow calls that have been queuing for longer than  the timer setting to be promoted in priority  In addition  the Dial Extension short code has been enhanced to  allow a transferred call to have its priority changed     ETSI CHI   In IP Office 4 2  the Line SubType ETSI CHI is now available on all supported PRI cards  When this subtype is  selected  channels can be allocated from 1 30 or 30 1 and further parameters may be configured per channel   Incoming Outgoing Line Group ID  Channel Name  In Out of Service  Direction  Incoming  Outgoing   Bothway   Bearer  Voice  Data  Any      ETSI CHI stands for European Telecommunications Standards Institute   Call Handling Initiator   Restrict Network Interconnect    When configured  this feature allows an IP Office to be programmed such that calls cannot be connected  between private and public trunk interface groups  Used in some countries to comply with regulations     T3 Telephone Enhancements  IP Office 4 2 supports the following enhancements for all variants of Avaya T3 telephones  T3 telephones are  not supported on the Small Office Edition      e Display Hunt Group membership status   e Edit phone directory entry   e Enhance T3 display    follow Me    target   e Visual
52.  Meet Me Conferencing on IP500 requires Professional Edition  IP Office Standard Edition supports 64 way basic conferencing  but if Meet Me capabilities are required  the Upgrade License to IP Office Professional Edition should be purchased       IP Office Conferencing Center   If IP Office Conferencing Center is installed  5 resources are reserved for use by the system  The  maximum number of callers in any one conference and the total number of people on conference calls is  reduced by 5  The maximum number of conferences on the system for IP406 V2  IP412 and IP Office  500 is reduced by 2        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 231    IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        IP Office Standard Conferencing Features       The IP Office provides the following features and benefits relating to conferencing     e No special conferencing equipment required  You only need an IP Office system unit with as many digital trunks VoIP channels as external  participants  as well as VoiceMail Pro should PIN code menu prompts be required      e Ease of use  Simply dial the direct number allocated to the conference bridge  type in the PIN if required and you  have joined the conference  PIN codes require VoiceMail Pro      e Conference control from IP Office Phone Manager Lite and Pro  For ad hoc conferences with a few participants  users can easily set up immediate conferences by calling  all parties and bringing them to the conference bridge  Thanks t
53.  Office CTI interfaces        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 195  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        TAPILink Lite  1st Party TAPI Support     TAPILink Lite provides simple first party CTI via Microsoft TAPI 2 1 and 3 0  Individual desktop PCs connected  to the Local Area Network communicate with IP Office via an IP connection over the LAN  Each PC is capable of  controlling one telephone device  see diagram below            PSTN        IP Office    IP Office User            Windows PC     P Office TAPI2       Microsoft TAPI 2 1 and 3 0 are specifications and developers interfaces for controlling and monitoring a  telephony device  The specification requires that a certain amount of core functionality is implemented  and  additionally defines a series of optional functionality that switch vendors may also implement        TAPILink Pro  3rd Party TAPI Support     TAPILink Pro provides all of the features and functionality of TAPILink Lite  but additionally provides third party  CTI operation  This means that a single server can control and monitor any number of telephone devices        In addition  TAPILink Pro provides the ability to monitor and control groups  This allows an application to be  notified when a call enters a queue  and can also redirect it to another location     TAPILink Pro also supports additional TAPI functionality that is not available through TAPILink Lite  This  functionality is supported through the LineGetLineD
54.  PoE   no individual power supplies are available to power the outdoor IP DECT base station     In EMEA and APAC this system supports the 3701 and 3711 handsets   In North America  only the 3711 handset is supported     Avaya recommends that for new deployments  for full feature functionality the 3711 handset be used with the  IP DECT solution     Note  The regulatory requirements for the radio part  base station and Handset  are slightly different in the US  and Canada compared to EMEA and APAC  Therefore  while providing the same functionality  the hardware is  different in these two regions     Each Base station has the following features   e 8 simultaneous Voice and up to 12 Signaling Channels   e Codec G 711  G 723  G 729 for base station IP trunk connection   e Handover    While in motion  the handset performs continuous measurements to determine which IP DECT base  station has the strongest signal  The one that can be best received is defined as the active Base station   To prevent the handset from rapidly switching back and forth between two base stations that are  equally well received  threshold values are used  Handover between base stations occurs seamlessly  whether a call is active or not     e DECT Networking    An IP DECT telephone can travel from one office to another which is connected over a wide area  network  WAN  link and make and take calls  In this scenario the main IP DECT controller remains at  one    headquarters    location     Given the degree of 
55.  Print fax or text Available as an option but fax    messages not currently supported    Options for addressing voicemails   2  or  A  Alternate between name and number addressing Yes        5  or  L  Use mailing list for addressing Yes  0 Call the sender Yes  provided Caller ID is provided   1 Reply to the sender by voicemail Yes  2 Forward with comment at beginning Yes  3 Forward with comment at the end Yes  4 Record and address a message Yes  1 Record Send messages Yes  2 Get messages Yes  3 Create greetings Yes  4 Outgoing and filed messages Not supported  5 Personal Options Support for options 1  3 7   6 Outcalling Yes   7 Autoscan Autoprint Autoscan supported   Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 223    IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        PC Requirements       General Requirements  e An IP Office Feature Key is required for VoiceMail Pro     e License for VoiceMail Pro and any additional ports required  If VoiceMail Pro server is installed without a  license it will run for 2 hours and then shutdown     e License for all options of VoiceMail Pro being installed   e IP Office VoiceMail Pro CD   e Installation on the same PC as being used for IP Office Manager is recommended     e Switch off any PC and hard disk sleep  power down  suspend  hibernation modes     PC Specification    e Always refer to the latest Avaya IP Office Technical Tip or Technical Bulletin for any updated information  with regard to Operating Systems  Service Packs o
56.  Real Time Control Protocol     CHAP RFC1994 Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol      CCP__________ RFC1962  Compression Control Protocol  SSS  STAC RFC1974   STAC LZS Compression Protocol     MPPC RFC2118_  Microsoft Point to Point Compression  Protocol      BACP_ RFC2125   Bandwidth Allocation Control Protocol     UDP  RFC768_ User Datagram Protocol  S  IP RFC791 Internet Protocol   TCP RFC793_  Transmission Control Protocol     DHCP RFC4533_  Dynamic Host Control Protocol  O  NAT RFC4631 Network Address Translation   BOOTP  RFC951 Bootstrap Protocol   TFTP RFC4350_  Trivial File Transfer Protocol   NTP RFC868  Network Time Protocol     SNMPv1 RFC1157 Simple Network Management Protocol   STD15     RFC1155 Structure and identification of management information for TCP IP  based internets   STD16    RFC1212 Concise MIB Definitions   STD16    RFC1215 A convention for defining traps for use with SNMP     ee oes om  based internets  MIB II   STD17    ENTITY MIB RFC2737_ Entity MIB  Version 2     RIP RFC1058___ Routing Information Protocol  o  RFC2453  RIP Version 2   STD        o       lt   RFC1722_  RIP Version 2 Protocol Applicability Statement   STD57   RFC2401  Security Architecture for the Internet Protocol     RFC2402  IP Authentication Header   RFC2403  The Use of HMAC MD5 96 within ESP and AH   RFC2404  The Use of HMAC SHA 1 96 within ESP and AH     RFC2405__ The ESP DES CBC Cipher Algorithm with Explicit IV     RFC2406  IP Encapsulation Security Payload   ESP   
57.  Snapshot LogOff Exit About Stats On    Configuration Size  1024K   resources   17   Configuration Used  172K       System Resources    Music on Hold Source  External    Memory Free  71837K    8kHz Clock source  Line  1 Slot 1 Port  1    Number of Channels Number in Use Last Date of Congestion                Modern          YM   10 Nov 2006 08 19 26          Conference                Pause    SSA can be launched independently or from IP Office Manager and there can be up to two  2  SSA clients  connected to an IP Office unit at one time     Note  SSA is not a configuration tool for IP Office systems  For information on configuration  refer to IP Office  Manager     In IP Office 4 2  System Status Application  SSA  has a new real time configuration alarms screen which  shows the following new alarms     e Duplicate Numbers in Small Community Networking dial plan     e    No routing for Line      Incoming Line Group has no associated Incoming Call Route     e Call Routed to a non existent Start Point in VoiceMail Pro     e SSA displays the following new resource availability alarms in IP Office 4 2        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 269  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     IP Office 4 2    Attempt to use a feature for which no license is installed     e Voicemail storage full or nearly full     e The following new screens are provided in SSA in IP Office 4 2     Control Unit Audit   details the last 15 accesses from Manager     Feature Key and License 
58.  The TAPI WAV driver is for use with TAPI 2 1  only  for TAPI 3 0  IP Office supports the Media Service Provider  MSP  interface  defined by Microsoft in  TAPI 3 0  This functionality will only work in conjunction with CTI Link Pro and also requires TAPI WAV  licenses  Each license enables 4 ports of voice processing     e DevLink Pro  Provides a real time event stream in addition to the SMDR interface provided in IP Office SMDR  The  real time event stream takes the form of a call record  which is issued whenever the state of any  endpoint of a call changes  typically there are two end points on a call  but for some circumstances   such as conference calls  intruded calls there may be more      e IP Office SMDR  Provides an interface to obtain SMDR events  A comma separated record is issued for each call  when  the call is completed  This interface is designed for call accounting and call billing applications  IP Office  SMDR is available free of charge  and distributed on the IP Office Admin CD ROM     e For IP Office 4 2  the IP Office SMDR can be output direct from the IP Office control unit to a  designated IP address and port     e Software Development Kit  This toolkit is delivered on a single CD Rom  containing the developer documentation for TAPILink Lite   TAPILink Pro  DevLink Lite and DevLink pro  as well as pre compiled programs for exploring TAPI 2 1  and 3 0  In addition  example source code is included  making it easy for developers to become familiar  with IP
59.  The result of this is that powerful  Interactive Voice Response systems  IVR  can be delivered to specifically meet the requirements of the  business and the customer experience that is required     Example interactive systems that can be built as a result of these facilities include  Information Bulletin  Boards  order taking and order processing systems  front end systems to Help Desks Support Desks  Contact  Centers  secure access to information through PIN checking  survey systems  remote time sheet management   etc     e The ability to interact with Database information is enabled through the purchase of the IPO LIC   IP400  3rd PRTY IVR RFA license key  The entry of this key will enable the operation of four new Database  Action Icons within the VoiceMail Pro client     SS    ix  Fie Edit Actions Administration Help  CRETA e a     J      eg  ALPINE   HR 4 Lala a    5   nv   A Specific Start Points Modules  gt  BookShop_Search_ISBN    g Database Open                                                Users  A Groups b gt  EH Database Execute  cd Short Codes  Next A   Database Get Data  Database Close        H a Default Start Points          yus  B Make sure DB Still active Fr        ma   Pleie  E apuro ISBN     Timeout a   Failure p E e                                           Modules aa 784 Te  nest  CPN Fram DR SSS 5 Liu ISBN Not Found  4 BookShop_CurrentBc H     EN From e  E Get Book Details i  Timeout   g  BookShop_CurrentBc Mogess    Success D l  ge BookShop_Search_  
60.  This application is IP Office s main configuration tool  Using a Windows Graphical User Interface  Manager  provides an intuitive interface for installation  configuration and subsequent moves and changes  As with all IP  Office applications  the Manager is multi lingual and coupled with the ability to use the application both locally  and remotely  it is possible for an administrator to manage any of their IP Offices from any country using their  local language preference  Access to each IP Office is protected by passwords and definable user rights  This  allows Manager to operate according to the individual administrator   s level of expertise        File Edit View Tools Help  L   6    i  gt  201 Extn201    IP Offices     amp  BOOTP  3  Extension Voicemail On  PhoneManager Type    H     Operator  3  Standard User   a  IPOffice_1     ap System  1     Extn203 203 Pro  TA Line  0     Extn201 201 Lite      Control Unit  4      ya    amp  Extension  42      User  43     HuntGroup  2       9x Short Code  60  User   Voicemail   DND    ShortCodes   Source Numbers   Telephony   Forwarding   Dialin   Vo 4      B Service  0  a  L RAS  1  Name Extn201            Incoming Call Route  4 Password  i WanPott  1   Directory  0  Confirm Password    P  Time Profile  1     Firewall Profile  1   GB IP Route  1  Extension 201     ff Least Cost Routing  0     m Account Code  1  Locale     Licence  5   Wa Tunnel  0     amp  Logical LAN  0  EE    9 User Rights  2     k Auto Attendant  0  Error Lis
61.  U  single or dual  daughter cards  e IP500 Dual or Quad BRI daughter cards  e SIP trunks  RFC 2833     In IP Office 4 2 the existing Mobile Twinning license has been renamed to Mobility license  The license now  enables the use of Mobile Call Control and one X Mobile client features as well as Mobile Twinning  An instance  of the license will be consumed for every user who has Mobility Features checked in IP Office Manager     With either internal and external twinning  users may be allowed to enter a twinned number  or may just be  able to activate deactivate the twinning function depending on administrative settings  Such user activation  can be achieved through deskphone buttons  Phone Manager or VoiceMail Pro        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 110  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     The following types of calls are eligible for twinning     Internal External  mobile   twinning twinning    Any internal call on a Call Appearance button       Internal or external calls transferred to the extension  Direct Dial calls to that extension   Hunt Group Calls   Calls forwarded from another extension   Line Appearance calls  configurable    Bridged Appearance calls  configurable    Coverage calls  configurable    Automatic Intercom calls    KK KK     lt        Returning transferred  held or park calls    Callback calls from the system  Transfer and Park  Return     Paging Calls    KIS  S LS LS LS LS LS LS LS LS LE LS    x x  X    Follow Me c
62.  Voice and Conferencing   e Program Function and Soft keys   e Night service button   e Voicemail and Voicemail on Toggle Button  e Line appearance keys   e Transfer to Voicemail    e Button Programming    Other Features    Telephone    Messages    Key Goes to Visual Voice   A new manager configuration option in IP Office 4 2 allows the messages key to initiate Visual Voice on  supported phones  on non supported phones the previous behavior will continue   This configurable option will  free the button programming required currently for Visual Voice     SMDR Output from IP Office   IP Office 4 2 can now provide SMDR  Station Message Detail Recording  call logging information direct from  the IP Office  As IP Office already has an IP based method for outputting Call Accounting records  CDR  or Call  Detail Recording   this has been further refined to output SMDR     The existing CDR tab has been renamed CDR SMDR  SMDR cannot be output at the same time as CDR        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 14  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Reversal of Operation  Outgoing Called Number Display    IP Office 4 0 changed the feature phone display for outgoing calls from the user dialed digits to the digits sent  to line  IP Office 4 2 reverses this change and the display for outbound external calls from the IP Office will be  the user dialed digits  Where the call is made using the directory feature the number from the directory will be  displayed a
63.  a call  The border  calling number  around the call status panel changes color to      indicate the status of the call   e Calling Number    The telephone number of the call originator  e Call Duration  The length of time that the has been in the    e Called Name state as indicated by the Call Status    The system user name or hunt group name   associated with the called number  e Notes   This area displays notes or information about  the call i e  when a call has been returned as  there was no answer from the extension it    e Called Number  The extension number the incoming call has been    routed to by the system  was transferred to  If annotation is attached  to the call  details are shown in the Notes  area     If a new call arrives  the call details panel will display the calls waiting to alert the operator and allow  answering of the call based on the Caller ID        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 186  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     e Directory Panel    Property    A Name   Number   Busy Status   Do Not Disturb Status   Login Status   Group Status       CustomerHelp  Absent Message   PAlNew Voice Mail Messages   Forwarding Status   Forward Unconditional   Forward On No Answer   Forward On Busy   Follow Me     Anne Webb  209   Idle   Off   Logged In    Out of Group    In Group  In Group    Forward Hunt Group Calls        The directory panel on the right shows information on following     e Directory entries    Including IP Off
64.  a single cable  able to drive the wallboards     In addition to the physical Spectrum wall mounted wallboard an IP Office license is required when being used  with CCC  This IP Office license supports 4 x Spectrum wall mounted wallboards  If more than 4 wall mounted  wallboards are required additional license keys must be purchased  each license key supports 4 wallboards at  a time      maximum of 16 wall mounted wallboards can be supported     Wallboard 22 IND DISP CCM WALLBRD 22 GB 700040173  Wallboard Manager Communications card IND CP CCM WALLBRD 700038854  IP 400 CCC Wallboard 4 RFA IPO LIC IP400 CCC WALLBRD 4 RFA LIC  176196   CU    License key required supporting 4 wallboards     PC Wallboard    The PC Wallboard delivers wallboard functionality to the contact center manager and contact center agent s  desktop  but with the benefit of each agent being able to configure and monitor a personalized view of the  contact center via their own PC wallboard  Supervisors can provide one template for all users in order to  standardize the view that agents obtain when starting PC Wallboard     A CCC agent is able to split their PC Wallboard into twenty  20  different variables that allow different  measures of groups and agents in real time  The data that is presented is identical to that of the physical  wallboard  Examples of this are Answered Calls  Longest Call Waiting  Agents logged in  and Lost Calls      re PC Wallboard    Bie Yew Sep Help  Of g       Number of sales agent
65.  achieved via a thin  client web browser session logged onto the IP Office Customer Call Reporter server  Within the supervisor  client a user can program up to 3 different views of their call center  This is a very useful feature as now a  supervisor can divide their responsibilities into different views and compare the results of those views     For example  assume that a call center supervisor is responsible for the following hunt groups in IP Office   Computer Sales  201   Monitor Sales  202   Warranty Service  203   and non Warranty service  The  Supervisor can create two separate views entitled    sales    and    service    and compare the number of calls   length of call  etc  This allows a supervisor to see a whole system as it relates to the business function  sales   service      The Supervisor views are private and can only be seen with a login  A view may be created that shows specific  Hunt Group and Agent statistics as well as Alarms and Warnings  Each of the three views are summarized and  made available to any Agents when they logon and select their corresponding Supervisor  An example of the  Supervisor real time view is shown below                                          09 33 Alarm HG502 35 Calls Waiting    09 33 Alarm HG500 57 65  Grade Of Service   09 33 Alarm HG510 2 Calls Waiting    09 33 Alarm HG503 11 12  Grade Of Service  9 33 Alarm HG510 10 91  Grade Of Service                               Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Pag
66.  after an IP Office VoIP installation  a copy of your network  assessment documentation will be requested by your support channel     For more details about available tools  resources and services to enable you to audit your network for VoIP  readiness  please contact your local Avaya representative        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 137  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        IP Packet Flow Control    While a high performance switch forwards data packets at full wire speed to and from its ports simultaneously   there may be times when a switch port may not be able to accept packets at the rate it is receiving them     For example  the switch port may be receiving packets from multiple ports at the same time  or the switch  port may be receiving packets from a port operating at a faster speed  For instance  the sending port might be  operating at 100 Mbps  while the receiving port operates at 10 Mbps  or the sending port might operate at  1000 Mbps  while the receiving port operates at 100 or 10 Mbps  If data packets arrive for a port that is  saturated with other packets  the packets may overflow the port s buffer  resulting in dropped packets and lost  data     Flow control is a congestion control mechanism that prevents data loss at congested ports  Flow control  prevents packet loss by controlling the flow of data from the transmitting device to ensure that the receiving  device can handle all of the incoming data     IEEE 802 3 flo
67.  analog  digital or any IP telephones  wired or  wireless  and is available in three versions  Phone Manager Lite  Phone Manager Pro and Phone Manager PC  Softphone subject to licensing     AVAYA Er             Title Bar   Phone Manager Pro  Anne Webb   Menu Bar  Tool Bar  Call Details Betty Edmunds Anne Webb  nga    otaa Messages oP  Number From Date  amp  Time  Call History 204 Betty Edmunds Anne Webb 07 Dec 2006 10 53 38  17 Anne Webb 17 07 Dec 2006 9 55 55  Voicemail Anne Webb Anne Webb 07 Dec 2006 9 55 43  203 Abbey Nortin CustomerHelp  Anne Wy 06 Dec 2006 16 46 17  207 Shander Lear CustomerHelp  Anne Wy 06 Dec 2006 16 46 10  Park Slots  Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 173    IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Phone Manager Lite       Phone Manager Lite is included as part of the IP Office solution free of charge for every user and provides easy  access to telephony features  call information and call control  Phone Manager will normally run in the Windows  system tray once the user is logged on  minimizing screen space when not in use     Caller ID Name Presentation    DES EST SERRE Ce eens LS E N     gt   204 Betty Edmunds Anne Webb       Caller ID is presented as standard  where provided  allowing users to see who s calling before answering  The  caller s phone number and name  if known to IP Office  are clearly shown in the call status area of the Phone  Manager screen  For incoming calls  the dialed destination is also visible
68.  and efficient generation of labels  free DESI printing software is available from    http   support avaya com  on the 1600 Phone Series page   This can be used to print all labels correctly  formatted on plain paper or available DESI labels  A PDF document with correct formatting can also be  downloaded     For customer environments requiring Gigabit Ethernet support  a Gigabit Ethernet adapter is available    providing 10 100 1000 Mbps support for both the 1600 series phone and co located laptop or PC     Note that with the 1600 series of phones  no Ethernet cable is included  If a cable is needed  it should be  ordered separately at the required length     The 1600 series phones are supported on IP Office from Release 4 2 Q4 2008 onwards        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 47  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     1603 IP Telephone    Communication  Manager       The Avaya 1603 supports 3 line appearances  Each of the buttons includes dual LEDs  red  green  providing  explicit status for the user  For a familiar look and feel  the 1603 includes several fixed feature keys for  common telephone tasks including conference  transfer  drop  hold  and mute  In addition  the 1603 includes a  2 way speakerphone  The display on the 1603 measures two lines by 16 characters and is backlit for easier  viewing in all lighting conditions     Common Features     Display Housing   o Backlit display   2 6    diagonal  2 rows by 16 characters   o Reversi
69.  are a way to put money back in your pocket     Eliminating conferencing fees     For connecting with partners  suppliers and dispersed employees  conference calls keep people working  together and keep travel costs down  Many companies rely on third party teleconferencing services and pay a  price for the convenience  This is particularly true   and irritating   if a call that   s scheduled doesn   t happen   you still pay the fee    Now there   s an alternative that will save you money  With Avaya IP Office  your organization can have its own  private  secure conference bridge and entirely eliminate fees to third party providers     Supporting multiple offices remote workers    When employees can   t get to the office  because of storms  medical issues or other reasons  but can still work  productively at home  your business benefits  IP Office Phone Manager lets you turn any PC into a phone   making it easy and productive to work anywhere  And the ability to network phone systems and share  messaging systems between offices reduces up front investment and drives long term productivity    And keep in mind       IP Office delivers a whole range of capabilities  Only you can put a number on the value that many of these  capabilities will have for your business   Examples     e Having calls automatically routed to a cell phone or other location  so important customers can get  through to the right person in real time    e Being able to operate as a 24 7 business  without a 24 
70.  be sent to a file on the PC  Both methods allow the details of calls to be sent  over an IP network to a TCP IP port     Third party applications use this data to allocate costs to departments  analyze trunk capacity  report usage  against account codes etc  One IP Office SMDR  Delta Server  is required for each site requiring the use of call  accounting software  Please refer to the Technical Specifications section for the Delta Server requirements     SMDR Diagnostics        end pepe pren fre       ane a 19 00 00 000 2110 215 215 1 6 0 E215 Ex215E215Exm2150 0  2004 10 19   Mo  07 47 07 00 00 00 0 Oo 1 1000 E 1 gee Eu  ful  2004 10 19 co  00 00 100 2151 215 215 0 6 0   Y9551ChannelE215Exm2150 0  07 46 56 1  2004 10 19 CO  00 00 091 2111 369 369 0 7 0 Y9551ChannelE2Z11Extn2110 0  07 46 54 1  2004 10 19 co  07 46 56 00 00 070 2111 95519551 oO 7 0 Y9551ChannelES69Exins690 O  46       Sample IP Office SMDR Information Output       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 268  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        System Status Application       The System Status Application  SSA  is a diagnostic tool for system managers and administrators to monitor  and check the status of IP Office systems locally or remotely  SSA shows both the current state of an IP Office  system and details of any problems that have occurred  The information reported is a combination of real   time events  historical events  status and configuration data to assist fault 
71.  calls     Avaya one X Mobile builds on the functionality of the IP Office 4 2 by providing a family of mobile clients  designed to further enhance the productivity of mobile workers  The family of Avaya one X Mobile clients  provides quick access to office phone functionality via an intuitive graphical user interface  The clients support  devices ranging from high end smart phones to lower end feature phones to support most business  environments  independent of the mobile devices deployed     This feature is only supported through the following trunk types on an IP Office 500   e IP500 PRI U  single or dual  daughter cards  e IP500 Dual or Quad BRI daughter cards  e SIP trunks  RFC 2833     e This feature requires one instance of the Mobility License as described below for each configured user     Mobile Twinning license now known as Mobility license   In IP Office 4 2 the existing Mobile Twinning license has been renamed to Mobility license  The license now  enables the use of Mobile Call Control and one X Mobile client features as well as Mobile Twinning  An instance  of the license will be consumed for every user who has Mobility Features checked in IP Office Manager     Mobile Twinning for Logged Out Users   In releases prior to IP Office 4 2  a user had to be logged in to an extension to use Mobile Twinning  IP Office  4 2 enables the user to logout from an extension and maintain a logical presence on the system through  Mobile Twinning  Logged Out includes the extensi
72.  cg Extn201  1  Extn202  1   BLF Panel  Park Slots   Status Bar  Connected   Profile  209   Missed Calls 37   DA New Messages  2       SoftConsole has been designed to be easy to use  while offering a look and feel  which will appeal to  experienced and novice operators alike        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 185  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     The SoftConsole screen is divided into the following areas     e Main Menu Bar    eee  LEUR LULOO    EEE    Commands and actions are available through menus  Some features can only be used when the right  conditions  If they are not available  the feature will be    grayed out    until conditions change that allow  the feature to be used  The following features are available on the tool bar     e Login  e Hang up    e Save Profile  e Page    e New call  e Record call    e Answer call  e Compact view    e Hold call  e Dial Pad    e Transfer call  e Access conference room 1   e Transfer complete  e Access conference room 2   e Reattempt transfer  e Options     e Conference     e Call Details Panel       Call Information    Calling Name  Betty Edmunds  Calling Number  204  Called Name  Anne Webb    Called Number  209  Call Status  Alerting   Incoming  Duration  00 02             The call details panel on the left shows details of the current call which will include the following    information    e Calling Name e Call Status  The system directory name associated with the States the progress of
73.  e Circuit Switched Data Call Basic call  ETS 300 171 172    e Calling Connected Line Identity Presentation  ETS 300 173   e Calling Connected Name Presentation  ETS 300 237 238    e Message Waiting Indication  ETS 301 260 255        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 155  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Messaging Networking    There are 2 options available today to provide messaging interoperability between IP Office and Definity    MultiVantage   ACM  The first option provides Centralized Voicemail while the second allows Avaya voicemail  systems to be networked  The requirements  functionality and restrictions are summarized below     e IP Office to DEFINITY   MultiVantage   ACM connected to Intuity AUDIX    over a QSIG link  E1 T1 or IP            Incoming Call  E1 T1 leased  line  or  IP Network 4        Communication  Manager with Intuity  AUDIX     IP  Connection     e No local Voicemail required on remote branch IP Office but AUDIX RFA required on every IP Office    e Requires Intuity Audix 4 4  connected via C LAN to DEFINITY 9 5   see IP Office Offer Announcement  dated August 2003 for more information on compatibility     e Maximum of 19 IP Offices can be supported on 1 INTUITY AUDIX    server  20 total with DEFINITY ACM  occupying one slot     e Requires QSIG and Private Networking licenses on DEFINITY   MultiVantage   ACM  e User mailbox with Message Waiting Light support   e Forward voicemails between users   e No auto attend
74.  e Lists can include voicemail boxes that exist on other Avaya voicemail systems that are available through  VoiceMail Pro Networked Messaging     e Lists can be added together  duplicate members are automatically removed  This includes public lists  owned by other voicemail subscribers     e Mailing lists are accessible to the user at any    send message    and    forward message    option within the  user s voicemail box     e When displayed within Phone Manager Pro  distribution lists can have a list description added to it  this  is only visible within Phone Manager Pro        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 214  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Cascaded Out Calling       VoiceMail Pro can send a notification  with an escalation capability  that a new voice message has been  received in a user s mailbox to specified phone number s   This is particularly useful in environments such as  healthcare and support where important voice messages are left and need to be answered promptly   even  outside of office hours     For example should a patient leave an important message to the main number of the doctor s office  the  voicemail system can ring the doctor at the office then on no response escalates to the doctor   s mobile cell  phone  his her home phone or the doctor on duty after a programmable timeout  This avoids having to rely on  an external answering service and allows mobile cell and home phone numbers to remain private     T
75.  e The ability to recover  or reclaim  the last call that was at your phone but is now ringing or is connected  elsewhere     Benefit  e If you just miss a call and it goes to voicemail or call coverage  you can get the call back while it is still  being presented or connected through IP Office    Description  This is a special version of the Acquire Call feature that only applies to the last call at your extension        Hunt Group Enable  Disable    Feature  e The ability for a user to enable or suspend their membership of Hunt Groups     Benefit  e A user may need to temporarily join or leave individual hunt groups  for example to cover a peak of  calls without changing the system programming     Description   A team supervisor or administrator may not usually take calls for a team but at times of high traffic they may  join the group to take calls and when the peak is over leave the group to resume their regular tasks  To use  this feature the User must be configured as a member of the Hunt Group by the systems administrator  it is  not possible for a User to arbitrarily join a Hunt Group that they have not been identified as a member of        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 106  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Call Waiting    A User may not want people calling them to receive busy tone if they are already on another call  but have the  call receive ring tone and have some kind of alert that there is a call waiting  The user can
76.  element of unified messaging and is particularly useful for group  voicemail boxes as it allows a single voicemail message to be copied to the email of every member in that  group        Inbox Microsoft Outlook   Steve Richards 2 5  x     Bie Edit View Favorites Tools Actions Help    en    amp  OF X SeRecly Reply toal Forward LA SendiRegeive   Brn organize CA             2a   D      From  Received    4 3 Colin Fri 23 02 2001 O8        Outlook Today n  gehin Thanks for your help  The Document is caled the Trainer s Classroom Set up doc     ts  Dave RE  Your Feedback Requested Fri 23 02 2001 08        looks good to me  Dave    Q PC voicemail Voicemail Message  Extn202 gt Extn201  From  Peter Jones Fri 23 02 2001 08 59  0 PC Voicemail Voicemail Message  Extn202 gt Extn201  From 0345385951 Fri 23 02 2001 09      Akchemy Voicemail redirected message Virus checked by AVP   lt end gt     1  PC Yoicemail Yoicemail Message  Extn202 gt Extn201  From  Adam Philpott Fri 23 02 2001 09      ich Voicemail redirected n oe Virus checked b   Le    Contacts          e    From  PC Voicemail To  Steve Richards  Subject  Voicemai Message  Extn202 gt Extn201  From 202 Cc     Tasks  E     A    SP MARRON MO oo eS      Notes    Deleted Items  23     AP Office Voicemail redirected message       Presentation of Voicemail to Email       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 203  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Unified Messaging Service  UMS        Unified Messaging S
77.  enables the operator to choose access to the following directories  SoftConsole local directory   IP Office system directory and Microsoft Outlook contacts  Once chosen  the operator is able to map  fields to directory entries     e Conferencing  This tab allows the operator to set up the names of the two conference rooms  The names will appear  on the telephone displays of users in the conference room  maximum of 10 characters      e Keyboard Mapping  This tab allows the operator to assign keyboard short cut keys for SoftConsole functions     e Keyboard Actions  This tab allows the operator to specify the default action when alphabetic or numeric characters are  pressed     e Alphabetic Keystrokes  Begin directory search or Open call annotation window  e Numeric Keystrokes  Begin directory search or Open pop up dial pad    e Appearance  This tab allows the operator to change the appearance of SoftConsole fonts  skins and the call  information window color     e SoftConsole  This tab allows the operator to save the changes made to the configuration of SoftConsole either  automatically or manually to a local configuration file on the PC        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 190  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        SoftConsole Administration       SoftConsole has an administration mode that enables the operator to configure the following settings     e Control panel views  The BLF panel  call history panel  held calls panel and park slot
78.  flip stand    e Fixed Buttons  15 plus Four way navigation cluster button     o Volume up down  separate volume levels for the handset  speaker  and ringer   Mute button  Speaker  button  Headset button     o Avaya Menu button  options and settings access   Telephony application button   to return to main  telephone screen     o Hold button  Conference button  Transfer button  Drop button   o Contacts button  Call log button  Redial button  quick access voicemail Message button   e Programmable Contextual buttons  11     o 8 line appearance feature key buttons   with dual LEDs  red  green  and paper labels  Printing tool  available      o Three contextual softkey buttons        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 50  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     e Key Labels  Icons used on fixed feature keys   e Speakerphone  High quality two way handsfree speaker and microphone     e Hearing Aid Compatible  Yes   ergonomic hearing aid compatible handset also supporting TTD acoustic  coupler     e Message Waiting Indicator  Yes   also used as ringing call alert indicator    e Personalized Ring Patterns  Yes   8    e Headset Socket  Yes    e Embedded Applications   o Contacts application  100  and Call Log  100  Missed  Incoming  Outgoing    o Access to company directory and Visual Voice applications on IP Office    e Upgradeable Firmware  Yes    e Expansion  None    e Color  Black     e Mounting  Desk or wall mountable with optional wall mount adapter  
79.  groups of Avaya IP telephones for firmware upgrade and maintenance purposes        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 10  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     User and Extension Auto Creation Enhancements  The auto creation feature for IP Phone users and extensions has been made consistent across phone types in  IP Office 4 2     Mobility Enhancements    Mobile Call Control   In IP Office 4 2  when a call to a user is delivered to an external number  due to External Mobile Twinning  the  user will be able to dial a DTMF sequence    star star  to put the call on hold and receive IP Office system dial  tone  The user will then be able to perform supervised and un supervised transfers  shuttle  switch between  held calls   and conference  Conference add and transfer to a meet me conference      This feature is only supported through the following trunk types on an IP Office 500   e IP500 PRI U  single or dual  daughter cards  e IP500 Dual or Quad BRI daughter cards  e SIP trunks  RFC 2833     e This feature requires one instance of the Mobility License as described below for each configured user     Avaya one X Mobile Client Support   IP Office 4 2 supports release 4 0 of the Avaya one X Mobile Client    Single Mode    operation  in conjunction  with mobile technology Symbian Single Mode Version 4 0 and Windows Mobile 6 technology  This provides a  graphical interface for call control and allows a one number service for both incoming and outgoing
80.  is an applications platform and includes a number of applications as part of the solution  These Lite  versions of applications do not require any additional licensing  but upgrades to Pro versions or optional  applications will need additional IP Office licenses to operate  The licensed applications require both a license  key  a unique number that enables the application to run  and a feature key  The feature key is an electronic  key installed on the IP Office system that determines which licensed applications can run     Licensed applications are supplied in two forms  time limited trial licenses and full indefinite licenses  Trial  licenses allow applications to run in fully functional form for 60 days  from the date of license generation    after which time they cannot be used until upgraded at cost to the full license but can be ordered at any time  during the product ownership     For further details of the IP Office licenses including Trial Licenses refer to the Licenses  297 section        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 22  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Chapter 2   IP Office Platform       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 23  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     2  IP Office Platform    IP Office is a modular communications solution that scales from 2 to 360 users  It provides a hybrid PBX with  both Time Division Multiplexing  TDM  and IP phone support that can be used in either mode or b
81.  longer  supported by Avaya  They may function but have not been tested with IP Office 4 2 and any faults reported  with IP Office 4 2 will not be fixed    2 Windows Small Business Server 2003 is supported for the same applications as Windows 2003 Server    3  Exceptions for VoiceMail Pro support   Integrated Messaging Pro  IMS  does not work on Windows Server 2008 or Windows Vista   Web Campaigns does not work on Windows Vista   Voicemail web access does not work on Windows XP or Windows Vista   Please refer to the Voicemail Installation and Administration manual    4 Although a server application  IP Office SMDR  Delta Server  can also run on a Windows 2003  Windows XP  and Windows Vista client Operating Systems  32 bit only  but should not be run on the same PC as a CCC  Delta Server    5 64 Bit versions of Microsoft client operating systems are not currently supported by IP Office applications    6  Integrated Messaging Pro  IMS  does not support IMS operation with Outlook 2003 2007 operating in cache  mode    7  Microsoft Exchange 2000 is no longer supported in IP Office 4 2        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 295  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Chapter 18   Licenses       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 296  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     18  Licenses    Many features on IP Office systems are licensed and only operate when a valid license is detected  This  includes features within IP O
82.  number of channels in use can be automatically reduced  If there is  no data traffic on any of the channels in use then all lines can be cleared  Since most carriers have a minimum  charge for calls  the period that a channel has to be idle before clearing is configurable  Through these  mechanisms call costs can be effectively controlled while ensuring that bandwidth is available as and when it is  needed        Frame Relay    Frame relay is a wide area networking protocol based on the X 25 protocol  Individual network connections are  multiplexed over a common medium by the use of Permanent Virtual Circuits  PVC   This allows a single  Leased Line to provide connectivity to a number of different locations  Frame relay is currently implemented in  IP Office as a CPE or  router end  protocol over WAN connections  IP Office supports both PPP and RFC1490  encapsulation with fragmentation of large data packets to provide voice quality of service        Service Quotas    IP Office can be configured to limit the maximum number of minutes that a service  such as Internet Access  is  available for each user  This is the sum total of calls made and does not include periods of inactivity  Once the  quota has been used the service is no longer available  The quota can be either automatically refreshed daily   weekly or monthly or manually refreshed by dialing a secure feature code on a handset        Time Profiles    Time profiles set the operational times for service  For example  a 
83.  of either using a power  supply or a PoE adapter     IP Telephone Power Consumption  Measured in Watts using an IEEE 802 3af power supply at 48V  This table shows the power consumption of the    phones currently shipping  Older versions of phones might have a different power requirement        Telephone Conservation Typical  Mode    5 0    4602SW  5602SW 2 4 1 N A   4610SW  5610SW 2 4 0 N A 6 0  4621SW  5621SW 2 4 9 N A 6 45  4625SW 3 7 8 N A 9 42  1603 2 4 32 3 75 5 10  1608 2 4 66 3 76 5 69  1616 2 3 17 2 83 3 65  Gig Adapter rs 3 16 N A 5 81       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 133  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Avaya Individual Power Supply   Avaya provides individual power supplies that can be used to power each IP phone which provides a single 48  volt output  The power supply can operate globally within a wide range of Alternating Current  AC  input  voltages  90   264 Volts Alternating Current  VAC   47 63 Hz  This power supply has a green indicator  LED   that shows the unit has power to the PHONE socket on pins 7 amp 8 of the CATS5 cable     This item is available in two different versions  with and without an internal battery for uninterrupted power to  the phone        1151 local power supply  without battery and with battery backup    Avaya Mid Span Power Distribution Units   These power devices are designed for IP telephony and provide power over Ethernet  PoE  for up to 24 IP  telephones or wireless LAN  WLAN  
84.  of extension cards and VCM cards    e Digital Station 8 card   e Phone 2 and Phone 8 cards   e VCM 32 and VCM 64 cards   Optional trunk daughter card support    e Analog Trunk Module 4 card   e BRI 4 and BRI 8 cards  2 x 2B D and 4 x 2B D channels respectively    e Single and Dual Universal PRI cards   Support for IP400 trunk and VCM cards using a Legacy Card Carrier   Slot for smart card Feature Key   required for system operation as well as licensing of optional features   9 pin DTE Port for maintenance    Support for up to 8 IP500 Expansion Modules  requires upgrade to Professional Edition    e Phone modules  8  16  30    e Digital Station modules  16  30    e Analog Trunk Module 16   e BRI So8 module   e IP400 expansion modules  not WAN3 10 100 or Network Alchemy modules    External O P socket supporting two relay on off switch ports  e g  for door entry systems   Audio input port for external music on hold source    48 Data channels   Up to 30 VoiceMail Pro ports   Two 10 100 switched Ethernet ports  Layer 3      Lad Slots        FJ a    1 2 3 4                   DTE      Feature Ka Status LED s Reset noae Expansion ports for  Power supply card slot 4 switch E IP400 Expansion  socket    Slot for embedded xtema Modules  volcemail memor music on hold USB Fort  card  input  Not used   External output LAN Ports  switch  for example LAN   LANT  door relays   WAN  LAN2  Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 25  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009    
85.  of numbering schemes are  commonly deployed    Linked Numbering  and  Node Numbering  schemes  In linked numbering schemes each  site within the network has a unique range of extension numbers and users simply dial the extension number  of the called party  Often  linked numbering schemes are used in very small networks   lt  5 sites  with less  than 500 extensions  With node numbering schemes each site is given a node ID and this is prefixed by the  user when dialing extensions at other sites  In this way extension numbers can be replicated across sites while  still appearing unique across the network  Node numbering schemes are common in larger networks  Linked  numbering schemes and node numbering schemes are sometimes both used within the same network with  node numbering used at the large offices and linked numbering employed at clusters of satellite offices     The following figures depict these two types of numbering schemes        Linked Numbering Scheme       Node Numbering Scheme       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 159  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 160  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Chapter 7   Data Networking Services       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 161  P Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     7  Data Networking Services       LAN WAN Services       Computers connected to an IP network in an office communica
86.  panel can be hidden or made visible     e Change the Administrator password    e Edit operator profiles  Each operator can have a personalized profile  which can be configured by the administrator     e Create and modify templates  SoftConsole comes with three predefined templates  which can be modified  or new templates can be  created     e Specify the maximum length of call notes  IP Office supports a wide range of different telephone types  These have different display sizes so the  operator can define the character length of messages sent to each user according to the type of phone  they use     e System Tray working  The application can be minimized and left running in the system tray so that it can pop on received calls     SoftConsole Telephone Requirements  e SoftConsole provides extensive call management  but it still requires an IP Office telephone to provide  the speech path  SoftConsole has been tested and is certified to work with all Avaya wired digital and IP  phones that are listed in chapter 4     e SoftConsole cannot be used with IP DECT 3700 series telephones        SoftConsole PC Requirements       e IP Office software release 2 0 or later   e PC requirements     e Always refer to the latest Avaya SMB Technical Tip or Technical Bulletin for any updated information  with regard to Operating Systems  Service Packs or PC hardware    e Refer to Technical Specifications section of the Product Description for Operating System and  Hardware requirements    e A 
87.  programmers to perform actions such as playing and recording messages        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 301  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     e   Voicemail Pro Networked Messaging License  IPO LIC IP400 NTWKD MSGING RFA LIC DS   182297   Voicemail Pro Networked Messaging  VPNM  can be used between separate IP Office systems  each  with their own Voicemail Pro server  to exchange messages left for different mailboxes  This option  is not supported within an SCN network but can be used between separate SCN networks     e   Integrated Messaging License  IPO LIC IP400 INTG MSGING PRO RFA LIC DS  171990   The Integrated Messaging Server component of Voicemail Pro allows integration between users  voicemail mailbox and their Outlook email mailbox via a Microsoft Exchange server  Note that use  of IMS is not supported on IP Office systems using UMS  see above      Trial Licenses    The following trial licenses can be requested  Each is valid for 60 days from the date of issue and can only be  issued once for a particular Feature Key serial number  Apart from that restriction the trial license works the  same as a full license     e   VMPro Networked Messaging  IPO TRIAL NTWKD MSGING RFA LIC DS  189776     e   VMPro Database Interface  IPO TRIAL 3RD PRTY IVR RFA LIC DS  189777     e   VMPro TTS  ScanSoft   IPO TRIAL AVAYA TTS RFA 1 LIC CU  189778     e   VMPro VB Script  IPO TRIAL VB SCRIPTING RFA LIC DS  189779     e   Conferencing Center
88.  ring type    Vibrate alert    Redial Button    Base Unit and Charger Unit     The Avaya 3810 Wireless Telephone is a digital telephone designed to work with IP Office from release 2 0 and  above by connecting to a Digital Station  DS  port  It offers the mobility inherent in a wireless telephone plus  access to a number of features and functionality of the connected communications system     A maximum of 5 Avaya 3810 wireless handsets can be connected to the same IP Office in any overlapping  radio coverage area     This phone is only available in the USA and Canada        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 82    IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     The Avaya 3810 is delivered as a single unit containing     Base Unit    Handset    Telephone Cord    Base Unit Power Supply Adapter   Charging Stand Power Supply Adapter   Rechargeable Battery    Belt Clip    Charging Stand    User and Installation Guide     Wall Plate Adapter        Rechargeable    2 AC Adapters Battery    Beltclip       Charger Unit Wall Mount Stand       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 83    IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        VPN Phone Software    VPN Phone is a full featured IP Telephony solution that provides secure communication over public ISP  networks to an IP Office system at the company headquarters     It is a software only product that runs on the standard 5610 5620 5621 or 4610 21 IP telephones  In  combination with one o
89.  single data channel since they all share the  same line to the ISP  Two people remotely accessing the Office LAN from home will use two data channels  since they have dialed in on separate lines  IP extensions do not use data channels  Data channels are used for  voicemail connections with a maximum of 20 available for VoiceMail Pro on an IP406 V2     Modems and Voice Compression modules    You can add additional hardware to the IP406 system to add one modem card  2 or 12 V 90 modems  and 1  Voice Compression Module  VCM   The VCM supports from 4 to 30 simultaneous Voice over IP sessions and is  used for either providing networking between sites over a Wide Area Network or supporting IP Telephones and  Soft phones        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 309  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        IP400 WANS 10 100    The IP400 WAN3 10 100 module provides three WAN connections  X21  V35 or V24 via a 37way D Type  socket and using an appropriate connector cable   Data rates of up to 2 Mbps are supported on each interface   the carrier providing the line dictates the actual operating speed i e  in some territories the maximum speed  may be limited to 1 544 Mbps  These WAN interfaces are identical to the single WAN connection provided as  standard on the IP406 and IP412 platforms        The IP400 WAN3 10 100 connects to the control unit through the Local Area Network via a 10 100Mbps  connection and does not use an expansion port on the control
90.  speeds up to 2048kbps  Point to Point protocol  PPP  is used over this  link  The data within the call uses the Point to Point Protocol  PPP  which is used by the vast majority of  manufacturers for linking routers  PPP support is essential if it is not the same manufacturer s equipment at  each end of the link  Addition WAN ports can be added using up to two WAN3 10 100 external expansion  modules  On Small Office Edition systems a single option WAN port card can be added  IP500 systems do not  support this type of port     Exchange lines  Central Office  can also be used in the event of failure of the WAN link or to provide alternate  or top up bandwidth on demand     All IP Office systems have an integral router with support for bandwidth on demand that allows the negotiation  of extra bandwidth dynamically over time  Where connection is over ISDN  IP Office initiates extra data  connections between sites only when there is data to be sent or sufficient data to warrant additional channels   It then drops the extra channels when they are no longer needed  The calls are made automatically  without  the users being aware of when calls begin or end  The rules for making calls  how long to keep calls up etc  are  configurable within IP Office     It is possible to have several different routing destinations or paths active at any time linking the office to  other offices and the Internet simultaneously        Internet Access       While the telephone is still the number one bu
91.  supported only between IP Offices that are connected  either directly on a WAN port or via the LAN using a 3rd Party router  IPSec is optional and enabled on IP  Office through a License Key     Note  Check with Avaya for supported scenarios and 3rd party devices        VPN  Layer 2 Tunneling Protocol    PPP via L2TP        Public Internet    PPP authentication using PAP or CHAP takes place between directly connected routers only  When using a  public IP Network to connect sites this authentication takes place between the customers router and the  service provide router that it is connected to  In some circumstances it is desirable to authenticate between  the customer owned routers  jumping over all the intermediary routers of the service provide network  Layer 2  Tunneling Protocol allow this to happen by facilitating a two stage authentication  firstly with the service  provider router then the customer router on the remote network        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 170  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 171  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Chapter 8   Phone Manager       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 172  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     8  Phone Manager    The IP Office Phone Manager application provides users control of their telephone from a networked PC     Phone Manager can be used with any IP Office extension 
92.  the Conferencing Center Web Client  voting results for each  participant would be shown for each question asked during the conference call     Participant Details  SS Stotus E tot    be    20 02 2004 16 20 52  Pater Speak And Listen 20 02 2004 16 29 54 20 02 2004 16 58 00  Sarah Listen Only 20 02 2004 16 49 54 2004 16 55 44  Philippe Speak And Listen 20 02 2004 16 41 00 20 02 2004 16 59 14  Diana Listen Only 20 02 2004 16 51 07  Andres Speak And Listen 20 02 2004 16151139    Questions Ralsed    Please vote for acceptance of Mr Smith as Marketing Director  Votes Recorded    andrew    John       Philippe       In summary  the Conferencing Center Web Scheduler offers the following   e Web based booking tool to reserve conference resources  immediate or future    e Ability to select    Listen only    or    Speak and Listen    mode for each participant   e Email notification to all participants   e Voice Conference Notification  VCN  to dial out participants   e Participants name announcements as they enter leave the conference bridge   e Unique computer generated Conference ID for security   e Unique PIN code for each participant for security and authentication     e Web based reports on conference usage and voting results        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 237  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Conferencing Center Web Client    To complement the audio conference  the host has the ability to share information over the Internet  The We
93.  the caller the option to opt out of  the queue and leave a message at any time if desired           Voremail Fro    fe GR Atios Adunita bp  WR  28  2      Ci  Specie Stat Pore     Users  Greet     gt  Stot Code   a    recovers cal      Desk Sta Points  4 Collect  2 Laye  2 Calback     ous       500       we  Noose        2 MOLE    a a A E M    Delouk Stat Points  gt  Queued                  Ballad       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 259    IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Chapter 14   Management Utilities       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 260  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     14  Management Utilities    This section gives an overview of the management applications that are common to all IP Office platforms     e IP Office Manager 26   IP Office s main configuration tool        e Monitor  265  A trace utility for trouble shooting     e SNMP  266  Alerts and alarms from IP Office systems to SNMP tools or to SMTP email     e CDR  Outputs call detail records direct to an attached printer or separate PC     e IP Office SMDR  268  Outputs station message detail records  SMDR  for off switch processing           e System Status Application  SSA   26   Outputs call detail records for off A diagnostic tool to monitor and check the status of IP Office systems           Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 261  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        IP Office Manager   
94.  then decide to finish  or hold the current call and answer the one that is waiting  The amount of information that is available about  the call that is waiting depends on the type of phone the user has  or if they are using Phone Manager     As Call waiting tone can be disruptive it is possible to turn the feature on or off and even suspend it for a  single call   useful for conference calls        Do Not Disturb  DND     This is the ability to temporarily stop incoming calls ringing at a user s telephone  It will prevent the user from  receiving Hunt Group calls and give direct callers either voicemail  if enabled  or a busy signal  This feature  can be enabled disabled from the phone or via the Phone Manager application     It is possible to have some calls bypass the DND setting and ring the phone  For example a manager might  have their secretary   s extension number on the DND exceptions list  The exceptions list can be easily managed  by the Phone Manager application  Both internal and external numbers can be on the exception list        Dial Plan    IP Office has a very flexible numbering scheme for extensions  hunt groups and feature commands  While the  system has default numbering for feature codes and extensions  they can all be re defined  Default extensions  and hunt groups have 3 digit numbers starting at 200 but these can be changed from 2 to 9 digits through the  IP Office Manager application  There is a default set of feature access    short codes     but th
95.  to speech is supported using MAPI     In both cases above  full email sending from the server PC to users PC should be configured and tested before  VoiceMail Pro installation using the same PC user account under VoiceMail Pro will be installed     IMS Pro Connection  IMS requires the Voicemail server to use MAPI     e Integrated Messaging Pro  IMS  is supported on Microsoft Exchange 5 5  2000 and 2003        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 224  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     e An Exchange User account for user  IMSAdmin  will be needed to as part of IMS installation   e Must be a member of the same Domain as VoiceMail Pro Server     e A list equating Exchange User account names with voicemail box users        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 225  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Voice Recording Library Management    IP Office Voice Recording Library  VRL  application is IP Office ContactStore  This application and its installation  are documented separately  However     e Avaya ContactStore for IP Office should be installed after VoiceMail Pro has been installed and its  operation verified     e Avaya ContactStore for IP Office must use a separate hard disk partition for its message archiving from  that used by VoiceMail Pro for current mailbox messages  Use of a separate hard disk or installation  onto a separate server PC are alternatives     e The use of RAID 1 or RAID 5 are recommended   e Th
96.  unit  Small Office Edition and IP500 do not  support the WAN3 10 100  All other platforms support up to two WAN3 10 100 modules     AVAYA IP400 WAN 3    WAH Link Status LEDs Unit Status LED LAH Port  Red   Starting  Conects to control unit LAN port   Green   Started OK  Green LED On   Connected     Yellow LED On   Activity        DC Power Input Socket DTE Serial Port WAH Ports  To external power supply 25 pin D type socket  37 way D type sockets   unit        IP400 So8 Expansion Module    The IP400 So8 module provides 8 S Bus interfaces for Basic Rate ISDN devices  such as video conferencing   fax servers or ISDN telephones           BRI S Ports Unit Status LED  Red   Starting   Green   Started OK     EXPANSION       DC Power Input Socket DTE Serial Port Functional To IP Office Control Unit   To external power supply 25 pin D type socket  Grounding  unit  Point    The IP Office So8 expansion module supports both point to point and point to multipoint connections  A  maximum of 10 terminal endpoints identifiers  TEIs  are supported on each bus        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 310  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Small Office Edition    The IP Office   Small Office Edition is the entry level control unit of the IP Office solution and is delivered in a  compact configuration that provides a mix of Analog trunks  Analog and Digital extensions and Voice over IP   VoIP  capacity  Dependant on the model chosen  up to a maximum of 28 
97.  users  Inactivity  timeout and return to operator options ensure efficient message handling  Mailbox users can also access their  mailboxes when out of office using a simple remote login sequence     Up to 40 independent auto attendants can be configured on the platform  These may be linked together to  form multiple tiers of attendants  The choice of which auto attendant is to answer a call can be made on any of  the criteria on the Incoming Call Routing form such as called number  calling number and time of day     Ua Avaya IP Office Manager  Edit View Tools Help    i IPOffice_2    Auto Attendant  amp  Out of Hours   IP Offices Auto Attendant   ay RAS  1  Name  Incoming Call Route  2  8 Out of Hours   4 WanPort  1   lt      m Directory  0      2  Time Profile  3    D Firewall Profile  1    Auto Attendant  Actions   _    Out of Hours       IP Route  0  Key Action Destination    Normal Transfer Main  Normal Transfer 201 Extn201  Normal Transfer 201 Extn201  Replay Greeting   Not Defined   Not Defined   Not Defined   Not Defined   Not Defined   Not Defined   Not Defined   Not Defined    NE Least Cost Routing  0   M Account Code  0   Wy Licence  0    Fa Tunnel  0      a Logical LAN  0      a User Rights  8    x  Auto Attendant  1   ae Authorization Code  0   fx E911 System  0         CO CO  J OU O1  amp  LU NN                  Received BOOTP request for 00016cdb335a  unable to process       Each auto attendant has a single menu of 12 items  0   9        that a caller can selec
98.  users will be prompted for a mailbox number and a PIN code for  that mailbox  before they can listen to voicemail  Users have the ability to set and change their own PIN codes     Where a voicemail needs to be copied to other users  VoiceMail Lite provides many options   e Voicemails can be forwarded to another mailbox  or group of mailboxes  e Recipients can add their comment to the voicemail before forwarding to another mailbox or mailboxes     e Voicemails can be forwarded as email WAV attachments        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 198  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     VoiceMail Lite telephony user interface  TUI  only operates in IP Office mode  not INTUITY mode   Note  On the IP500  VoiceMail Lite is only supported after upgrading to IP Office Professional Edition        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 199  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Embedded Voicemail        IP500  IP406 V2 and IP Office   Small Office Edition only     In environments like retail or home office  where space  noise or cost considerations rule out using a PC for  voicemail  Embedded Voicemail will be the preferred option for an entry level voicemail service  With the Small  Office Edition Embedded Voicemail makes use of the voice compression resources to optimize the message  storage by compressing messages before storing  and expanding them during playback  By doing this up to 10  hours of messages can be stored f
99.  wav file 102  181  218  waveform 218  Web 6  19  71  174  216  217  218  224  233  254  Logged 238  web address 233  Web Chat 238  Web Client 233  238  Web Client offers 238  Web Scheduler 233  238  Web Server 218  224  238  Web Server Operation 224  Web site 19 71  website URL 238  Week Planner 201  WEP 75 78  whats 129  What s New 10  Whisper Announce 201  220  Wide Area 32  37  69  150  162  166  167  Wide Area Expansion 150  Wide Area Network 32  69  162  167  Wide Area Networking Protocol 166  Width 80  287  WiFi 21  46  72  75  76  77  78  79  98  wildcards 10  Wink Start 143  WINS 165  Wire 18  41  46  64  65  66  72  75  78  125  129   138  173  180  191  252       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 342  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       Wire 18  41  46  64  65  66  72  75  78  125  129   138  173  180  191  252  closet switch 133  wire speed 138  Wired Equivalent Privacy 75  78  Wireless 6  18  21  22  40  42  46  68  69  71  72   75  82  98  100  129  133  173  180  182  273  290  Wireless Access Points 21  72  273  Wireless Module 290  Wireless Telephones 22  46  68  71  72  75  82  98  Wireless VolP 22  Within Compact Contact Center 254  Within SoftConsole 185  WLAN 72 133  WLAN Compatibility List    72  Word 238  254  workflow 201  workforce 206  workgroup 79  workgroups 20  254  World 89  129  162  Rest 231  WorldCom 143  worlds companies    LANs 129  World Wide Source  Crystal Training 254  Worst Case 133  
100.  with BM32 if needed   5621 4621SW with EU24  5420 2420 with  EU24     e Executive  5621 4621SW  5420 2420  4625SW       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 46  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        1600       Avaya one X is a portfolio of communications solutions that deliver a powerful and consistent communications  experience for the end user   across a variety of devices and interfaces  Avaya one X solutions provide  Intelligent Access to Intelligent Communications driving enhanced productivity and competitive advantage     Avaya one X Deskphone Value Edition is a family of cost effective IP Telephones designed especially around  the needs of the Small and Medium Business customer     Designed with the reliability you expect from Avaya  oneX Deskphone Value Edition telephones provide critical  features and capabilities not often found in competitively priced models     The family of 1600 phones consists of three models  designed around different user needs     e The 1603 phone is designed for the Walk Up user and basic Everyday user  For a Walk Up scenario  the  1603 is used in locations such as common areas in offices  stockrooms  lobbies  or drop in desks  Users  can be building visitors  employees  or even customers who need a phone with a simple  familiar  interface     e The Avaya 1608 IP Telephone is designed for the Everyday user  Everyday users typically rely on  several forms of communication including voice and email   and while 
101.  worldwide  Further product information available from www equisys com    e Captaris   RightFax  RightFax offers a broad  scalable product line that integrates with email  desktop  CRM  ERP  document  management  imaging  archival  call center  copier scanner systems  as well as host  legacy and  mainframe applications virtually all business applications  Further product information available from  www captaris com    e Fenestrae   Faxination  Fenestrae Faxination Server for Microsoft Exchange integrates fax into email technology  Create faxes  on your desktop and deliver them to your chosen fax machine at the click of a mouse  Further product  information available from www fenestrae com    e GFI   GFI FaxMaker  GFI FaxMaker for Exchange SMTP allows users to send and receive faxes and SMS text messages  directly from their email client  It integrates with Active Directory and therefore does not require the  administration of a separate fax user database  GFI FAXmaker integrates via the SMTP POP3 protocol  with Lotus Notes and any SMTP POP3 server  Further product information available from www gfi com    e Castelle Fax  Faxes routed to a user s mailbox by Castelle fax servers will be recognized by VoiceMail Pro as faxes   and will be supported by VoiceMail Pro Fax features        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 206  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Email Reading  Microsoft Exchange only        In addition to providing a unified mailb
102. 0  INTUITY Mode 198  206  207  208  215  Intuity TUI 220  Invited 185  IP Address Assignment 55  56  58  60  64  65  66  IP application  LAN 135  IP Authentication Header 291  IP DECT 3700 191  IP DECT Capacities 69  IP DECT IPO STARTER KIT 69  IP DECT System 69  IP DECT Telephone 69  80  81  IP DECT Wireless Handset 98  IP Encapsulation Security Payload 291  IP extension calling 278  279  IP Extensions 21  132  278  279  IP Hard Phone 129  IP Office Management Utilities 261    IP Office Manager 21  25  103  107  113  118  143   168  207  213  214  217  224  232  262  267  269    IP Office PC SoftPhone 182    IP Office Phone Manager application maintains  118    IP Office Phone Manager Lite 232  IP Office Phone Modules 41    IP Office Professional Edition 25  198  201  220   231  233  273    IP Office Professional Edition Upgrade 25    IP Office Small Community Networking 102  103   105  107  109  118  152    IP Office Standard Edition 25  231  278  IP Office stores  list 114  IP Office Support Fax 137  IP Office Supports 137  169  IP Office Time Profiles 10  217       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 329    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       IP Office Voicemail Pro CD 224    IP Office Voicemail Pro Intuity Audix Emulation  Features 220    IP Office VoIP 137  IP Offices 147   IP Office s Directory   IP Office s list 114  IP Offices Transit Network Selection 143   IP Office s WAN 150   IP Packet 138  150   IP Packet Flow Cont
103. 0 programmable dialing buttons and the 6221 phone adds a built in  speakerphone with mute capability     Analog Telephone Features BTE 6219 6221    Programmable buttons  10 buttons  A d  Program Keylock   A   ve EU EE     Pause  Pause VX          Real M AE RC AE RC EE  Speaker     Speaker MK O F  Sysco Hold      a ooo   Ringing Patterns  2    Y   X   X    Personalized Ringing O X   O 7  Desk Wall Mount   Y   Y _   Y    pa te ee  Colors  en ed   M   0      RS     5       DTMF Dialing M     F  a 7    aM  BAY    sis      S          Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 90    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Interquartz Gemini Phones  EMEA and APAC     Avaya have tested the new generation Interquartz Gemini analog telephones with IP Office to ensure that  telephone and system are compatible  The Gemini phones offer good value for money without compromising  on quality  Their stylish design and rugged build quality make them a popular choice for buyers on a limited  budget     For sales enquiries and product information contact Interquartz at avaya enquiries interquartz co uk     Basic telephone 9330 AV       e Visual Message Waiting Indication    e Locking mute button with LED indicator    e Last number redial    e Recall button    e Ringer volume adjust    e Ringer indicator light    e Wall mountable   no additional bracket required   e Hearing aid compatible     e Rubber feet to minimize slippage       Product Description    2009 AVAYA Al
104. 00 System Unit  IEC AC inlet socket  100 240V AC  50 60Hz  81 115VA  2 5A  maximum     e Power Supply Units  All CE UL Dentori Safety Approved     e Standard 40W Power Supply Unit  All control and expansion units unless otherwise indicated   Supplied with the control or expansion unit  40W PSU with integral lead to the unit  Connection to  switched mains supply requires separately supplied country specific IEC 60320 C7 power cord   2 wire figure 8 connector      e Input  100 240V AC  50 60Hz  81 115VA  2A maximum   e Output  24Vdc  1 875A  output power 45W maximum        Product Description       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 288  IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     e Small Office 45W Power Supply Unit  Supplied with the unit  45W PSU with integral lead to control unit  Connection to switched mains  supply requires separately supplied country specific IEC 60320 C13 power cord  3 wire earthed  cold kettle lead      e Input  100 240V AC  50 60Hz  81 115VA  1 5A maximum   e Output  24V DC  1 875A  output power 45W maximum     e IP406 V2 60W Power Supply Unit  Supplied with the control or expansion unit  60W PSU with integral lead to the unit  Connection to  switched mains supply requires separately supplied country specific IEC 60320 C13 power cord   3 wire earthed cold kettle lead      e Input  100 240V AC  50 60Hz  81 115VA  2 5A maximum   e Output  24V DC  1 5A  output power 60W maximum     e IP Office 500 80W internal Power Supply  Integral to the System Un
105. 01  211  220  282   Visual Basic Scripts 220   Visual Message Waiting Indication 91   Visual Voice 104  200  201  220   Visual Voice NOT 104   VLAN 55  56  58  60  64  65  66   VM 116  254   VM Call Flow Monitor 254   VM Summary 254   Voice Call 120  136  155   Voice Communication Solution 18   Voice Communication Solution Features 18    Voice Compression 21  27  32  36  69  131  132   135  137  147  150  200  273  279    Voice Compression Module 32  36  131  132  135   137  150  273    Voice Conferencing Notification 233  Voice encoding 78  273   Voice encoding G711 75   Voice Forms Questionnaire Mailboxes 201  Voice Mail 6  80  81  116  185  215   Voice Messaging 18    Voice Networking 22  25  Voice Networking Licenses 10  Voice Priority Processors 72  voice processing 195  Voice Recording 109  201  217  Voice Recording Library 224  Voice Recording Library Management 224  Voice Recording Library    218  voice samples  telephone 135  voice traffic 72  135  137  164  VoiceDirector 143  Voicemail 10  20  21  22  25  32  58  60  94  100   103  104  106  107  108  109  110  113  115  116   122  123  125  126  132  135  141  153  155  164   174  177  181  185  198  206  207  208  209  210     211  212  214  215  216  217  218  219  224  230   232  233  259  262  266  269  273  283  284  287    alter 121   comment 198   control 200  201   distribute 214   Email 203   Forwarding 201  203   Hunt Groups 220   Individual 220   Interaction 203   IP500 200   listen 198   PC 200   routed
106. 09 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 153  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Small Community Networking   Advanced Networking Features    IP Office R4 0 allows a number of additional feature to be enabled by addition of an Advanced Small  Community Networking license  Those features are     e Distributed Hunt Groups  Hunt groups can include users located on other IP Office systems within the network     e Remote Hot Desking  Users can hot desk between IP Office systems within the network  The system on which the user  configured is termed their  home  IP Office  all other systems are  remote  IP Offices  To log on at a  remote IP Office requires that IP Office to have an Advanced Small Community Networking license  A  license is not necessary on the user s home IP Office     e Breakout Dialing  This feature allows the user to select an IP Office system in the network from a displayed list and then  dial a subsequent number as if dialing locally on the select system  This feature is triggered either by a  programmable button or short code     Note that both Distributed Hunt Groups and Remote Hot Desking are not supported for use with CCC     The Advanced Small Community Networking license is required in every IP Office site where remote workers  are expected to hot desk to as well as on every site where members are included in distributed groups        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 154  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Interne
107. 1        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 311  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     IP Office   Small Office Edition 4T 4A 8DS  3 or 16 VoIP   The IP Office   Small Office Edition 4T 4A 8DS provides     e Four Analog Loop Start Trunks  Caller ID enabled      e Four Analog extension  POT  ports with power fail switchover such that analog trunk port 2 is connected  to analog extension port 1     e Eight Digital Station  DS  ports for selected 2400  5400 and 6400 phones plus 3810 wireless  US   phones  T3 Series phones are not supported from Release 4 0 onwards on Small Office Edition     e 3 or 16 VoIP Codecs  G 723 1  G 711 and G 729a  and 48ms echo cancellation   e 4 Switched Ethernet ports  Layer 2     e Dedicated Switched Ethernet WAN port  Layer 3     e 2 x PCMCIA Slots for optional Wireless and Embedded Voicemail card support   e Expansion Slot for optional WAN card  V35 V24 X 21   BRI or Ti PRI    e Serial DTE port    e Audio input port for external music on hold source     e External O P socket supporting two relay on off switch ports  e g  for door entry systems     8 x Digital Station Ports    AVAYA IP Office   Small Office Edition  3 ANALOG 4 DS1 2    em BR       1 ANALOG 2 POT1 2 4 LAN1 2          4x Analog 4x Analog 4 x Switched Ethernet WAN Port  Trunk Ports Extension LAN Ports  at default LAN2   Ports  POT   Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 312    IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     DC Power DTE
108. 1  273  278  279  290    Analog digital 135   ANI 143  181  218   ANLG 27   Announcements   220  233  252  Queuing 259   ANSI T1 401  conform 143   ANSI T1 607 290   Answer Interval 116   Answered Calls 185  258   Anti Tromboning 153   AOC 126  143   APAC 68  69  91  98   Appearance 10  94  110  112  113  190   Appearance Buttons 112  113   Appearance Keys    107  115  158    6  10  121  122  198  200  201     Twinning 10  appearance feature 46  62  85  86  87  Applicable 30  110  119  213  217    Application Level Gateway 147       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 319  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       Applications Platform 20  22  Applications Platform Features 20  ARP   receiving 168  ARS 107  115  158  Assisted Transfer 201  220    Audio 10 25  32  64  65  66  72  107  131  132   136  138  180  201  218  229  230  233  238  273   290    Audio Codec 136   Audio CODECS 138   Audio Conferencing 229   Audio Volume 64  65  66   Audio waveform 218   audio conference 238   Audiotex 201   Audit 137  262   AUDIX RFA 155   August 34  155   August 2003 155   Australia 277   Austria 277   Authorization Codes 114   Auto Attendant Properties  Transfer 10   Auto Attendants on Embedded Voicemail 10   Auto Connect 168   Auto Connect Time Profile 168   auto attendant offers 209   Auto Attendant Audiotex 220   Auto Create Extensions 132   Automatic Call Distribution 123   Automatic Callback 102   Automatic Intercom 110   Automatic IP 1
109. 16 port expansion modules  ATM16   The first two trunks on the ATM16  are automatically switched to power fail sockets in the event of power being interrupted  They conform  to the TIA EIA 646 B standard  The loop start trunks also support incoming caller line identification   ICLID  conforming to GR 188 CORE and GR 31 CORE standards  IP Office can use this information to  route calls or provide it to computer applications to display additional information about the caller     e Ground Start  Ground Start trunks are only available on the ATM16  configured through IP Office Manager  The first  two trunks on the module are automatically switched to power fail socket in the event of power being  interrupted  They conform to ANSI T1 401 and TIA EIA 646 B standards  Not available in all territories     E1R2 Channel Associated Signaling  Provided by the IP400 PRI E1R2 and IP500 Universal PRI cards     The IP400 PRI E1R2 cards are available in two versions supporting either RJ45 or coax network connections   Each card provides channels that can be configured for MFC  Pulse or DTMF dialing dependent on the  requirements of the network        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 146  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Session Initiation Protocol  SIP        IP Office 4 0  introduces SIP trunking  SIP trunks allow IP Office users to take advantage of new telephony  services being offered by    Internet Telephony Service Providers  ITSPs      In many c
110. 17  147  150  231  233  266   273  4601 133    Exchange SMTP   GFI FAXmaker 206  executing   Acquire Call 123  Executive Wireless 98  Exit Queue 220  Expansion 10  21  24  25  27  32  37  39  40  41   42  43  55  56  58  60  62  67  86  87  143  266  269   273  278  279  287  Expansion Cards 273  Expansion Module Digital Station 30 273  Expansion Module Phone 30 273  expansion module provides 39  43  Expansion Modules 21  25  32  39  40  41  42  43   60  67  86  87  266  273  287  Expansion Units 287  expiry 10  Explicit Call Transfer 143  Explicit iV 291  Exporting 262  Extended Callback Control Protocol 167  Extended CBCP 167  Extended Personal 201  213  220  Extended Personal Greetings 201  213  Extension Activity 253  EXTENSION NUMBER 262  extension offering mobility 180  extension VCM 273    External 37  External Bell 290  External Call 103  107    External Control 125  External Control Port 125  External Expansion Modules 37  273  ExternalNumber 116  122  143  174  200  External O P 25  32  External Participants 231  External Systems 177  Forward Emails 220  External Transferred Account Code 254  Extn Login 126  Extn Logout 126  extranet 238  Extreme Alpine Series 132  Extreme Alpine Series switches 132  Extreme Networks 132     F   failover 37  Fall Back 120  162    Fast Forward 104  200  220  Fast Forward Message 220  Fast Start 132    Fax 10  22  39  132  138  155  174  200  206  207   220    carrying 137       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All 
111. 18 s    22 May 2009        Auto Attendant    VoiceMail Pro provides an easy to use  multi level configuration tool  the VoiceMail Pro client  which allows  network managers and system administrators to construct an interactive menu system  based upon DTMF  telephone key entry  This allows an Auto Attendant system to be built and configured to suit business needs   be that on its own or as a back up for the regular operator when call volumes are high  VoiceMail Pro offers  the caller the ability to dial the name of a person via the phone keypad  like    Text    messaging on cell mobile  phones   In response the auto attendant offers the caller a best match name or if there is more than one  a  selection list is offered and the caller can select which one they want to call        As an example  VoiceMail Pro can be used to build an Auto Attendant that prompts callers to  enter 1 for sales   2 for support  3 for admin  or O for the operator  allowing them to be transferred to the appropriate  department without operator intervention  Alternatively  a list of personnel and their extension numbers could  be listed  allowing the caller to directly access the person they want  For larger companies it could be  department name listed first  followed by the list of employee extensions within the department     The latter two examples are ideal where company telephone operation has changed from a central operator to  Direct Dialing  DDI DID   allowing callers to  learn  the required ex
112. 19  Public Voice Networking ARAS eee ERATEN Dasnan anse ERATARA ERANA 143 Voicemail Feature Comparison id ConA E REE EA AEE AREN 220  Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 3    IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Contents       PC Requirements                                                    224  12  Audio Conferencing   IP Office Meet Me Conferencing Solution                230  IP Office Conferencing Capacity    231  IP Office Standard Conferencing Features               232  Conferencing Center    233  13  The Contact Center   Customer Call Reporter    243  Compact Contact Center    252  14  Management Utilities   IP Office Manager    262  Monitor   sausaiusin lide cee denned 265  Simple Network Management Protocol  SNMP        266  CDR  a a aaa A eae hoacea ht os 267  SMDRe  Stitt an o rE a eat ania te arate  268  System Status Application    269  15  Configurations   Country Availability                                              277  Sample Configurations    278    16  TAPI Functions Supported by IP  Office       TAPI 2 1 Functions Supported                                       282  TAPI 3 0 functions supported    282  Device Specific Data    283  D  vkink Fields eee hte itech wed  hevsteldesctcs 284  17  Technical Specifications   Interfaces lentes othe nat aoe Nta 290  Protocols azz cack ieee arte a AE eat ee ag 291  PC Specification                                                      293  18  Licenses   19  Appendix   IP406 V2 C
113. 2 May 2009     Chapter 13   The Contact Center       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved   e 4     Issue    Page 241  18 s    22 May 2009     13  The Contact Center    Avaya provides Customer Contact solutions that meet the needs of the small to medium business  From the  smallest company that requires basic system performance reporting to the larger businesses that need  advanced routing and multimedia integration with the Customer Contact Center  Avaya provides two solutions  on the IP Office communications platform based on the needs of Small Business Customers        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 242  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Customer Call Reporter       Overview  Contact Centers are a requirement at nearly every level of business  from very small informal groups of 5 or  10    customer service reps     to large formal campaigns that can involve thousands of agents     However  customers in the small business market are generally very nervous about making such a high profile  investment in a    contact center solution     They require a    business intelligence solution    that deploys easily   can be managed with very little training  and can provide statistics on each segment of the business  Small  Businesses also do not have the resources for extra IT staff to administer databases  servers  etc  so they  need a solution that can be easily understood by their own employees  It should operate as a ser
114. 218  252  MSP 195  Mu law 273  Multiclass 138  Multi Class Extension  Multi Link PPP 291  Multiclass Extensions  Multilink PPP 138  Multi Level Tree Structure 220  Multi Link 135  166  291  Multilink PPP  Multiclass Extensions 138  multiple Auto Attendants 10  multiple incoming 112  Multiple Mailboxes  Forward 220  Multiple Subscriber Number 143  Multiple Time Entries 122  multipoint 131  point 143  Multipoint Connection Units 131       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 332  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       MultiVantage 155  Music on Hold 273  Mute 56  58  60  80  81  90  91  118  238  Mute All 238  MWI 41  103   N   NA 42 68  NAME 262   Calling 185  NAT 19  150  168  291   discover 147  Netgear 84  Netherlands 277  Network Address Translation 19  150  168  291  Network Address Translators 291  network addresses 19  150  168  291  Network Alchemy 25  Network Assessment 137  network called   Public Switched 129  network comprising 169  Network Manager 266  Network Manager application 266  network numbering 159  168  Network Numbering Schemes 159  network ready 6  Network Requirements 135  Network Time Protocol 291  Networked Messaging 201  208  Networked Messaging Solution 208  Networking Features 153  Networking maximizes 141  networks converging voice 72  networks including private 129  New message 103  164  207  new old saved 104  new repeat answered unanswered 91  NI2 143  Night Service 120  121  122  283  Night Servi
115. 26  Forward On Busy On 126  Forward on No Answer 105  116  126  196  283  Forward On No Answer Off 126  Forward On No Answer On 126  Forward Unconditional 116  126  283  Forward Unconditional Off 126  Forward Unconditional On 126  Forward voicemails 155  Forwarding 117  185  Email 220  Multiple 220  Multiple Mailboxes 220  voicemail 201  203  Forwarding except 117  FRAD 150  frame instructs 138  Frame Relay 135  162  164  166  201  291  Encapsulation 138  framed 150  Frame Relay Assembler Disassembler  IP Office employs 150  Frame Relay Encapsulation 291  Frame Relay s PVCs 150  framed 135  138  162  164  166  201  291  Frame Relay 150  Front Door 94  FSK 290  FTP 168   G   G 711 55  56  58  60  64  65  66  136  138  including 132  G 711 A law U law 138  G 711A 155  G 711MU 155  G 723 69  G 723 1 136  138  G 723 1 MP MLQ 138  G 723 1  132  G 723 1 6K3 155  G 726 16kbps ADPCM 218  G 729 69  138  G 729 Annex 138  G 729a 78  132  136  155  G 729a b 55  56  58  60  64  65  66  G711  encoding 75 78  Gatekeepers 129  132  requests 131       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 327  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       Gateway 10  18  72  84  129  131  132  135  150   162  164  Greetings 177  200  201  213  220    Greetings  amp  Mailbox Navigation 200   greetings provide 213   Ground Start 18  34  37  39  43  143  273  290  Ground Start 143   GROUP 262   Group Details 253   Group Listen 10  126   Group Listen Off 126   Group ListenOn
116. 287  Wrap Up 177  283  WS X4148 RJ45V 133  WS X6348 RJ45V 133   X   X 21 150  162  165  273  290  X 21 V35 WAN 32    X 25 166  169  xDSL 165  XLS 254    XM24 40  42  98  XM24 DSS Unit 98   Y   Year 6  Yes 55  56  58  60  64  65  66  181  198  220   Z   Zetafax  Networks 206  Zip Code Postal Code 254       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     IP Office 4 2    Page 343  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Performance figures and data quoted in this document are typical  and must be specifically confirmed in  writing by Avaya before they become applicable to any particular order or contract  The company  reserves the right to make alterations or amendments to the detailed specifications at its discretion  The  publication of information in this document does not imply freedom from patent or other protective rights  of Avaya or others     Intellectual property related to this product  including trademarks  and registered to Lucent  Technologies have been transferred or licensed to Avaya     All trademarks identified by the    or     are registered trademarks or trademarks  respectively  of Avaya  Inc  All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners     This document contains proprietary information of Avaya and is not to be disclosed or used except in  accordance with applicable agreements     Any comments or suggestions regarding this document should be sent to  wgctechpubs avaya com       2009 Avaya Inc  All rights reserved     Avaya   Unit 1  St
117. 323 zone  a zone is analogous to a PABX    Each zone has a single Gatekeeper that can be considered as the brains of the system dealing with call  distribution  call control and the management of resources  On power up  IP telephones  Gateways and MCU  make registration requests to a Gatekeeper which then authenticates  accepts or rejects  their request to  become a member of the zone  Once accepted  a telephone wishing to make a call sends a call set up  message to the Gatekeeper which then determines how to route the call and will then send an alert to the  called telephone  or if the call is to a non H 323 telephone establish the call via a Gateway within the zone     The design of IP Telephony systems has been driven by open standards  Digital IP Phones  Gateways and  Gatekeepers all support the H 323 standard and it is this that allows devices from different manufacturers to  work together  IP Office has an optional integral Gateway  Voice Compression Modules  and Gatekeeper  functionality required to provide a fully functional IP Telephony solution        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 131  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        IP Telephony Features       e Gatekeeper  The IP Office gatekeeper allows the registration of up to 16 IP extensions on the Small Office Edition   190 IP extensions on the IP406  360 IP extensions on the IP412 and 272 IP extensions on the IP500   less the number of analog and digital TDM telephones already co
118. 36  Overhead WAN 136       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 333  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index        P   PABX s 18  131   provide 21  Packet Based 150  Packet Based Voice Networking 150  packet filtering 168  packet switching 150  packetization 138  packetized VoIP   allowing 150  packetized VoIP calls 150  packets arrive   port 138  packet switched 129  Packet Switched Telephony 129  Packet switched VoIP 129    Pager 203  Paging  Calls 110    receiving 41  Pakistan 277  Pan European Connection 290  PAP 164  167  169  170  291    Park 102  103  110  126  174  185  190  191  201   216  284    Park Call 126   Park ID s 185   Park Return 110   Park Slot Panel 185  190  191    Park Slots 102  185  190  191  216  284  pass calls 122  Password 10  104  164  167  191  233  262  291    PC application 119 214   PC application Phone Manager Pro 214  PC Based 198   PC CTI application 252   PC Requirements 224   PC Softphone 20  25  100  180  181  182  PC Wallboard Example 258   PC based 252  254   PCMCIA 273   PCMCIA Slots 273   PCMCIA Wireless 273   Percentage Time 253    Permanent Virtual Circuits 150  166  Personal 212   Personal Distribution Lists 177  181 214  Personal Numbering 201  212  220  Personal Options 220   Personal Productivity 174  177    personalization 177  Personalized Greeting 220    Personalized Ring Patterns  66    Personalized Ringing    55  56  58  60  64  65     90  103    Phone 16 273  287   Phone 16 Module
119. 400 3RD PRTY IVR RFA LIC DS   182298   This license allows Voicemail Pro to read and write information to and from a database that  supports Windows ODBC  The information can be used within customized voicemail call flows   including being spoken on systems with a TTS license  This allows the creation of interactive voice  response  IVR  solutions     e Text to Speech  TTS  Licenses  TTS can be used within customized voicemail call flows to speak information to callers rather than  having to record prompts for the call flow  Two options are supported for TTS operation     e   Voicemail Pro TTS  ScanSoft  License  IPO LIC IP400 AVAYA TTS RFA 1 LIC CU   182299   This license enables the use of the TTS speech engines supplied as part of the IP Office  Voicemail Pro software set  Multiple licenses can combined for the number of simultaneous  uses of TTS required up to the number of voicemail channels licensed     e   Voicemail Pro TTS  Generic  License  IPO LIC IP400 3RD PRTY TTS RFA LIC CU   182303   This license enables the use of the defaults TTS speech engines supplied as part of Windows  operating systems or any other SAPI compliant speech engine  Multiple licenses can combined  for the number of simultaneous uses of TTS required up to the number of voicemail channels  licensed     e   Voicemail Pro VB Script License  IPO LIC IP400 VB SCRIPTING RFA LIC DS  182300   This license allows VBScript commands to be included within Voicemail Pro call flows  VB Script can  be used by
120. 43  Signaling Channels 69  143  Silence Suppression 132  138  Simple Network Management Protocol 266  291  Simple Outlook 181  Simple Telephony Call Basic 142  155  Simple Telephony Call Basic Call 142  155  Simple Traversal   UDP 147   User Datagram Protocol 291  Simultaneous 137  Simultaneous VoIP Calls   Maximum Number 137       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 337    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       Small Community Network 10  102  103  105  107   108  109  118  121  152  153  155  174  201    SMDR 25  114  195  267  SMI 75   SMS 203   SMS text 206   SMTP 20  201  203  224  261  SMTP email 261  SMTP POP3 206    SNMP _ 55  56  58  60  64  65  66  133  150  261   266  291   SNMPv1 291   So8 32  273  287   So8 Module 32  273  287   Soft 18  32  78  86  87  106   Soft Keys 86  87   SoftConsole 22  25  102  105  109  118  125  185     190  191  233  SoftConsole Administration 191  SoftConsole gives  operator 185  SoftConsole Options 190  SoftConsole PC Requirements 191  SoftConsole Telephone Requirements 191  Software Developers Kit 194  Software Development Kit 20  195  Software License Feature Key A Law 273  Software License Feature Key Mu Law 273  software documentation CD 273  SOHO 107  Sophisticated Queue Announcement 201  SOS Emergency key 80  soundcard 180  Speaker button 119  pressing 10  Speaking Clock  Special Features  4625 SW 60  5410 58  5420 60  5621 SW 60  Special Services 143  Specialty Handset Support 90  S
121. 45 sockets    CLI Schemes  DTMFA  DTMFC  DTMFD  FSK and UK20   REN  2   External Bell via POT port  REN   1    Off Hook Current  25mA    Ring Voltage  40V  nominal  RMS     RJ45 sockets  Auto negotiating 10 100 BaseT Ethernet  10 100Mbps      Small Office Edition  RJ45 Ethernet socket    IP406 V2 and IP412  optional on Small Office Edition   37 way D Type female  sockets  X 21 interface to 2048k bps  V 35 interface to 2048Kbps and V 24  Interface to 19 2Kbps    3 5mm Stereo Jack socket  Input impedance   10k  channel    Maximum AC signal   200mV rms     3 5mm Stereo Jack socket  Switching Capacity   0 7A    Maximum Voltage   55V DC  On state resistance   0 7    Short circuit current   1A  Reverse circuit current capacity   1 4A   Small Office Edition only    16bit Type II PCMCIA format PC card    IEEE 802 11b WiFi    Small Office Edition  64MB Flash memory  16bit Type II PCMCIA card   IP406 V2 and IP500  512MB Compact Flash memory card        Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 290  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Protocols       Protocol Ei Information   V120 A standard Rate Adaptation mechanism        V110 A standard Rate Adaptation mechanism     Ppp RFC4661_ Point to Point Protocol  S  tcp RFC4570  Link Control Protocol     MP RFC4990  Multi Link  Point to Point  Protocol     IPCP______________ RFC1332  Internet Protocol Control Protocol     PAP RFC4334_  Password Authentication Protocol     RTP RTCP______ RFC1889 Real Time and
122. 53  Remote Management 232  REN 41  290  Repeat Message 220  Replay 201  218  replay rights 218  Reply 200  207  213  220  Report Design Solutions 254  Report Manager 254  Report Scheduler 252  254  Report Viewers 252  Reporting IntegrationNew 254  Reports Training 254  Reports Using  Designing 254  Reports Using Crystal Reports  Designing 254  requesting  Gatekeeper 131  PIN 230  reseller 254  Rest 162  World 231  restricted allowed 168  Resume Call 126  Retrieve Call 126  Return On Investment 229  reviewing  PowerPoint 238  Rewind Message 220  RFA 155 258  RFC 138  291  Ringer 10  64  65  66  82  90  91  103  124  Ringer Equivalency 90  Ringer On Off 82  Ringing  Patterns 90  Volume Control 90       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 336    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       RIP 19  169  291  RJ45 Ethernet 290  RMS 290  ROI 229  ROTARY 262  router alleviates 162  router firewall DHCP 21  Routing Information Protocol 169  291  RPT 254  RTF 254  RTP 136  147  291  RTP Payload  DTMF Digits 291  RTP Relay 147  RTP Voice Data Payload 136  RTP RTCP 138  291  Ruggedized 77  78  79  98  Russia 277  Russian 201  211  RW 218   S   S Message 284  SO 143  S0 Endpoint  Call 143   3210 155  Sales Reports 254  Save Message 220  Save Profile 177  185  SBC 147  S Bus 39  scalable 21  141  206  Scalable Platform 21  Scan    214  Scheduler 233  SCN 25  108  121  153  174  PSTN 115  158  Screen Pop 181  195  Screen Popping 101  SDP 291  Search 1
123. 6  252  Voicemail 203  Interactive Voice Response 6  20  24  210  building 201  Interchange 155  Internal Call 103  110  284  Internal Daughter Cards 36  Internal Directory 153  Internal Modem 21  32  36  Internal Modem Card 21  36  Internal Twinning 110  Internal User 174  Internal External 213  Internal External greeting 213  Internet Access 19  32  135  162  166  Internet browsing 168  Internet Explorer 218  233  238  239  Internet Explorer 6 0 239  Internet IP Security Domain  Interpolation 291  Internet Key Exchange 291  Internet Protocol 129  Security Architecture 291  Internet Protocol Control Protocol 291  Internet Protocol refers  type 129  Internet Security Association 291  Internet Service Provider 168  Internet Standards Specification 138  Internet Telephony 6  18  147  Internet Telephony Service Providers 147  SIP trunking 18  internets 291  Internetworking 155  interoperability 152  196  messaging 155  Interoperable 155  interoperate 169    networking 18  interoperation 169  Interpolation   Internet IP Security Domain 291  Interquartz 91 94  98  Interquartz Doorphone 94  Interquartz Gemini 91  98  Interquartz Gemini 9281 AV 98  Interquartz Gemini Phones 91  Introduction 46  233  254  261   IP Telephony 129  Intrude 107  108  123  195  201  283    INTUITY 155  181  198  201  206  207  208  213   214  215  219  220    Intuity Audix 155  220  Intuity Audix 4 4 155  Intuity Audix Emulation Features 220  Intuity AUDIX    155  Intuity Emulation 198  Intuity Feature 22
124. 7 staff    e Using your communications to quickly identify when your top customers call        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 8  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     How IP Office is benefiting businesses today     e More room for sales  With IP Office  a leading provider of commercial food service equipment now handles 50  more calls  per day  without extra staff and without sacrificing the personal service it knows is the key to sales     e At the head of the class  By relying on IP Office to connect nearly 50 buildings  a public school system saved thousands of dollars  on inter office calls and simplified communications     e Lowering global costs  By using IP Office to hold teleconferences and make phone calls across the IP network  a strategic  consulting firm is saving up to  30 000 per year     The right model for your business with several models to choose from  there s an IP Office to meet your  needs  Ready to grow Capacities  2 360 extensions  up to 192 analog lines  192 240 T1 E1 lines  128 VoIP  trunk lines     Call handling and messaging     Get 24 hour support for callers customers without a 24 hour staff  IP Office has a range of messaging  auto  attendant and Interactive Voice Response  IVR  capabilities  Integrate messaging and advanced call handling  into your customer service operations  Handle voice mail and email in a single mailbox     Communication with customers     Set up a formal or informal customer service cent
125. 8  60   DS30 86  87   DSS 40  42  64  65  66  67  86  87  98  118  216  DSS key 216   DSS key incorporates 216   DSS Modules 64  65  66  67   DSS Unit 98    DSS BLF 102  DSS BLF key 102  DSS4450 86  87  88  DSS4450 provides 88  DSS4450 Unit 88  DSSS  75   DSU 30 34  143  DTE 169  290   DTE Port 169  290    DTMF 41  90  94  115  132  138  143  158  196   209  210  216  291    sending 181  DTMF Dialing 90  DTMF Digits    RTP Payload 291  DTMF signaling 41  DTMFA 290  DTMFC 290  DTMFD 290  D Type 290    D type on IP412 290   Dual Charger 72   Dual PRIE 27   Dual PRIE1R2 RJ45 27   Dual PRI T1 27 279   Dual Universal PRI 25   Duration Summary  Incoming 254   Dutch 80  81  201  211   DVD 218  224    Dynamic 19  55  56  58  60  64  65  66  150  254   291    Dynamic Host Control Protocol 291    Dynamic IP 55  56  58  60  64  65  66   E   E amp M DID 143    E amp M Switched 56K 143  E amp M Tie Line 143  E 164 291  eg 115  158  E1 10  21  30  32  34  112  142  143  155  219  231  including 18  E1 ISDN 231  E1 PRI 112  E1 PRI 273  E1 T   1 155  165  E1R2 10  30  32  34  112  143  273  E1R2 Channel Associated Signaling 143  E1R2 MFC 30  34  E1R2 Primary 273  E911 125  Earth Loop Recall 41  Echo 34  36  135  273  128ms 18  e commerce  Internet 162  ECT 143  eg 105  Eliminating  conferencing 6  ELR TBR switchable 91  Email 6  24  72  104  162  164  168  198  201  224   233  252  254  266  accessing 207  Copy 220  Forward 220  Host 238  leading 206  reading 20  sends 218  subject 203  Voic
126. 802 11 and IEEE 802 11b Compliance   e Wireless Fidelity Wi Fi Compliance   e Interoperable with other 802 11b compliant devices   e WEP or RC4 security   e Range up to 550M  1750ft      Open  160m 252ft 270m 885ft  400m 1300ft  550m 1750ft    Semi Open 50m 165ft 70m 230ft  90m 300ft 115m 375ft    Closed    25m 80ft  35m 115ft  40m 130ft  50m 165ft    Receiver Sensitivity dBm    82  87  91  94    Delay Spread  at FER of  lt 1   l65ns 225ns  400ns 500ns    For wireless operation  IP Office   Small Office Edition must be fitted with a Wireless LAN card and the Wireless  LAN Access Point license key  Alternatively  a 3rd party wireless access point can be connected directly to one  of the LAN ports        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 315  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Optional Embedded Voicemail with Auto Attendant   Entry level voicemail and auto attendant applications are available using the Avaya memory expansion kit in  one of the PCMCIA slots on the rear of the Small Office Edition  This provides small locations with an effective  embedded messaging solution with auto attendant without the additional costs of an external PC  The  embedded voicemail supports up to 10 hours of message storage  The number of available voicemail ports  to  support simultaneous calls to voicemail  is 3 ports on the 3 VoIP model or 10 ports on the 16 VoIP model    Personalized greetings and PIN code access can be enabled for each mailbox by the mailbox
127. 9     Index       Supervisors 106  110  214  254  258  259  Call Center View provides 253  real time prompting 252   Supplementary Service 150  152   Supplementary Services within 152   Supplementary Services within IP Networks 152   surfing  Internet 32   Suspend Call 126   Suspend CW 126   Sv 284   SW 56  58  60   SwapHold 282   Sweden 277   Swedish 80  81  201   switchable 58  60  91   Switchable Time Break Recall 100 91   Switched Ethernet 19  25  32   Switched LAN 21   switching  Capacity 290  Play Advice 217  WAN 150   synchronization 169  220  Phone Manager 19   Syslog 10   System Administration 218    System Administrator 101  103  106  126  174   217  218  233  239    System Announcement 220  systems supporting 208    STE  T 38 132  137  T 38 Fax 137    T1 10  18  19  21  30  32  34  103  112  115  141   142  143  155  158  165  219  231  273  278  279    T3 10  40  42  46  63  64  65  66  67  98  104  143   287    Tabs 177  181  185  190  232  233  267  TAPI 20  25  101  195  196  252  282  283    TAPILink Lite 195  196  282  TAPILink Pro 195  196  TAPI WAV 195  196    Target Graphical Summary 254   Target Member Duration 254   Target RAS 284   TCP 291   TCP IP 21  224  268  291   TCP UDP IP 138   Technical Bulletin 147  182  191  224  239  Technical Specifications 182  191  224  239  268  Technology Overview 131   TEls 39   telecommunication 291  telecommunication numbering 291    10  109  177  181  10  109  177  181    Telecommuter   Telecommuter Mode   teleconfer
128. 9   Automatic Number Identification 143   automatic manual    allow 217  automatic manual recording  calls 217   B   Back When Free 126  Backlight 60  62  78  backlit 72  94  BACP 167  291  Band DTMF 132  138    Bandwidth Allocation Control Protocol 167  291  Bandwidth Required For Each 136  Bandwidth Required For Each Voice Call 136  bar 115  174  283  queue panel displays 185  Base 6  10  22  25  27  30  46  69  71  82  94  165   273  287  291  Base Unit 82  94  165  273  287    Base Unit Power Supply Adapter 82    BaseT Ethernet 56  58  60  64  65  66  Basic Commands 220    Basic Rate 34  39  143  165  Basic Rate ISDN 34  39  BCC 267    B channel 64kbps 290   Bearer Capability Class 267   Bellcore Special Report SR4287 290   Belt Clip 72  80  81  82   bi directional 129   BLF 153  174  182  190  191  216  253  form 118  groups 185   BLF Details 253   BLF Groups 190   BLF Panel 185  191   Blind Transfer 103   BlindTransfer 282   Book Shop 211   BOOTP 291   Bootstrap Protocol 291   Bothway 168    bps 136  branch maximizes 141  branches 6  129  141    DEFINITY ACM 155  Branch to Branch 19  Brazilian 201  211  Break Out 126  216  set 108  Break Out Dialing 108  Breakout 153  200  Reception 220  Breakout Dialing 153  BRI 25  30  32  34  37  112  141  143  290  BRI ISDN 141  BRI S interfaces  ISDN 37  BRI So8 25  BRI 4 25  BRI 8 25 27  Bridged Appearance 10  110  112  113  bridged appearance button matches 113  Bridged Appearance Buttons 112 113  Built in IP 150  Business moving
129. 90  218  Secondary Dial Tone 107  126  secretary   s 107  Securing  L2TP 291  Security Architecture  Internet Protocol 291  Self Administration 119  Send Email 220  266  Send Instant Messages 174  181  Separated incoming outgoing 181  serialy 258    Series 10  22  27  37  40  42  46  56  58  60  62     90  98  191  196  201  287  Server   Base System 252    ServerPC 224  server PC s 287  servers provide 167  Service Packs 182  191  224  239  Service Provider conferencing  compared 229  Service Provider conferencing services 229  service provider supporting 101    Service Providers 18  24  101  143  147  150  170   174  181  229    Service Reports 254  service by service 166  Session Border Controller 147  Session Description Protocol 291  Session Initiation Protocol 129  138  147  Privacy Mechanism 291  Set Absent Text 126  Set Account Code 126  Set Authorization Code 126  Set Hunt Group Night Service 126  Set Hunt Group Out  Service 126  Set Hunt Group Out Of Service 126  Set Inside Call Seq 126  Set Message Priority 220  Set Mobile Twinning Number 126  Set Mobile Twinning Off 126  Set Mobile Twinning On   126  Set No Answer Time 126  Set Outside Call Seq 126  Set Ringback Seq 126  Set Wrap Up Time 126  SetCalllnfoBuffer 282  short code representing 216    Short Codes 10  102  122  123  125  126  153   166  200  216  232  258    Short Message System 203  shortcode 41  ShortCode csv 262  Shut Down Embedded Voicemail 126  ShutdownEmbeddedVoicemail    10  Signaling   Conforms 1
130. 960   This license enables 4 voice networking channels   e   IP500 Voice Networking  Additional Channels  License  IPO LIC IP500 VCE NTWKG ADD 4  LIC CU  205650   This license enables 4 additional voice networking channels  Additional licenses can be added to  achieve the number of voice networking channels required     e IP500 Voice Compression Module Licenses   Up to 2 IP500 VCM cards can be fitted into an IP500 control unit  The card is available in two variants   supporting up to 32 or 64 VCM channels  Each card provides 4 VCM channels that do not need to be  licensed  Additional VCM channels up to the maximum capacity of the cards fitted can be enabled by the  addition of the licenses below  Multiple licenses can be added to achieve the total number of channels  required  Note that the maximum achievable number of channels is also affected by the codecs being used    e   IP500 VCM Channels   4 Channels License  JPO LIC IP500 VCM LIC 4 CH  202961    e   IP500 VCM Channels   8 Channels License  JPO LIC IP500 VCM LIC 8 CH  202962    e   IP500 VCM Channels   16 Channels License  IPO LIC IP500 VCM LIC 16 CH  202963    e   IP500 VCM Channels   28 Channels License  IPO LIC IP500 VCM LIC 28 CH  202964    e   IP500 VCM Channels   60 Channels License  IPO LIC IP500 VCM LIC 60 CH  202965     e IP500 Universal PRI Additional Channel Licenses  The IP500 PRI Universal trunk card  IP500 PRI U  is available in 1 or 2 port variants  each port supporting a  single PRI trunk connection  Th
131. Assignment  Static or dynamic IP address assignment    e Ethernet Ports  Two port full duplex 10 100 BaseT Ethernet switch for PC pass through connection   e Auto negotiation provided separately for each port   e 802 3 Flow Control     e Phone has priority over PC port at all times     Special Features for 5621 SW and 4621 SW     e Display Backlight  The display has a backlight for improved contrast  Standby mode turns off backlight  after time out     Special Features for 4625 SW   e Color Backlight Display  The display is full color and has a backlight for improved contrast     Note  While still supported  the 5620SW and 4620SW phones are no longer available for purchase        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 61  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        EU24 and EU24 BL Expansion Modules          The EU24 EU24BL are phone expansion modules that work in association with a 5420  5620 1  2420  4620 1   4625 phones  They provide an additional 24 programmable buttons with associated display label and status  icons  Only one EU24 can be used per phone  The EU24BL has a backlight and is for use with the 4621 and    5621 only     The EU24 EU24BL supports an additional 24 Call Appearance Feature buttons  by displaying a column of 12    buttons at a time  with a dotted line separating the two columns     Common Features    e 24 Programmable call appearance feature keys     e Automatically labeled from the system  no paper labels      e Connects direc
132. C SVR RFA LIC DS  171994   This license enables the use CCC to collect call and agent data into a database  That data can then be used  by the various CCC applications  This license also enables 1 CCC supervisor  see below for description of  supervisors  and 5 CCC agents  see below for a description of agents      e For IP Office IP500 control units  CCC is only supported on systems with an IP500 Upgrade  Standard to Professional license  see above      e Additional CCC Supervisor Licenses   CCC Supervisors are able to log into CCC applications to view the realtime status of CCC agents  Up to  25 supervisors are supported  with a supervisor license instance being consumed while a supervisor is  logged into a CCC application  The CCC base license  above  enables a single supervisor  Additional  supervisors are enabled using the following licenses in combination for the number of supervisors  required    e   1 Additional CCC Supervisor  IPO LIC IP400 CCC SPV RFA LIC CU  171996    e   5 Additional CCC Supervisors  IPO LIC CCC SPV RFA 5 LIC CU  184730    e   10 Additional CCC Supervisors  IPO LIC CCC SPV RFA 10 LIC CU  184731    e   20 Additional CCC Supervisors  IPO LIC CCC SPV RFA 20 LIC CU  184732     e Additional CCC Agent Licenses   CCC Agents are IP Office users configured in such a way that the CCC collects data on their calls and  status  CCC can support up to 75 agents  The CCC base license  above  enables 5 agents  Additional  agents are enabled using the following lic
133. Client requires the participant to have Internet Explorer  6 0 or above   installed on their PC  No download of the application is required  There can be as many web clients as there  are participants on the conference call  up to 64 maximum per conference   For security  access to the Web  Client requires the participant to logon using the Conference ID and their unique PIN number  This allows the  system to recognize who joined the conference and display its name on the right hand side of the screen     Status   Vote      Anne Webb 2    Select CC Presentation mht Lg  File  Charles Poyser X  Address   http JlocalhostFileUploadi32iCc Presentation  mnt Henry Bright    John Delft       iB IP Office 3 2 Peter    2 New Features    IP Office 3 2    Conferencing Center    Outline  lt  Slide 1 of 2  gt  E Slide Show Participants  6 Votes  4    Voting   Chat    Question   Please vote for acceptance of Mr Smith as Marketing Director     Please vote for acceptance of Mr Smith as Marketing Director    Vote    No Vote                In summary  the Conferencing Center Web Client offers the following     e Real time view of participant s status  Dialed in  Logged on to Web client  Speak and Listen  Listen  Only      e Ability for the host to change participant status in real time    e Ability for participants in listen only mode to request the right to speak  raise hand function     e Mute All   Un Mute All facility for the host    e Web Chat between Host and Participant   e Whisper facil
134. Comfort Noise  Automatic Gain  control     e QoS Options  UDP Port Selection  DiffServ and 802 1p q  VLAN    e SNMP Support  Yes   e IP Address Assignment  Static or dynamic IP address assignment     e Ethernet Ports  Ethernet  10 100  line interface with a secondary 10 100 port for collocated laptop or PC  with VLAN separation     Language Support     e Supports the following languages  English  French  Spanish  German  Italian  Dutch  Portuguese and Russian   English and 4 of the other languages at once in the phone         Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 53  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     BM32 Button module        The BM32 Button Module extends the number of feature buttons on your Avaya 1616 IP Telephone  It provides  32 additional buttons all with dual LEDs  red  green  for easy visibility     Up to 1 button module can be connected to a 1616 phone  The total number of button modules supported on  one IP Office system is 16  Note that appearance buttons are not supported on a BM32     Typical use cases are   e to provide additional lines for calls bridged from one or more other extensions  e to provide abbreviated dialing buttons    e to provide buttons to access additional switch features like call forwarding    Note that the BM32 buttons cannot be used for appearance functions such as call and line appearance  buttons        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 54  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009   
135. ContactStore s database and held for a month before being purged  The administrator can define specific  Email addresses for alarms to be automatically forwarded to  The email recipient could be a local system  administrator  a manned help desk and or suppliers  support desks if you have a support agreement that  includes this facility  The system sends an email message each time an alarm occurs or is cleared  It also  sends an email once per day as a  heartbeat  to let you know it is still operating  Failure to receive the daily  heartbeat message should be investigated  it could indicate that the server has failed        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 218  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     IP Office ContactStore allows replay of recordings by means of a browser based application that is accessible  with Internet Explorer  IE  V5 0 and higher  The Search and Replay facilities include the following features     e Personal security restrictions  The restrictions are applied as you log into the web server   e Criteria based search filter fields to perform specific searches     e Replay controls  Use the replay controls to start  stop  pause  skip forward  skip backward  or to export  the recording to a readily playable  wav file     e Audio waveform display  The waveform presents a graphic representation of the audio content of the  call  Use the waveform to avoid replaying static or silences  and to move easily to specific portions of a  
136. Expansion  None    Color  Multi gray    Mounting  Desk or wall mountable     Adjustable Desk Stand  Yes   Supplied with phone        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 58    IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Special Features for the 5410 and 2410     e Messages Button  Dedicated button to collect voicemail     Requirements for 5410 and 2410   e Connect to  Digital Station  DS  port     e Power Supply  From phone system     Requirements for 5610 and 4610     e Power Supply  IEEE 802 3af Power over Ethernet  PoE  or individual power supply unit  Avaya 1151  series      e Codecs  G 711  G 729a b    e QoS Options  UDP Port Selection  DiffServ and 802 1p q  VLAN    e SNMP Support  Yes    e IP Address Assignment  Static or dynamic IP address assignment    e Ethernet Ports  Two port full duplex 10 100 BaseT Ethernet switch for PC pass through connection   e Auto negotiation provided separately for each port   e 802 3 Flow Control     e Phone has priority over PC port at all times        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 59  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        5420  5621  2420  4621  4625 Telephones       re             Works on IP Office and  Communication Manager                                           Common Features     Display  7 lines x 29 characters     Fixed Feature Buttons  10   Conference  Headset  Transfer  Drop  Redial  Speaker  Hold  Mute   Volume Up  Volume Down     Programmable Feature Buttons
137. Hold button  Conference button  Transfer button  Drop button   o Contacts button  Call log button  Redial button  Quick access voicemail Message button     e Programmable Contextual buttons  19        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 52  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     o 16 line appearance feature key buttons   with dual LEDs  red  green  and paper labels  Printing tool  available      o Three contextual softkey buttons   e Key Labels  Icons used on fixed feature keys   e Speakerphone  High quality two way handsfree speaker and microphone     e Hearing Aid Compatible  Yes   ergonomic hearing aid compatible handset also supporting TTD acoustic  coupler     e Message Waiting Indicator  Yes   also used as ringing call alert indicator   e Personalized Ring Patterns  Yes   8   e Headset Socket  Yes   e Embedded Applications   o Contacts application  100  and Call Log  100  Missed  Incoming  Outgoing    o Access to company directory and Visual Voice applications on IP Office   e Upgradeable Firmware  Yes     e Expansion  Module interface   for up to 1 x BM32 32 button expansion modules  Note  An external power  supply is needed      e Color  Black     e Mounting  Desk or wall mountable with optional wall mount adapter     Requirements for IP interface     e Power Supply  IEEE 802 3af Power over Ethernet  PoE  class 2 device or optional wall plug local power  supply     e Codecs audio  G 711  G 729a b  Dynamic Jitter buffer  Echo cancellation  
138. IP Office   Small Office Edition and IP406 V2 Only     All the IP Office   Small Office Edition platforms provide a four port Layer 2 Ethernet Switch  The IP406 V2  provides an 8 port Layer 2 Ethernet switch     Each port auto senses its operational speed  10Mbps or 100Mbps  In addition to the four port layer 2 switch   IP Office   Small Office Edition has a fifth Ethernet port  labeled WAN  with its own IP Address  LAN2  intended  for connecting to external xDSL or Cable Modems  This fifth port is a Layer 3 switch to the other four ports        Integral 10 100 Mbit Layer 3 Ethernet Switch    Layer 3 switching is particularly useful in situations where it is desirable to have a    trusted    and    unsecured     network  where the    unsecured    network is uncontrolled and carries public traffic on it     It is possible to set up a firewall between two LAN segments using the IP Office layer 3 switch  Small Office  Edition offers a firewall between its four port Layer 2 Ethernet switch and its Layer 3 Ethernet WAN port  while  IP412 and IP500 support a two port Layer 3 Ethernet switch with the firewall between them  Both of these  switched ports have their own IP addresses  LAN1 and LAN2  and in order for traffic to pass from one port to  the other  a route is configured in the system   s routing tables     From Release 4 1 onwards  port 8 of the IP406 V2 Ethernet Switch can optionally be configured as LAN2        DHCP Server    IP Office can manage your IP Network for you th
139. IP Office 4 2    Product Description    i    fi        gt        15 601041 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        2009 AVAYA All Rights Reserved    Notice   While reasonable efforts were made to ensure that the information in this document was complete and accurate at the time of  printing  Avaya Inc  can assume no liability for any errors  Changes and corrections to the information in this document may be  incorporated in future releases    Documentation Disclaimer   Avaya Inc  is not responsible for any modifications  additions  or deletions to the original published version of this   documentation unless such modifications  additions  or deletions were performed by Avaya    Link Disclaimer   Avaya Inc  is not responsible for the contents or reliability of any linked Web sites referenced elsewhere within this  Documentation  and Avaya does not necessarily endorse the products  services  or information described or offered within  them  We cannot guarantee that these links will work all of the time and we have no control over the availability of the linked  pages    License   USE OR INSTALLATION OF THE PRODUCT INDICATES THE END USER   S ACCEPTANCE OF THE TERMS SET FORTH  HEREIN AND THE GENERAL LICENSE TERMS AVAILABLE ON THE AVAYA WEBSITE AT  http   support avaya com Licenselnfo      GENERAL LICENSE TERMS      IF YOU DO NOT WISH TO BE BOUND BY THESE  TERMS  YOU MUST RETURN THE PRODUCT S  TO THE POINT OF PURCHASE WITHIN TEN  10  DAYS OF DELIVERY  FOR A REFUND OR CREDIT    Avaya gran
140. IP Office system software     e Systems running 2 1 or later have the added benefit of being able to send software over an IP  network link to a system and have it validated before committing to the upgrade    e IP Office Manager 3 2 is backwards compatible with systems from release 2 1 onwards to allow a single  management application     e Importing and Exporting IP Office configuration information in ACSII CSV files  Manager will create files  for the following data    e Configuration csv which is a complete list of items as per Manager 5 1 and earlier  e Directory csv containing fields NAME  NUMBER    e HuntGroup csv containing fields HUNT GROUP NAME  HUNT GROUP EXTENSION  GROUP  HUNT   ROTARY  IDLE  QUEUING  VOICEMAIL  BROADCAST MESSAGES  EMAIL ADDRESS    e License csv is import only containing fields LICENCE OPTION  LICENCE KEY  e ShortCode csv containing fields SHORT CODE  TELEPHONE NUMBER  FEATURE NAME  e User csv containing fields NAME  EXTENSION NUMBER  USER RIGHT  EMAIL ADDRESS    e User templates for rapid programming and user rights for setting up user access levels       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 264  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Monitor       The IP Office Monitor application is a real time maintenance utility to assist with IP Office trouble shooting  As  the application connects to the IP Office over an IP connection it can be used from both local  LAN  and remote  locations  WAN      A simple interface allo
141. IP400 TAPI WAV RFA 4 LIC CU  177466   Applications accessing the IP Office TAPI software in 3rd party mode can also be used to stream  WAV files to users  This license allows streaming to up to 4 users at any time  Multiple licenses can  be combined for a higher number of user up to the maximum supported by the IP Office control  unit  Small Office Edition   10  IP406 V2   2   1P412   30  IP500   30     Phone Manager Licenses   IP Office Phone Manager is a Windows PC application that allows IP Office users to control their telephone  through their PC  The one version of Phone Manager software installed on their PC can run in Phone Manager  Lite  Phone Manager Pro or Phone Manager Pro PC Softphone modes  The mode for each user is configured  within the IP Office s settings and requires an instance of the appropriate Phone Manager license or licenses to  be available when the application is running  If the appropriate license or licenses are not available  the  application will run in the unlicensed Phone Manager Lite mode     e Phone Manager Pro Licenses  These licenses control how many users configured for Phone Manager Pro can simultaneously run Phone  Manager in that mode  Multiple license can be combined   e   Phone Manager Pro  per seat    1 User  IPO LIC IP400 PMGR PRO RFA 1 LIC CU  177468   e   Phone Manager Pro  per seat    5 Users  IPO LIC IP400 PMGR PRO RFA 5 LIC CU  177469   e   Phone Manager Pro  per seat    10 Users  IPO LIC IP400 PMGR PRO RFA 10 LIC CU    177470 
142. IP406 V2 or Small Office Edition  The  WAV file  must be 16bit PCM mono and sampled at 8Khz with a maximum duration of 30 seconds     From release 4 2  the alternate sources for music on hold are selectable for use by Incoming Call Routes or  Hunt Groups  not available on the Small Office Edition   On IP500 systems  each source can be up to 90  seconds long  30 seconds on IP406 V2 and IP412      External music on hold sources connect to the 3 5mm Audio socket on all IP Office control units        Park    As an alternative to placing a call on hold  a call can be parked on the system to be picked by another user     The call park facility is available through the user s telephone  Phone Manager or SoftConsole  Calls are Parked  against a    park slot number    which can be announced over a paging system so the person the call is for can go  to any phone and collect the call by dialling the park slot number     For convenience Phone Manager has 4 pre defined park buttons  On digital phones with DSS BLF keys it is  possible to program Park keys that will indicate when there is a call in a particular park slot and allow calls to  be parked or retrieved     There is a system configurable timeout that determines how long a call may remain parked before it is re   presented to the extension that originally parked the call        Automatic Callback    Feature  e When calling an extension that is busy  set the system to call you when the extension becomes free   This feature is also c
143. Kalika also offers an RVI  Remote visual identification  application which can screen pop an image onto the  Avaya browser based handsets  RVI is displayed frame by frame in a JPEG image form and is used as an  identification tool  It is designed to complement the existing IP camera already supplied by Kalika           Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 95  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Interquartz Doorphone        Choice of models  1  2  and 4 button    Slim design  16mm thick     Strong aluminium casing    Optional PC configuration     Remotely programmable via DTMF     Connection via analog extension port or trunk port     Relay lock control   Backlit inlay cards   Internal heating system   Day Night service     Combination lock control     For sales enquiries and product information contact Interquartz at support analogphonesavaya com        Product Description    IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 96  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Headsets       Avaya offers ergonomically designed communication headsets and amplifiers for the Avaya IP Office  telephones  This full line of professional and contact center solutions set the standard in sound quality and  durability  Avaya headsets are designed for maximum  all day comfort and are available in styles that suit  nearly any wearer and any usage pattern     Whether you want the freedom to communicate handsfree while working at your desk  or the ability to roam  
144. LIC    217658 IPO CUSTMR CALL License that upgrades existing CCC licenses to IP Office Customer Call  REPORTER UPG LIC Reporter for CCC users  no database upgrade    700461 IPO CUSTMR CALL DVD Containing required software for IP Office Customer Call Reporter    874 REPORTER DVD V1    To activate an IP Office Customer Call Reporter system all that is required is the purchase of one of the  supervisor licenses  1  10  20  and the system will be able to report on any agent that has been licensed  properly  Licensing is on a concurrent basis  i e   once an agent logs out of IP Office Customer Call Reporter   that license becomes freed up for the next agent to use  This is effective for those businesses that are working  in shifts     IP Office 4 2 will have a setting in IP Office Manager for designating which hunt groups will be reported upon  by IP Office Customer Call Reporter  Any hunt group that contains agent who is not properly licensed will not  be able to retrieve any reporting on that group  real time or historical      IP Office Customer Call Reporter Server Operating System Requirements  Small Business Contact Center server will be supported on the following 32 bit platforms only     e Microsoft Windows Business Server 2003 R2   e Microsoft Windows Server 2003 SP2   e Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2     Support for Windows 2008 server  both 32 and 64 bit  is planned for a future release     IP Office Customer Call Reporter Server Hardware Requirements  The minimum ser
145. Message        e A Forward All       nx  Do Not Disturb    This feature is supported across the IP Office Small Community Network        Call History    Feature  e Storage of called and calling number details within the user s phone and or IP Office application     Description   Most Avaya digital and IP phones keep a record of calls made and received  including unanswered calls  The  method of operation varies according to the phone type but in all cases the call records can be used for return  calls     The IP Office Phone Manager application maintains a call history record of the users last 100 calls  The  application must be running to record call history  Phone Manager Lite can display call history for all calls and  missed calls only  Phone Manager Pro can display call histories for all calls  missed calls  inbound calls and  outbound calls  Entries in the call history can be used for return calls  sorted and added to the Phone Managers  local directory or speed dials        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 118  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Language    Avaya digital and IP phone menus and displays are available in many languages and usually the system default  setting will be applicable to all phones  however it is possible to have language set on an extension by  extension basis  this will also change the language of menus for IP Office Voice Mail        Directory    The IP Office Directory is a list of up to 1000 numbers an
146. Off Hook Station   Park Call   Private Call   Private Call Off   Private Call On   Priority Call   Record Message   Relay On   Relay Off   Relay Pulse    Resume Call   Retrieve Call   Ring Back When Free  Secondary Dial Tone  Set Absent Text   Set Account Code   Set Authorization Code  Set Hunt Group Night  Service   Set Hunt Group Out Of  Service   Set Inside Call Seq   Set No Answer Time  Set Mobile Twinning  Number   Set Mobile Twinning On  Set Mobile Twinning Off  Set Outside Call Seq  Set Ringback Seq   Set Wrap Up Time  Shut Down Embedded  Voicemail   Suspend Call   Suspend CW   Toggle Calls   Unpark Call   Voicemail Collect  Voicemail Node  Voicemail On  Voicemail Off  Voicemail Ringback On  Voicemail Ringback Off       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 126  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 127  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Chapter 5   IP Telephony       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 128  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     5  IP Telephony    Technological innovation is changing the way we communicate  This time it is coming in the form of changing  the way telephone calls are transmitted  It brings with it several new capabilities that change the meaning of  the phrase telephone call through the use of Voice over Internet Protocol  VoIP   Basically  VoIP means    voice  transmitted over a packet data network   
147. P   40bit and 128 bit   2x16 character alphanumeric  plus status indicators     4 hours talk time and 80 hours standby        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     IP Office 4 2    Page 75    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        3620 Healthcare Wireless Telephone    The Avaya 3620 IP Wireless Telephone is a WiFi  802 11b  telephone that runs using H 323     as       The 3620 supports all of the features of 3616 with the following differences   e Designed for health care environments  e Waterproof durable design   e Display Backlight     e Manufacturer s Liquid damage warranty       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 76  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        3626 Ruggedized Wireless Telephone    The Avaya 3626 Wireless Telephone is a WiFi standard  802 11b  telephone that runs using H 323        The 3626 supports all of the features of 3616 with the following differences   e Designed for industrial environments   e Ruggedized durable design     e Push to talk  walkie talkie  feature for broadcast communications between employees     Note  3626 supports both R1 0 and R2 0 firmware on the set itself  However  as of R3 1 of IP Office  only  3626 phone R1 0 firmware is supported        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 77  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        3641 Ruggedized Wireless Telephone    The Avaya 3641 Wireless Telephone is a WiFi standard  802 11a b g  telephone that runs using H 323   
148. P400 DS30 expansion modules will  only support sixteen of these telephones     This phone does not support personalized ringing     This phone is not supported on the IP500 DS8 Extension Card  For the IP500 it will work on external Digital  Station Expansion Modules        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 87  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     DSS4450 Unit       The DSS4450 works in association with the 4412D and 4424D telephones  each of which can support up to  two DSS4450 adjuncts     Each DSS4450 provides an additional 60 programmable keys with single red lamps except for the bottom two  rows which have green lamps  The DSS4450 requires an auxiliary Avaya power supply unit and must be used  with the cables supplied     IP Office supports up to 2 units on each Digital Station expansion module  including the control unit with DS  ports  Up to 8 units are supported on a system     This phone is not supported on the IP500 DS8 Extension Card  For the IP500 it will work on external Digital  Station Expansion Modules        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 88  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Analog Telephones    As well as providing a lower cost alternative to system specific telephones  analog telephones can still deliver a  high degree of functionality on IP Office  They are particularly appropriate in applications where users require  lower entry costs and can be used with Phone Manager for a high p
149. Phone Directory 181  Local Telcos 143  Locating  SIP Servers 291  Longest Call Waiting 258  Longest Waiting 121  190  Loop Disconnect 41  Loop Greeting 220  Loop Start 18  34  37  39  43  143  273  Loop start Ground 290  Loop Start 30  143  Lord Of The Rings 211  Lost Call CLI 254  Lost Calls 254  258  Lotus Notes 203  206  Low Speed Serial Links 291  LS 34  Luxembourg 277   M   Mail Box  Remote Access 220  Maintainers Network Manager 266  make receive  headset microphone 129  Malicious Call Identification 143  Manage Personal Distribution Lists 177  Manage voicemail 177 219  Manage voicemails 177  Managed Frame Relay Network 150       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 331  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       Managed IP VPN 135  150  Management Tools 21  Manager 5 1 262  Manager application 108  Manager provides 262  Manager Start up Banner 10  Manager Warning Dialog 10  manager secretary 113  Managment Information 291  Manufacturer s Liquid 76  Many Avaya 103  112  118  Many Simultaneous Calls Can 136  MAPI 20  203  224  Mbps 138  150  Mbps LAN 150  MCID 126  143  MCID Activate 126  MCU 131  MDAC 210  Media 21  131  135  138  190  195  207  254  266  Media Service Provider 195  Medical 6 71  medical issues 6  Medium Enterprise 254  Medium Size Companies 6  Meet Me conferencing 229  Meeting 105  Meet Me 25  230  231  Meet Me conferencing 25  Meet Me Conferencing on IP500 231  Meet Me Conferencing Solution 230  Memory 10  82
150. RFC2407  The Internet IP Security Domain of Interpolation for ISAKMP     RFC2408_ ___ Internet Security Association and Key Management Protocol  __  RFC2409__ The Internet Key Exchange  ooo o  RFC2410  The NULL Encryption Algorithm and its Use with IPSec     RFC2411  IP Security Document Roadmap       L2TP RFC2661 Layer Two Tunneling Protocol  L2TP     Em E   Header Compression RFC2507_IP Header Compression  IPHC    RFC2508  Compressing IP UDP RTP Headers for Low Speed Serial Links     RFC2509__ IP Header Compression over PPP     DiffServ RFC2474 Definition of the Differentiated Services Field  DS Field  in the  IPv4 and IPv6 Headers    PPP MP RFC1990 The PPP Multilink Protocol  MP     Frame Relay Encapsulation RFC1490 Multi protocol Interconnect over Frame Relay     ML PPP RFC2686 The Multi Class Extension to Multi Link PPP     Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 291  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009           Session Initiation Protocol    Rec  E 164  2    ITU T Recommendation E 164  The international public telecommunication numbering  plan    RFC 2833  7    RTP Payload for DTMF Digits  Telephony Tones and Telephony Signals  RFC 3261  8    SIP  Session Initiation Protocol   RFC 3263  10    Session Initiation Protocol  SIP   Locating SIP Servers   RFC 3264  11    An Offer Answer Model with Session Description Protocol  SDP    RFC 3323  14    A Privacy Mechanism for the Session Initiation Protocol  SIP     RFC 3489  18    STUN   Simple Traversa
151. SNMP Support  Yes    e IP Address Assignment  Static or dynamic IP address assignment    e Ethernet Ports  Two port full duplex 10 100 BaseT Ethernet switch for PC pass through connection   e Auto negotiation provided separately for each port   e 802 3 Flow Control     e Phone has priority over PC port at all times        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 57  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        5410  5610 SW  2410  4610 SW Telephones       Communication Manager    Telephone   Works on IP Office Works on IP Office and    EXC PR EE   5610 SW         2410         620 SW  E f       Common Features     Display  5 lines x 29 characters  168 x 80 pixel 4 grayscale      Fixed Feature Buttons  10   Conference  Headset  Transfer  Drop  Redial  Speaker  Hold  Mute   Volume Up  Volume Down     Programmable Feature Buttons    e DS Phones  12   in 2 switchable display pages of 6 matching the 6 physical display buttons   e IP Phones  24   in 4 switchable display pages of 6 matching the 6 physical display buttons   Key Labels  Icons used on fixed feature keys    Speakerphone  Two way handsfree speaker and microphone    Hearing Aid Compatible  Yes    Message Waiting Indicator  Yes   also used as ringing call alert indicator    Personalized Ring Patterns  Yes   8    Headset Socket  Yes     Embedded Applications  Speed Dial List  48  and Call Log  Missed  Incoming  Outgoing   Also WAP  WML browser supported on IP phone models     Upgradeable Firmware  Yes   
152. Standards based multi site networking to interoperate with other PABX s     e Integrated H 323 Gatekeeper and Gateway for converged communications  The IP Office acts as an IP telephony server with Quality of Service  QoS  support through DiffServ for  routing and up to 128ms of Echo cancellation depending on Voice Compression Module  VCM  card  fitted     e SIP Trunking  IP Office 4 0 and above supports SIP trunking to Internet Telephony Service Providers  This approach  allows users with non SIP phones to make and receive SIP calls        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 18  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Data Communication Solution Features       For offices with basic data networking needs  IP Office can provide a complete data communications and  networking solution     e Internet Access  Firewall protected leased line or dial up connectivity via PRI  Ti or WAN port  high speed dialed access   direct leased line connections for high usage and Web site hosting  integral security  and efficient access  to information and a larger business presence via the Web     e Routing  Integral Static or Dynamic  RIP I II  routing for both Internet and Branch to Branch solutions     e Security  NAT  Network Address Translation  and built in firewall to protect your internal network and IPSec  support allows secure VPN data transmission across public IP Networks using 3DES encryption     e DHCP  Automatic IP address allocation for local and re
153. Status   Directory  including Users on the SCN   Real time Voicemail port status   Voicemail Summary Detail information   Real time Mailbox status    IP Route and Service status     Tunnel Status        Product Description    IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 270  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 271  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Chapter 15   Configurations       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 272  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     15  Configurations    IP500 Control Unit  700417207    Includes  4 x front slots for combinations of extension VCM cards and trunk daughter cards  1 x smart card  slot for locale settings and license feature key  1 x compact flash slot for embedded voicemail option  2 port  Layer 3 LAN switch  9 pin DTE serial port for system diagnostics  3 5 mm jack for Music on Hold audio input  and 2 switch external door relay control port  8 x external expansion module ports to support additional  analog trunks  digital or analog extensions  Includes auto ranging internal power supply  Regional power cord  and software documentation CD pack not included  Only one variant of control unit is available  but regional  locale is determined by the appropriate smart card feature key  mandatory      e IP Office 500 Software License Feature Key Mu Law  700417470   Configures the control unit for Mu law voice encoding and US locale s
154. Synergy Research  Q4 2007   Avaya IP Office has the track record businesses like yours  can rely on   Aside from receiving the Product of the Year award by Internet Telephony magazine and being  named Best in Test by Miercom in 2004  customers like you are saving money and boosting productivity  Many  are managing the system themselves via menu driven tools     I have old systems but am adding an office  Should I consider the new technology     Not only would this be a way for you to experience the rich functionality of the latest communications  applications  but we may be able to network with your existing equipment  as well as provide a gradual  migration plan for your other locations     How quickly can I get up and running     Just say    when      an authorized Avaya BusinessPartner can tailor a solution to your needs and your budget  By  saving you money and helping you grow  IP Office repays your investment and lets you reallocate resources to  other business priorities     Lowering long distance costs     Routing phone calls over IP lines   Voice over IP   is growing in popularity  Particularly in the case of  international calls  VoIP generates significant savings  If your company is already linking multiple offices using  high speed lines  the VoIP capabilities in IP Office make it possible to route voice calls over the existing  infrastructure  providing another way to lower costs and leverage your investment  However you do it  the  VoIP capabilities of IP Office
155. V2 only   When using the Hong Kong locale  Embedded Voicemail prompts are now available in Cantonese     VoiceMail Pro Enhancements    Unified Messaging Service  UMS   VoiceMail Pro 4 2 replaces the existing Integrated Messaging Service  IMS  with a new Unified Messaging  Service  UMS   This has two main uses     e UMS is an Outlook integration solution that does not require the installation of client side components   VoiceMail Pro provides an IMAP Server to which IMAP Client capability of Microsoft Outlook can connect     There is a new UMS User License  One valid license is required for each user of the service     Check Digit Action   The current Check Digit Action has been enhanced to support the ability for the variables in the system to be  validated against existing Extensions  Hunt Groups or Mailboxes  This is particularly important if constructing  call flows that require unsupervised transfers to these targets  when there is a need to validate the existence  of a target before committing a caller to that target     Menu Action Enhancements   The current Menu action implementation requires additional call flow elements to be constructed to  accommodate Timeout  invalid entries  and retry loops  VoiceMail Pro 4 2 has simple enhancements to the  Menu Action providing an easier and quicker way of accommodating this capability     Extended VBScript support  VBScript action will now support VB scripts of up to 10 000 characters     Phone Manager Enhancements    Out Calli
156. Visual Voice   This feature is  supported on the 2410  2420  4610  4620  4621  4625  5410  5420  5610  5620 and 5621 phones     e Reply to a message to either an internal or external number  if Caller ID available    e Support for Hunt group announcements   e Fax option for rerouting fax calls via the auto attendant menu     e Support for Fast Forward      Rewind      Skip message  9  and Call Sender      when listening to  messages     e No License Key required        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 200  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Voicemail Pro       IP Office VoiceMail Pro offers all the features and facilities of VoiceMail Lite and can be tailored to meet the  individual needs of a business  It has higher call capacity by scaling up from 4 to 30 simultaneous calls  All  options are available in a choice of languages  both spoken voice prompts and graphical programming  interfaces and have the choice of IP Office TUI and INTUITY emulation TUI     At the heart of VoiceMail Pro is the ability to construct call flows from a series of different building blocks   These building blocks allow automation over tasks like answer a call  listen for tone dialed digits  make a call  etc  VoiceMail Pro call flows allow far more than just guiding a user to the group or extension they require  Call  flows allow VoiceMail Pro to dial back users as soon as a voicemail message is left for them  it provides remote  access to phone forwarding sett
157. Y or Modular Messaging system over a remote  connection such that all messaging calls divert to this location and message waiting indications are provided  from the remote location and are displayed correctly on IP Office extensions  Connectivity must be either an  E1 or T1 circuit or an IP trunk running QSIG services  In addition to the IP Office license Key  Centralized VM  with ACM RFA  that enables this service  further license keys may be required on the ACM system        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 219  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Voicemail Feature Comparison       Platform Support    ae Embedded Voicemail VoiceMail Lite VoiceMail Pro    IP500 Yes  does not use VCM resources  Yes  Yes   IP412 No Yes Yes  IP406 V2 Yes  does not use VCM resources  Yes Yes  Small Office Edition Yes  uses in built VCM resources  Yes Yes     IP500 running in IP Office Professional Edition mode only        Capacities  Embedded Voicemail VoiceMail Lite  VoiceMail Pro  Number of Mailboxes No specific limit on IP500  IP406 V2 or Small No Limit   No Limit    supported Office Edition  Limited only by IP Office Limited only by Limited only by  configuration  IP Office IP Office  configuration   configuration   Maximum Number of 4 simultaneous calls on IP500 and IP406 V2  4 simultaneous  Up to 30  Concurrent Calls  ports   From 1 10 simultaneous calls on IP Office   Small  calls on IP dependent on  Office Edition depending up on available VCM Office
158. access points in one unit  The Mid Span Power units are designed to mount  in a 19 inch rack with the data equipment or they can be stacked up to four units high using the optional  rubber feet  The mid span is 1U in height  1 75 inches  and has up to twenty four RJ45 sockets on the bottom  row and twenty four data and power output RJ45 sockets on the top row  The units provide a maximum of 200  Watts or a peak of 16 8 watts per port  Data is unaffected by power delivery  if the device does not require  power  The mid span power units are also referred to as PDU  Powered Data Unit  devices  Power over the  LAN will simplify the installation and support of IP telephones for our customers and are available in 3 sizes  6   12 or 24 ports with optional SNMP management capability     Mid Span power supply       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 134  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        VoIP FAQ          Network Requirements    Quality of Service  QoS  is a measure of the performance of a network that reflects the availability of network  service and the quality of network transmissions  The term itself refers to a number of networking technologies  and techniques and does not necessarily restrict itself to any single protocol or standard     There are a number of measures that can be taken on the LAN and WAN to make them    good enough    to carry  voice traffic  Some of these are the implementation of standards based QoS protocols while are sim
159. acility or residence  Doorphones can be connected to the Avaya IP Office base unit in a variety of ways   providing design flexibility based upon needs     All of the IP Office base units include an external output port  Connections of doorphones to these ports enable  the user to gain    access to the premises through default system short codes  through the optional Phone Manager Pro  application  and through the optional VoiceMail Pro application  The flexibility of the IP Office provides the  ability for short codes to be customized to a code more desirable for users  By using the Phone Manager Pro  application  users can label the icons within the application a descriptive name such as Receiving Door or Front  Door  The flexibility of VoiceMail Pro allows the visitor to enter a predetermined code from the phone granting  access  This scenario is particularly useful in areas when co workers are working at another site  Additionally   many doorphones can be connected to station or trunk ports available on IP Office     The Avaya IP Office system offers three doorphone solutions to choose from   e Avaya Universal Doorphone System  North America   e Kalika Communications Doorphone Entry System  EMEA     e Interquartz Doorphone  EMEA     Avaya Universal Doorphone System        e System consists of a controller and a speaker     e The speaker is mounted securely on the wall and is connected to the controller  which normally resides  in the equipment room  The controller is conn
160. ack On 126  Voicemail Server 155  164  198  201  224  Voicemail System 215  218    Voicemails 10  104  109  174  177  198  203  207   220    VolP 6  18  21  22  27  36  68  72  97  129  132   135  136  137  138  141  150  155  181  269  273  VoIP application 137   VoIP calls 136  137   VoIP provides 129   VoIP Standards Supported 138   VoIP Wi Fi Solution 68   VolP compatible 129   VolP ready VPN 10   Voltage 91  133  290   Volts 133   Volts Alternating Current 133    Volume 55  56  58  60  80  81  85  86  87  90  91   118  209  220  Volume Control  Ringing 90  Volume Down 55  56  58  60  Volume Up 55  56  58  60  85  87  Volume Up Down 86  VPIM 220  VPN 19  21  22  25  84  150  170  following 68    terminate 10  VPN IPSec L2TP 22  VPN Phone Software 84  VPN Phones 10  22  25  68  Licenses 84  VPN tunneling 21  VPN access 84  VPN gateways 84  VRL 224   W   waiting    Acquire Call 123  walkie 72  walkie talkie 77  Wall Mounted Wallboards 258  Wall Plate Adapter 82  Wallboard Manager 258  Wallboard Manager Communications 258  Wallboard Manager Wallboard Server 258  Wallboard Server 258  Wallboard Server Client 258  Wallboard 22 258  WAN 10  19  21  24  69  135  136  141  162  164   165  166  170  201  265  273  290  switching 150  VCM 135  WAN Expansion Kit 273  WAN link 162  WAN multiplexers 164  WAN3 25 37  266  273  287  WAN3 10 100 25  37  273  WAN3 10 100 Module 273  WAN3 Module 266  287  WAP WML 58 60  Warm Start 262  Watts 133  287  WAV 102  177  181  190  203  207  218 
161. act management applications  such as Outlook  ACT   GoldMine and Maximizer  Sophisticated custom applications can be rapidly  developed and deployed with our full software development kit     Voicemail   Callers can always be answered with a personal voicemail greeting before a message is taken and  message notification set  Messages can be shared  forwarded  with colleagues and retrieved by any  phone capable of tone dialing  When used with Phone Manager Pro  the PC can be used to control  message playback     Integrated Voicemail to Email Presentation  Voice messages can be copied into email messages and delivered into the email system  IP Office uses  SMTP or MAPI to deliver a copy of the voice message     Unified Messaging  The Unified Messaging Service within VoiceMail Pro provides a higher level of integration to synchronize  both voicemail and email inboxes     VoiceMail Pro Web Access   Together with UMS comes the ability to access voice mails via an internet browser  Into the browser  voice mails can be managed  listen to them via the PC speaker or the desk phone  forward  delete   mark as read   unread are some of the possibilities the Voice Mail Web Access provides     Auto Attendant   Simplify service for administrators with this easy to use feature with the ability to construct customized  automated services allowing callers to efficiently navigate the system  and reach the right person   without the assistance of an operator  Available with VoiceMail Pro and wit
162. al expansion modules are only supported by the IP500 when running in IP Office Professional Edition  mode     IP500    e IP Office 500 Expansion Module Phone 16  700449507   Adds an additional 16 analog Plain Ordinary Telephone ports to control units     e IP Office 500 Expansion Module Digital Station 16  700449499   Adds an additional 16 Digital Station ports to control units     e IP Office 500 Expansion Module Phone 30  700426224   Adds an additional 30 analog Plain Ordinary Telephone ports to control units     e IP Office 500 Expansion Module Digital Station 30  700426216   Adds an additional 30 Digital Station ports to control units     e IP500 BRI So8 Module  700449515   Provides 8 ISDN BRI S interface device lines to the desktop     e IP500 Analog Trunk 16   North America only  700449473   Provides an additional 16 Analog trunks  loop start or ground start  and two power fail sockets     IP400    e IP400 Phone 8 Module V2  700359896   Adds an additional 8 analog Plain Ordinary Telephone ports to control units       IP400 Phone 16 Module V2  700359904   Adds an additional 16 analog Plain Ordinary Telephone ports to control units     e IP400 Phone 30 Module V2  700359912   Adds an additional 30 analog Plain Ordinary Telephone ports to control units     e IP400 Digital Station 16 Module V2  700359839   Adds an additional 16 Digital Station ports to control units     e IP400 Digital Station 30 Module V2  700359847   Adds an additional 30 Digital Station ports to control u
163. ality for TAPI 2 1     e lineAddToConference  e lineAnswer   e lineBlindtransfer   e lineCompleteTransfer  e lineConfigDialog   e lineClose   e lineDeallocateCall   e lineDial   e lineDrop   e lineGetAddressCaps  e lineGetAddressID   e lineGetAddressStatus  e lineGetAppPriority    e lineGetCallInfo    lineGetCallStatus  lineGetDevCaps  lineGetID   lineHold   lineInitialiseEx  lineMakeCall  lineNegotiateTAPIVersion  lineOpen   linePark   lineRedirect  lineRemoveFromConference  lineSetAppPriority  lineSetAppSpecific    lineSetCallPrivilege    lineSetStatusMessages  lineSetupTransfer  lineShutdown  lineSwapHold  lineUnhold  lineUnpark  lineSetCallData  lineDevSpecific  lineGenerateDigits  lineGenerateTone  lineMonitorDigits    lineMonitorTones       TAPI 3 0 functions supported       The following functions are supported using TAPI 3 0     e ITTAPI   e Initialize   e Shutdown   e EnumerateAddresses   e RegisterCallNotifications    e Put_EventFilter    e ITAddress   e get_AddressName   e get_dialableAddress   e get_ServiceProviderName    e CreateCall    e ITMediaSupport  e get_MediaTypes    Notes     ITCallinfo  get_Address  get_CallState  get_CallInfoString  SetCallInfoBuffer    ITBasicCallControl  Connect   Answer   Disconnect   Hold   SwapHold  ParkDirect   Unpark  BlindTransfer    Transfer    ITCaliStateEvent  get_Cause  get_State   get_Call    ITCalINotificationEvent    get_Call    ITCallInfoChangeEvent    get_Call    ITCallHubEvent  get_Event  get_Call    e TAPILink Lite ca
164. all PickUp Extension short code and  the user executing Acquire Call will be connected to the oldest ringing waiting call     e If the User has a connected call with no call waiting and the Intrude settings of the two Users allow it   the call will be connected to the user executing the Acquire Call and the other user will be disconnected     e If the User does not have a call the feature will fail        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 123  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Queue Threshold Alert    When the number of calls queued against a Hunt Group exceed a threshold  the system can be configured to  alert at a selected analog extension port  Typically the User to Alert will be a loud ringer or other alerting  device  The alert does not present a real call        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 124  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Miscellaneous Features          Conference Calls    Calls can be placed on hold and a conference created using either the phone or desktop applications   Additional conference members may be added up to a maximum number of 64 members     The IP Office   Small Office Edition supports 24 conference parties with a maximum of 6 parties in any single  conference     The IP406 and IP500 can support multiple conference calls totaling up to 64 parties  For example one  conference of 64 calls or 21 conferences of 3 calls each     The IP412 has two 64 party conference bridg
165. alled  Ringback When Free      e When calling an extension that just rings  set the system to call you when the extension is next used   This feature is also called  Ringback When Next Used      Benefit  e Carry on with other work and let the system initiate a call for you when the extension becomes  available     Description   Depending on the type of phone a user has  call back when free is accessed by dialing a short code while  listening to internal busy tone  selecting an option from an interactive menu or pressing a programmed DSS   BLF key  Callback when free can also be activated from Phone Manager     You can also set a callback when free or a callback when next used using a short code without attempting a  call     Note that a user can only have one automatic callback set at any one time     This feature is supported across the IP Office Small Community Network        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 102  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Direct Inward Dialing  DID DDI     This relies on the local telephone exchange passing all or part of the dialed number to the IP Office  This  number can then be used by IP Office call routing software to route the call to an individual phone  or groups  of phones  This service is typically used to reduce the workload on a reception position by giving members of  staff or departments individual numbers so they can be called directly  For convenience it is common to have  the extension or gro
166. alls     Requires IP500 BRI  PRI or SIP trunks and Mobile Call Control to be enabled for that user        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 111  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Key and Lamp Operation       IP Office offers a full range of Key and Lamp features on Avaya feature phones  These features include  Line  Appearance  Call Appearance  Bridged Appearance and Call Coverage  As these features require a phone with  buttons and indicators  the features are only supported on certain Avaya digital and IP phones  Key and Lamp  operation is not supported on analog phones     IP Office can have a ring delay set on each appearance button to allow time for the target number to answer  before other extensions ring  or visual alert only without ring     In Key and Lamp operation  IP Office supports up to 10 buttons on each telephone and 10 telephones with the  same line appearance        Appearance Buttons  Feature  e Use the programmable buttons available on Avaya digital and IP telephones to represent individual calls     e Answer  originate and join calls by pressing the appropriate appearance buttons     Benefits  e Indication of calls connected and calls waiting   e Handling of multiple calls from a single phone   Description  Many Avaya digital and IP telephones supported by IP Office have programmable buttons  These buttons can    be assigned to appearance functions that allow the handling of calls  These functions are   e Line Appear
167. an be selected using the Normal  Enhanced  or ISDN options on the System   CDR     SMDR tab     Depending upon the selected report format and options  there are a number of different fields available within  the CDR  they are listed as follows  please review the IP Office Manager documentation for further  information      Access Code Dialed   Access Code Used   Account Code   BCC  Bearer Capability Class    Calling Number   Calling Number Incoming Trunk Access Code    Carriage Return    Duration   Feature Flag   Incoming Circuit ID  Incoming Trunk Access Code  Line Feed   Null    Outgoing Circuit ID       e Condition Code Space  e Dialed Number Time  Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 267    IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        SMDR       For more formal call logging and reporting  the IP Office Station Message Detail Report  SMDR output is used  by third party applications for many call accounting applications  IP Office SMDR provides much greater details  of the call  including duration  ring time  hold time  and transfer information     From Release 4 2 onwards  IP Office can output SMDR events directly as well as through a separate Windows  service included in the IP Office Delta Server application  To generate SMDR events directly  choose SMDR  from the System   CDR SMDR tab in Manager     The IP Office Delta Server  SMDR  application is provided on the Admin portion of the IP Office CD DVD set  It  allows the detail of all calls to
168. ance Buttons    Used to indicate make and answer calls on a specific external trunk   e Call Appearance Buttons   Used to handle multiple incoming and outgoing calls from a user s extension   e Bridged Appearance Buttons   Used to match the call appearance buttons on a colleagues extension   e Call Coverage Buttons    Used to indicate unanswered calls ringing at a colleagues extension        Line Appearance    A Line Appearance is a representation of a trunk line on the IP Office system where the indicator tracks the  activity on the Line  Only external calls can be answered or made on Line Appearances  Line appearances can  be used with Analog  E1 PRI  T1 PRI and BRI trunks PSTN trunks  They cannot be used with E1R2  QSIG and  IP trunks        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 112  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Call Appearance Buttons    Feature  e Uses a programmable button on the Avaya digital and IP telephone to represent an incoming or  outgoing call     e Separate buttons are used to represent each simultaneous call that the user can make or answer     e Where possible  the status of the calls  ringing  connected or held  is indicated by the button indicator     Benefit  e Call appearances allow a single user to make  answer and switch between multiple calls by pressing the  appropriate call appearance button for each call     Description   On Avaya IP Office digital and IP telephones that have programmable buttons  those butto
169. and send e mails to other sites    e Support for RIP 2 protocol for dynamic data routing  IPSec VPN  firewall and NAT  Network Address  Translation  and for security  Centralized management and proactive fault management via SNMP     IP Packet based voice networking between IP Office sites can be achieved in a number of ways   e VoIP over an unstructured private circuit   e VoIP over a managed IP VPN   e VoIP over a managed Frame Relay network   e VoIP across the campus LAN     e VoIP across the public network            Managed  IPIFR Network         VoIP H 450    WAN Data Circuit       VoIP networking across IP network or WAN    VoIP over an Unstructured Private Circuit    Data networks can be constructed with IP Office using unstructured point to point data circuits  X 21  V 35  at  speeds of up to 2 Mbps  These data circuits are accessed via optional Wide Area Expansion modules  one port  is included on IP400 system units  and Voice Compression Modules  VCM   This approach can realize  significant savings by allowing packetized VoIP calls to be interleaved with data on up to 7 leased data circuits  with spare bandwidth  Depending on required solution sizing  IP Office supports from 3 to 128 concurrent VoIP  calls  This option is not supported on IP500 systems        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 150  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     VoIP over a Managed Frame Relay Network    Frame Relay is a high speed  packet switching WAN protoco
170. andling    igi nine Messaging Service  UMS sitatel eter iseasai  Fax Messages    206  Advanced Call Handling    105 f    Email Reading  Microsoft Exchange only     207  Key and Lamp Operation    112      Networked Messaging                                                208  Outbound Call Handling Features    114    Auto Attendant oia 209  Forwarding esnaera a a 116 l   vi  Accessing Database Information within Call Flows  Avaya Digital and IP Phones    118   IVR  RER Aa Re at a  210  Inbound Call Handling    120 Using Text To Speech  TTS  Facilities within a Call  Contact Center Features    123  FO      made suc Ar cent    211  Miscellaneous Features    125 Visual Basic  VB  Scie asus 211  System Short Codes    126 Personal Numbering                            212  5  IP Telephony Extended Personal Greetings                                     213  Gateways  Gatekeepers and H 323   Technology Hunt Group Broadcast Messages    214  OUVGIVIOW arbre crie 131 Personal Distribution Lists    214  IP Telephony Features    132 Cascaded Out Calling                                                215  Power Options for IP Telephones             0 01001r1110e0 133 Campaign Manager    216  VOB FAQ MERS NE Re Re Rai 135  Call Recording    217         IP Office ContactStore                                           218  6  Public and Private Voice Networks Centralized Messaging with Avaya Communication  Private Circuit Switched Voice Networking    142 gt  Managet ee vst tn de SR acts lull 2
171. ant  enhancement currently being investigated    e No call recording   e No queuing at remote sites   e No Fax over IP to AUDIX       e No Small Community Networking support when AUDIX    is configured on IP Office     e Avaya IP Office VoiceMail Pro networked to Avaya Modular Messaging   Octel   Intuity AUDIX    via  Interchange   S3210    Avaya  Communication    Avaya IP Office Manager         Public or  Private Network           ma Ext  2000    VoiceMail Pro  Server            Leaves message    Interchange 53210  for ext  3000    Avaya Intuity AUDIX       e Requires local VoiceMail Pro on every branch IP Office licensed with VoiceMail Pro Networked  Messaging RFA    e Requires Avaya Interchange S3210 on Modular Messaging  Octel or Intuity Audix       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 156  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     e Provides 2 000 remote mailboxes per VoiceMail Pro server i e  per branch office  to be extended  to 10 000 remote mailboxes by next VoiceMail Pro maintenance release     e User mailbox with Message Waiting Light support  e Forward voicemails between known remote users  e Fully featured VoiceMail Pro at every branch office    e VoiceMail Pro Networked Messaging will only accept an incoming voicemail message for a local  mailbox  It will NOT forward it to a remote Voicemail server  If required  this facility is available  through Avaya Interchange     e VoiceMail Pro Networked Messaging RFA is currently in extended tria
172. application  The proportion of incoming and or outgoing calls that should be recorded and the time period  during which Voice Recording should operate can be selected     e User Recording  The calls to and or from a particular user can be automatically recorded  By default the recordings are  placed in the user s mailbox    e Hunt Group Recording  The calls to a particular hunt group can be automatically recorded  By default the recordings are placed  in the hunt group s mailbox  but there is the ability to select a target mailbox made for or on behalf of a  subscriber     e Account Code Recording  An account code can be applied to a call by the user before it is made  This can be used to trigger  recording of outgoing calls     e Caller ID Recording  Account codes can be assigned to a call by Caller ID matching  This allows recording to be based on a  Caller ID match     e Time Profiles  For each user  hunt group and or account code  an IP Office time profile can be used to determine when  auto recording is used     e Incoming Call Routes  Incoming Call Routes can trigger automatic call recording     Note  It is possible for several recordings to be made of the same call  For example  if both automatic hunt  group recording and automatic user recording are applicable to the same call  separate recordings are  produced for both the hunt group and the user  Recording only continues while the party triggering the  recording is part of the call  for example     e Recording trigg
173. approximately one and a half hours    e Single  Dual  and Quad Chargers for the 3641 and 3645 phones   e Belt Clip   e Nylon Pouch   e Carrying case with Lanyard   e Hands Free Pouch   e Noise canceling headset     e Over the ear headset     Avaya IP Wireless Telephony Solution  AWTS  Open Application Interface  OAI   Gateway    The AWTS Open Application Interface  OAI  Gateway enables third  party software applications to  communicate with the Avaya IP Wireless Telephones  This serves as a two way messaging device  Many  companies provide applications that interface to your in house paging systems  email  and client server  messaging  Other vendors with complementary systems such as nurse call  telemetry  alarm  and control  system manufacturers are currently developing applications to interface with the Avaya IP Wireless Telephone  solution        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 74  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        3616 Wireless Telephone    The Avaya 3616 IP Wireless Telephone is a WiFi  802 11b  telephone that runs using H 323        The 3616 supports the following features     Lightweight innovative design     Simple to use    802 11b standard compatible    Radio Frequency 2 4000   2 835 GHz  SMI    Transmission type Direct Sequence Spread Spectrum  DSSS    FCC certification Part 15 247    Management of telephones via DHCP and TFTP   Voice encoding G711    Transmit Power 100mw peak   lt 10mW average   Wired Equivalent Privacy  WE
174. ard and up to 12 lines or selected features  Both of these  handsets are resistant to dust and spraying water and therefore also suitable for harsh environments   They also offer office quality speaker phone functionality     e Avaya 3641 supports a broad range of enterprise applications and is ideally suited for general office   financial or hospitality industries  This compact handset offers a high resolution backlight graphic  display a new  improved user interface and design and a lightweight form factor     e Avaya 3645 is a slightly larger version that in addition supports    push to talk    functionality for  broadcast communication between employees  Due to its rubberized sized grips and the larger ear  cup it is especially well suited in noisy and industrial environments     e Access to 2 6 lines or selected features through the  line  key and the  FCN  key  no labels         Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 73  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Avaya Voice Priority Processors    The Avaya Voice Priority Processor  AVPP  is an Ethernet LAN appliance that works with access points to  provide Quality of Service  QoS  on the wireless LAN  All packets to and from the wireless phones pass  through the AVPP and are encapsulated for prioritization as they are routed to and from IP Office  AVPP is fully  compliant with the IEEE 802 11a b g standards     AVPP is required for QoS because the current IEEE 802 11a b g wireless LAN standards p
175. are  delivered     e An analog extension port can be set for external Paging operation  It does not operate like a normal  extension and is connected to external equipment through an isolation device  The Port will always be  busy so it cannot be called directly and can only be accessed by using a shortcode  When not receiving  a Page the port will remain silent  when being paged the page tone is sent before the speech path is  opened        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 41  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        IP400 Digital Station V2 Module  This expansion module provides additional Digital Station  DS  ports for selected Avaya 2400  4400  5400     6400  T3  EMEA only  series phones and 3810 wireless phones  NA only   The IP400 Digital Station module is  available in 2 variants  16 or 30 extensions     DS 7 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 DS 25 26 27 26 23 30    17 24 25 30  000000 0000000  Parsman palatial       RES S ee    EXPANSION      24Y DC     5 04 MAX   DIGITAL STATION Y2  24 DC     1 54   PHONE V2       e Telephones can be located up to 1km from the control unit  For extensions located  out of the building   additional line protection will be needed  For more information on cabling and out of building guidelines   see the IP Office Installation Manual     e For systems where Direct Station Select  DSS  Units are being used  IP Office supports a maximum of   e Eight EU24 and or EU24BL per system     e Two XM24 units on each Digital Stati
176. are supported     e Simple incoming call scripting  Scripts can be displayed based on the Caller ID or the dialed number  DID DDI  to remind users of a  specific greeting or message to use     e Distinctive ringing  Allows the configuration of distinct ringing on a per caller basis  WAV sound files can be associated with  incoming callers  numbers and then played through the PC speakers when a call is received from that  number  This allows you to easily differentiate calls from important customers  clients  and unknown  callers     e Compact Mode  Compact mode minimizes the screen space required to run the Phone Manager Pro application  While in  compact mode  a notification slider alerts new calls and allows the user to view the caller ID or  associated caller   s name and answer the call  Users can easily switch between standard and compact  modes         A x          Phone Manager Pro  Anne Webb     CSI Ce A Ce         e Agent Mode  Agent mode operation allows the user to perform contact center functionality without needing a specially  designed contact center telephone  for example one with dedicated keys such as log on off  Agent mode  users can set their phone to    Busy    or    Wrap Up    and select which hunt group they are member of via  simple button clicks  Access to this feature is controlled by the administrator via User Rights     sees      aga     OQ    Busy Wrap Up Select Group Busy Not Start Call Stop Call  Membership Available Recording Recording    e Acco
177. ases  these telephony  services can offer substantial savings in comparison to traditional exchange lines  The IP Office solution allows  all users  regardless of their phone type  to make and receive SIP calls  SIP trunks are handled like any other  line on IP Office  affording all the call routing and toll control needed to manage inbound and outbound calls     SIP trunks on IP Office require the provisioning of voice compression channels through the installation of VCM  modules within the control unit  RTP Relay is also supported to allow the IP stream through SIP after call  setup  A license for the maximum required number of simultaneous SIP calls is also needed     There are several possible network topologies for SIP trunk systems  as shown in the following diagrams     Option 1  Service provider with a Session Border Controller  SBC   which solves NAT traversal issues   this is  the most reliable and preferred method     SIP Service  Provider                 Es SIP   155 0  S DEED    Firewall Session      Router Border  Controller    IP Office                    Internet       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 147  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Option 2  Direct connection from the IP Office   s second Ethernet port to the internet via a DMZ  demilitarized  zone  port on the router  To make this configuration secure  the IP Office firewall is set to drop all packets  except SIP             Unsecured LAN       SIP Service    Provi
178. ation of traffic and agent information  This capability is  aimed at the contact center manager who wants to take the statistics to a deeper level in order to make  better informed decisions     Within Compact Contact Center  custom reporting is available  but requires the purchase of Crystal Reports or  Crystal Design software from an authorized Crystal Business Objects software reseller or distributor  With this  software  the designer has the ability to create and load 3 custom reports into the CCC Reporter  no additional  license required   Custom reports can be added and subtracted as required  If the business requires greater  than 3 custom reports  the following license is required     e IPO LIC IP 400 CCC DESIGNER RFA LIC CU       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 255  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Designing Reports Using Crystal Reports    CCC is designed to work with Crystal Reports    reporting software package  using Crystal version 9   Crystal  Reports is available in four different editions to meet the needs of application developers  IT professionals  and  business users  The following is an overview of the types of Crystal products that can be used     Application Development Solutions    e Advanced Developer   Web development and deployment bundle for integrating and deploying dynamic  report creation and viewing capabilities into web applications     e Developer Edition   For integrating report viewing  printing  and e
179. b  Client offers a browser interface where the host and participants can not only see which participants have  joined the conference but also whether they joined as audio only or both audio and web  A conference host  has the ability to pose questions  modify participant speak listen settings and whisper to a single participant  connected into the conference  When in listen only mode  participants can request the right to speak through  their Web Client  raise hand function   A Web Chat service is available between Host and Participants and the  dialog is recorded and sent via email to the Host after the conference  Two modes of communication between  Host and Participant is supported  either private or public  Public allows all participants to see the dialog    The host can present a document on the Web Client with all participants   for example a PowerPoint  presentation  Word document or an Excel spreadsheet  or simply a website URL  Files can be loaded on  demand using the Web Client  or in advance using the Web Scheduler  When presenting the document  the  host has the ability to synchronize the document view to all participants  e g  change slide  as long as he  resides within the same IP domain as the Conferencing Center server  this is a Microsoft limitation      Participants can be located anywhere on the Internet or across an extranet as long as they have access to the  Web Server running the Conferencing Center application     Access to the Conferencing Center Web 
180. ble by default  it must be  specifically enabled in the system configuration  An option exists to have a beep tone indicate when monitoring  is in use  The user is only able to listen  they cannot speak into the conversation being monitored        Acquire Call    Feature  e Takeover a call currently connected at another extension  This feature is also known as  Call Steal      Benefit  e Assist a colleague who indicates they want you to take the call     Description   The Acquire Call function can be setup as a special short code or programmed against a button on an Avaya  digital or IP phone with programmable buttons  Use of the feature is subject to IP Office intrusion control  settings  the user acquiring the call must be set to be able to intrude and the user whose call is being acquired  must be set to can be intruded  Acquire call works in two ways  invoked with or without a number     Without a value in the number field  e This allows a user to reclaim a call that was ringing on their phone but has now gone elsewhere  for  example to Voicemail or Forward No Answer destination  The Intrude settings are not checked and the  call can be reclaimed even if it has been answered     e If the last call to ring this User is no longer ringing or connected on the system  the feature will fail     With a number  where the number is the telephone number of a user who currently has the call to be acquired   e If the user has a call ringing or waiting Acquire Call will act like the C
181. ble wedge stand for desktop and wall mount use   Fixed Buttons  10     o Volume up down  separate volume levels for the handset  speaker  and ringer   Mute button  Speaker  button     o Avaya Menu button  options and settings access     o Hold button  Conference button  Transfer button  Drop button  Redial button   Programmable Contextual buttons  3    o 3 line appearance key buttons   with dual LEDs  red  green  and paper labels  Printing tool available    Key Labels  Icons used on fixed feature keys    Speakerphone  Two way handsfree speaker and microphone     Hearing Aid Compatible  Yes   ergonomic hearing aid compatible handset also supporting TTD acoustic  coupler     Message Waiting Indicator  Yes   also used as ringing call alert indicator   Personalized Ring Patterns  Yes   8   Headset Socket  No     Embedded Applications        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 48  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     o Contacts application  100  and Call Log  100  Missed  Incoming  Outgoing    o Access to company directory and Visual Voice applications on IP Office    e Upgradeable Firmware  Yes    e Expansion  None    e Color  Black     e Mounting  Desk or wall mountable with optional wall mount adapter     Requirements for IP interface   e Power Supply  Optional IEEE PoE 802 3af adapter  class 2  or optional wall plug local power supply     e Codecs audio  G 711  G 729a b  Dynamic Jitter buffer  Echo cancellation  Comfort Noise  Automatic Gain  con
182. cal calls are to go through one carrier between specific hours  and international calls through an alternative carrier  Carrier selection using 2 stage call set up via in band  DTMF is possible  It is possible to assign specific routes on a per user basis  e g  only allow expensive routes to  be used by critical staff     Note  Existing LCR configurations are automatically converted to ARS when upgrading to 4 0       Maximum Call Length    This feature allows the system to control the maximum duration of any call based on the dialed number  This  could be used for controlling calls to cellular networks or data calls made over the public network to ISPs        PIN Restricted Calling    See Account Codes  114        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 115  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Forwarding       This is the ability to forward a user s calls to another extension or external number such as a Mobile Cell  Phone  Calls can be forwarded in a number of ways and if the call is not answered at the forward destination it  will go to IP Office voicemail if enabled for the user and call supervision is available  There are three separate  forward destinations  one for forwarding on busy one for no answer and one for forward unconditional  Once  the numbers have been entered  the user can toggle the forwarding to be active or not as required without  having to re enter the numbers     If the user is a member of a hunt group  some types of Hunt
183. call     The Search and Replay screen  shown below  provides filter fields that you can use to search for calls        F ContactStore   Microsoft Internet Explorer  Ele Edt    ew Favorites Tools Help          Heak    gt   gt  OA BY  Geach Favores Preis A  ES   amp  M i    Address   http    adsvr 89683 servieticsipo  gt   ea   Ur      AVAYA ContactStore    Change P    powered by WITNESS SYSTEMS             Administration  Administer System 4 Call Start   PartiesVaA TypeYA TargetYA                   i 24 08 04 11 50 27 00 12 203  Extn203   204    Incoming 204  24 08 04 11 50 50 00 11 203     204  Extn204  Incoming 203  24 08 04 17 27 08 00 10 203  Extn203   204    Incoming 204    Search Filters  Call Start Range   Poe  00 00 00  Pace      7   23 59 59  Parties   Length    Target Number       xl   E  Done    BE Local intranet Z    Note  For ContactStore to work for remote nodes across a Small Community Network  SCN  there needs to be  a ContactStore license present on each node  For remote IP500 systems this is in addition to the Voice  Networking license required for SCN  but the system does not need a Professional Edition upgrade license     Centralized Messaging with Avaya Communication Manager             Where IP Office is deployed in an Avaya Communication Manager  ACM  Environment  it may be desirable to  use one centrally managed voicemail system  INTUITY or Modular Messaging  to provide voicemail services to  IP Office users  IP Office can be configured to use an INTUIT
184. card in order to provide additional facilities  typically trunk connections         The following base cards are available   e IP500 Digital Station 8 Card    Maximum 3    e IP500 Analog Phone 2 Card and Phone 8 Card  2   Maximum 4    e IP500 VCM Card  2  Maximum 2      e IP500 Legacy Card Carrier  2  Maximum 2  2            Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 27  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     IP500 Digital Station 8 Card    This card provides 12 RJ45 ports  The first 8 ports are DS ports for the connection of Avaya digital phones  other than IP phones  The card can be fitted with an IP500 daughter trunk card  which then uses the additional  4 RJ45 ports for trunk connections        e This card accepts one IP500 trunk daughter card of any type     e This card supports selected Avaya 2400  5400 and 6400 series phones  plus T3 phones EMEA only  and  3810 wireless phones  North America only      e 4400 Series phones  4406D  4412D and 4424D  are not supported on this card  only on Digital Station  expansion modules  Therefore a maximum of 240 x 4400 Series phones are supported in the system     IP500 Analog Phone 2 Card    This card provides 2 analog extension ports  1 2  for the connection of analog phones  The card can be fitted  with an IP500 daughter trunk card  which then uses the last 4 RJ45 ports  9 12  for trunk connections        e This card accepts one IP500 trunk daughter card of any type     IP500 Analog Phone 8 Card    This card 
185. cation     Agent and Site Management  Real Time     e Real Time Supervisor Monitoring   Call Center View  As many as 21 supervisor CCV positions can be used in CCC  please note  MSDE installations can only  be supported up to 5 supervisor positions   This provides a supervisor with the ability to monitor in  real time the service being provided to callers  There are up to 12 separate real time graphs that can  be viewed by the supervisor  Alarms also appear in real time prompting the supervisor to  acknowledge them as they occur     Phone Manager Pro  Agent Enabled   Provides agents with a PC CTI application where they can log in  join groups  and go into busy status  when they are unable to accept calls for short periods so no special turrets are needed   CCC and Phone  Manager allow Agent working on any wired IP Office extension type  Phone Manager PC Softphone can  be used in agent mode as well  without the need for a physical telephone  Please refer to the  applications section for more information on Phone Manager Pro     Alarm Reporter   Alarm Reporter is designed to enhance the exception management used by Call Center View  CCV   The  Alarm Reporter enables the contact center supervisor to look back on the performance of the contact  center  on a daily or weekly basis  by reporting on certain criteria predefined by the contact center  supervisor     Historical Reporting   The Compact Contact Center archives all call center interactions  telephony or multimedia  to a ce
186. ccount Code Costing Log  Outgoing Account Code Log  Graphical    Outgoing Account Code Log     Outgoing Most Common Destination by Agent  Group     Pilot Call Duration    Pilot Distribution by Target    Pilot Distribution    Pilot Response    Pilot Routing    Pilot Summary  All Calls     Pilot Summary   System Summary    Target Graphical Summary    Target Member Duration  All Media    Target Member Duration    Transfer Call Tracking Detail by Agent   Trunk Group Activity   Trunk Group Busy    Trunk Group Call Duration    Trunk Group Response    Trunk Group Summary    VM Call Flow Monitor by Call Flow Name   VM Call Flow Monitor by Topic    VM Call Flow Monitor    VM Summary   Incoming Calls By Target Group    Plus 3 custom reports     Report Scheduler allows reports to be scheduled to run at a specified date and time  or repeated at regular  intervals  Supervisors can schedule reports to be delivered to various places within the contact center  Reports  can also be delivered to multiple recipients via email in the following formats  PDF  CSV  XLS  RTF  RPT and  Word format  Reports can even be scheduled for delivery to multiple printers within the network at the same    time        Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 254  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Custom Reporting    Custom Reporting allows the business to create reports tailored specifically to the needs of the individual  business  providing greater flexibility in the present
187. ce Fallback 121   Pass 122  Night Service Group 121  No Answer 110  116  117  126  185  283  No Answer Interval 116  No Answer Time 110  Node Numbering 159  Node Numbering Scheme 159  North American Primary Rate Interface 143  North American T1 143  Norway 277  Norwegian 80  201  211  Not Disturb 107  116  118  174  Not Disturb Exception Add 126  Not Disturb Exception Delete 126  Not Disturb Off 126    Not Disturb On 126  Notice 6  Now there s 6  NTP 291  NULL Encryption Algorithm 291  Number service 143  212  Number Incoming Trunk Access Code  Calling 267  number name 220  number 102  Numeric Keystrokes 190  Nylon Pouch 72   O   OAI 72  occurrence instance 10  Octel 155  Of Hours 213  Off Hook Current 290  Off Hook Operation 125  Off Hook Station 126  Offer Answer Model 291  offering  high resolution 72  high resolution backlight 72  Off Hook Station 125  office heating 201  Office LAN  accessing 32  Office quality speakerphone 78  offline 174  Oldest 123 218  oldest ringing waiting 123  oldest ringing waiting call 123  On Demand Call Recording 201  Open Application Interface 72  Open CTI 20  OpenView application 266  Operator SoftConsole 20  Opportunity Activity 254  Optional Add Ons 64  65  66  Other Avaya Products 46  85  155  Other Features 10  220  231  Other Ranges  Telephones Compatible 85  Out Of Hours 213  Outbound Call Handling Features 114  outcall 215  Outcalling 220  Outlook 20  177  181  206  Goldmine 181  Output Port 94  290  Overflow Group 121  Overhead LAN 1
188. cess Server  RAS     IP Office provides RAS functionality allowing external users to dial in to the local area network from modems   telephone adaptors and routers  Several of the previously described features and services can be applied to  the dial in users to create a powerful Remote Access Server  Dial in users can be authenticated using either  PAP or CHAP  Once authenticated the DHCP server can automatically assign the user an IP address to use  while connected to the LAN  Individual time profiles and firewalls can be applied to the user restricting what  they have access to and when they have access  For further security and accounting ease  IP Office can  automatically call a user back  This keeps the cost of the telephone call on the company telephone bill  removing the need to process individual expense claims        Transaction Packet Assembler Dissembler  TPAD     TPAD is a lightweight version of the X 25 protocol used in the retail market for transaction processing  Through  faster transaction processing a retailer can reduce the floor limit of credit authorizations and benefit from lower  transaction charges  A PDQ or credit card  swipe  telephone can utilize the digital trunks  via the DTE port or  the USB on the rear of the IP Office  Since the link between the main unit and the transaction authenticator is  digital no modems are required at either end        Routing Information Protocol  RIP     RIP is a distance vector protocol that allows routers to determi
189. conds  The BHCC  figures for the different IP Office control units are listed below  Note that in some cases the BHCC figure  achievable will be limited by the number of incoming trunks supported     e IP500   36000   e IP412   36000   e IP406 V2   27000     Il    e IP406 V1   15000     e Small Office Edition   4800        Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 287  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Telephone Extension Cable Lengths    The following table details the maximum cable lengths supported for the telephone ranges  These figures  assume that standard twisted pair telephone cable or CAT5 network cable is used     Unshielded Twisted Pair  UTP    50nf Km       Telephone    AWG22 AWG24 AWG26   0 65mm   0 5mm   0 4mm     2400 5400 Series 1200m 3937   1000m 3280   670m 2200   400m 1310    4406D Phone 1000m 3280   1000m 3280   400m 1310   400m 1310    4412D Phone 1000m 3280   700m 2295   400m 1310   400m 1310    4424D 500m 1640   500m 1640   400m 1310   400m 1310    6400 Series 1000m 3280   1000m 3280   400m 1310   400m 1310    T3 Series  Upn  1000m 3280   1000m 3280   400m 1310       Analog Phones 1000m 3280   1000m  3280   400m 1640   800m 2620      Heat Dissipation   Note that the above numbers are for reference only  For practical purposes  for example the calculation of heat  dissipation  it is recommended to base environmental requirements  for example air cooling or UPS ratings  on  the maximum input rating of the power supplies of 
190. cting to the Internet  ISPs typically want a  customer to use an IP address they have allocated  Using NAT this is easily accommodated  eradicating the  need for the customer to change their network numbering scheme and providing additional security to the  internal users as their address in hidden to the public     Typically  a company maps its internal network addresses to a global external IP address and unmaps the  global IP address on incoming packets back into internal IP addresses  This helps ensure security since each  outgoing or incoming request must go through a translation process  This also offers the opportunity to qualify  or authenticate the request or match it to a previous request  NAT also conserves the number of global IP  addresses that a company needs        Proxy Address Resolution Protocol  ARP     Support for Proxy Address Resolution Protocol allows IP Office to respond on behalf of the IP address of a  device connected to it when receiving an ARP request        Auto Connect    If a service is idle  that is no one is using the Internet  Auto Connect allows the IP Office to periodically  connect to a service  This is ideal for mail polling to retrieve email from an Internet Service Provider  An  Auto  Connect Time Profile    controls the time period during which automatic calls are made  for example not at  weekends or during the middle of the night        Firewall    IP Office integrated firewall provides packet filtering of the most common IP protoco
191. ction  transfer  and or use can be a criminal  as well as a civil  offense under the applicable law   Third Party Components   Certain software programs or portions thereof included in the Product may contain software distributed under third party  agreements     Third Party Components      which may contain terms that expand or limit rights to use certain portions of the  Product     Third Party Terms      Information identifying Third Party Components and the Third Party Terms that apply to them is  available on Avaya   s web site at  http   support avaya com ThirdPartyLicense    Avaya Fraud Intervention   If you suspect that you are being victimized by toll fraud and you need technical assistance or support  call Technical Service  Center Toll Fraud Intervention Hotline at  1 800 643 2353 for the United States and Canada  Suspected security  vulnerabilities with Avaya Products should be reported to Avaya by sending mail to  securityalerts avaya com    For additional support telephone numbers  see the Avaya Support web site  http   www avaya com support     Trademarks   Avaya and the Avaya logo are registered trademarks of Avaya Inc  in the United States of America and other jurisdictions   Unless otherwise provided in this document  marks identified by                     and    SM    are registered marks  trademarks and  service marks  respectively  of Avaya Inc  All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners    Documentation information   For the most c
192. cuit on an So8 Expansion Module     These trunks support the mobility features of Mobile Call Control and one X Mobile client support introduced in  Release 4 2     IP500 Universal PRI Trunk Card    This type of card can be added to an IP500 Digital Station card  IP500 Analog Phone card  or IP500 VCM card   It allows that card to then also support primary rate digital trunk connections  Available in single and dual  versions the IP400 PRI card provides single and dual primary rate trunk interfaces respectively  The PRI is  configurable for T1  E1 or E1R2 MFC use depending on the territory        Details of the supported ISDN supplementary services and protocols for each PRI are given in the    Public and  Private Voice Networks  section     The IP500 Universal PRI trunk cards incorporate an integrated CSU DSU  The CSU function allows the trunk to  be put in loop back mode for testing purposes  This can be set manually  using the monitor application  or  automatically from a Central Office sending a Line Loop Back  LLB  pattern  The DSU function allows the T1  trunk to be shared between data and voice services     Here is a summary of the capabilities of the card   e Each card is configurable to connect to T1  E1 or E1R2 lines     e The card is available in either a single or dual PRI variant  The single variant can support up to 24 T1  channels or up to 30 E1 channels  The dual variant can support up to 48 Ti channels or 60 E1 channels     e On each card  8 channels per inter
193. d associated names stored centrally in the system  A  Directory Entry can be used to label an incoming call on a caller display telephone or on a PC application  The  Directory also gives a system wide list of frequently used numbers for speed dialling via Phone Manager or a  feature phone with a suitable display     For example  Head Office  can be displayed when a known Caller ID is received  A user can also select  Head  Office  in the Directory List in Phone Manager or on the display phone Directory to speed dial this number  IP  Office s Directory is LDAP  Lightweight Directory Access Protocol  compliant which allows it to be synchronized  with the information on any LDAP server  A maximum of 500 records can be retrieved by this method        Self Administration    The IP Office administrator may give select users the ability to change some of the phone settings themselves     For example  button programming  The range of changes that the user can make depends on the phone type  in use        On Hook Dialing    Avaya digital and IP phones allow the user to make calls by just dialing the number on the keypad  without  having to lift the handset or pressing a speaker button  Usually the call progress can be monitored using the    speaker in the phone  on phones that support handsfree the whole conversation can be had without having to  lift the handset        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 119  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Inb
194. d to perform compression as a background task  which does not  impact the systems ability to record  search or play other calls  It takes approximately 1 minute to compress a  two hour recording  The compressed recordings are stored as 16kbps G 726 format  storage requirements are  therefore 8MBs per hour of recording     The IP Office ContactStore suite can be installed onto the same server as VoiceMail Pro but must be loaded  onto a separate partition  Alternatively  IP Office ContactStore can be installed on a separate drive within the  same server or on a separate server  The minimum PC specification when VoiceMail Pro and IP Office  ContactStore are installed on the same server is detailed in the Voicemail System requirements later in this  chapter     IP Office ContactStore stores recorded calls with certain security in place  Access to recordings is strictly  controlled according to the security constraints configured within the System Administration pages  Each  recording has an owner  the call owner is the number of the extension that recorded the call  You can specify  to which extensions each user has replay rights  the user can search for and replay all calls    owned    by those  stations  Typically an individual may be given rights to replay calls owned by their extension number while  managers may have rights to the extension numbers of all of their staff     The system will automatically generate alarms showing system warnings  Alarms are logged to IP Office  
195. ddition to the added level of security dial back provides it can also  be an excellent method of consolidating remote access charges onto the central office telephone bill     In addition to remote access from Telephone Adaptors  an optional V 90 56Kbps modem module can be added  to provide dial in dial out to from users equipped with analog modems  Also as standard  all ATM4 trunk cards  and Small Office Editions analog trunk ports support switching of the first analog trunk to an integral V 32  modem for remote access        LAN to LAN Routing    All businesses now have a need for data routing whether it s a requirement to share resources such as email  servers  file servers and internet gateways  or seamlessly transport data between sites or network to and from  their customers and suppliers  This is why each IP Office platform offers IP routing as standard        Embedding a router within IP Office removes the costs  complexity and additional points of failure of external  WAN multiplexers by allowing data and voice traffic to converge and share the network resources of IP Office   These network resources can range from dial up ISDN connections  point to point leased circuits  managed IP  networks or Frame Relay as IP Office supports all these types of network connections        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 164  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Data Networking Features          Integral 10 100 Mbit Layer 2 Ethernet Switch    e 
196. de by a user dialing the appropriate short code    by any extension or by specific users        Time Profiles    Time Profiles can be used to define when a Service  Hunt Group  Least Cost Route  Conference Bridge or a  user s dial in facility are operational  For example  a time profile can be used to route Hunt Group calls to a  manned extension or voicemail outside of office hours  or be used to apply different Least Cost Routes at  varying times of day to take advantage of cheaper call rates  Multiple Time Entries can be created so that a  Time Profile can be used to define specific hours in the day e g  09 00 12 00 and 13 00 17 00  Outside of a  Time Profile  voice calls would be re routed according to the configuration but any currently connected calls at  the time the Time Profile changes would not get cut off as the change only affects the routing  Data calls will  get cut off as the time profile goes out of service but a new data call will start immediately if specified  From  Release 4 1  Time Profiles can also be based on specific calendar dates to make allowance for public holidays  or other events        Queuing    Queuing allows calls to a Hunt Group to be held in a queue when all extensions in the group extension List are  busy  When an extension becomes free the queued call is then presented  The definition of queued calls now  includes ringing calls and calls waiting to be presented for ringing  The queue limit can be set to control the  maximum number of call
197. der     DMZ  IP Office           LELLELELELELLE  cnncesneneccnnacancnnencnaseenancnencucancacacesace    Secured LAN    Firewall    Router    Option 3  Connection to the ITSP over NAT using 3rd party STUN  Simple Traversal of UDP through NAT   servers in the network to discover the NAT mechanism being used     STUN  server        SIP Service  Provider             IP Office          RE me  irewall      Router              Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved        Page 148  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Option 4  Connection to the ITSP through a router equipped with an Application Level Gateway  ALG  which  transparently resolves all NAT issues           SIP Service  Provider       sip Router    CELECEECECECEELELE CE EEE EEE EP ET Serr     ALG    IP Office    For details on SIP ITSPs which have been tested by Avaya  please see the Technical Bulletin for the IP Office  4 0 release and or IP Office Knowledge Base at http   www avaya com ipoffice knowledgebase        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 149  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Packet Based Voice Networking       This section describes the options available for businesses that are able to utilize data networks to support  voice solutions such as Voice over IP  VoIP   IP Office offers networked voice and data communications   providing     e Built in IP router  e One link for voice and data networking  e Common access to the Internet  share files 
198. des enhanced functionality  including the ability to control multiple telephones and gives  access to advanced call center operation     Because IP networking is integrated into the IP Office system  all CTI is done through the LAN  On many other  systems  CTI is delivered by a physical connection between each handset and computer  first party CTI   This  introduces additional points of failure  as well as relying on non standard interfaces and handsets  On IP Office   all devices can be used with CTI        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 194  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        CTI with IP Office    IP Office offers a significant CTI capability  Several interfaces are supported        e TAPILink Lite    e TAPILink Pro    e TAPI WAV driver   e DevLink Pro    e IP Office SMDR     e IP Office Software Development Kit     e TAPILink Lite  Provides first party CTI support for Microsoft TAPI 2 1 and TAPI 3 0  so each PC can control or monitor  one handset device  The software components are supplied with the IP Office system on the User CD   Rom  and do not required a license key for use     e TAPILink Pro  Provides third party CTI support for TAPI 2 1 and 3 0  These components are identical to their first   party equivalent  the presence of the CTI Link Pro RFA license key  which can be purchased in the usual  way for products  enables this additional functionality     e TAPI WAV driver  Provides software based support for voice processing 
199. details about equipment and  resources in the IP Office system  This includes indication of alarms and details of current calls in progress for  local or remote diagnostics        Scalable Platform    The  all in one  IP Office Family     servers  media modules  trunk interface cards and software applications      give small and mid size businesses the options they want to meet today s communications needs and plans for  the future        e Avaya IP Office 500  Modular  flexible chassis which supports up to 32 extensions  up to 272 with expansion modules   with  capacity for up to 16 analog trunks or 8 digital trunks  up to 192 T1 channels or 240 E1 channels  using  internal daughter cards  Up to 8 Expansion Modules may be added to provide a combination of up to  272 analog  digital or IP extensions  with additional analog trunks through external Analog 16 modules   Features include 128 optional voice compression channels  2 independently switched LAN ports and an  optional Embedded Messaging card     e Avaya IP Office IP412  Supports 12 Expansion Modules providing a combination of up to 360 analog  digital or IP extensions   with capacity for 8 analog trunks or 4 digital trunks  up to 96 T1 channels or 120 E1 channels    Additional analog trunks can be added using IP400 Analog 16 modules  Features include 60 optional  voice compression channels  2 independently switched LAN ports  and 108 data channels  An Internal  Modem Card can be added to answer up to 12 V 90 analog mode
200. disconnects from the  conference bridge  the last calls is disconnected automatically by the system for added security     Control Unit Conference Capabilities    The following tables show the maximum number of conference parties when calling via the different types of    interface available on IP Office     Maximum Participants   Small office   1P406 V2  Edition    E1 ISDN  Rest of World     T1 PRI T1 6 64 64 96 92 64 64  IP 6 30 60 64  Internal users 6 64 2x64 64  Total max  24 64 2x64 64    1  Analog Trunk Restriction    In conferences that include external analog line calls  a maximum of two analog line calls are allowed  per conference       External Participants  Each external caller requires a digital trunk VoIP channel  for example 1 T1 allows 23 24 external  parties  1 E1 allows 30 parties and a VCM 20 allows 20 parties        Use of Conference Resources by Other Features   System features such as call intrusion  call recording and silent monitoring all use conference resources   as does automatic recording if enabled  When any of these features are active the number of slots  available for conference parties is reduced       The IP412 Supports Two 64 party Conference Banks   When a new conference is started  the bank with the most free capacity is used for that conference   However once a conference is started on one conference bank  that conference cannot use any free  capacity from the other conference bank  i e  no more than 64 parties in any one conference      
201. dth on IP and Frame Relay services     e Not available in all territories  check for availability        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 314  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Optional Wireless Access Point    All IP Office   Small Office Edition platforms can be configured to become Wireless LAN access points  An  Access Point acts as a Hub in a wireless network providing connectivity between devices in the vicinity  In ideal  conditions a range of up to 550M  1750 ft  is achievable although this range will be decreased if walls and  other obstacles are present  This is used where local conditions impair coverage and additional Access Points  are needed to cover the black spots     Additional  ae ree a A Access Point       Coverage  Area       e      m     m e m            Integral    Access Point    The IP Office   Small Office Edition wireless network can be secured against intruders using either the Wired  Equivalent Privacy  WEP  or RC4  WEP uses 64 bit encryption key and RC4 uses a 128 bit encryption key  Only  devices with a matching security key can participate in the network     IP Office   Small Office Edition complies to the IEEE 802 11 and IEEE 802 11b standards meeting the Wireless  Ethernet Compatibility Alliance  WECA  Wireless Fidelity Wi Fi requirements for interoperability     Summary  e 2 4 GHz to 2 5 GHz band  Scientific Medical and Industrial  SMI  band    e Automatic fallback 11Mbps  5 5Mbps  2Mbps or 1Mbps   e IEEE 
202. dual agents to see their own individual statistics  those for their  group  or for the whole contact center  Agents can customize their view so that information is  presented in the way most useful to them  In additional  supervisors can set particular messages to  appear on PC Wallboards  as a motivational or informational tool  Please refer to the CCC System  Administration manual for a complete list of variables available     3rd Party Integration    e Microsoft TAPI Integration  By utilizing either the 1st party or 3rd party TAPI support on IP Office businesses can link their  contact management to their telephony  e g  ACT  Goldmine  and increase the productivity of their  agents and the profitability of the contact center        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 252    IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Call Center View   Real Time Reporting    Supervisors in a contact center are there to manage workload  Call Center View provides the Supervisors with  the combination of real time service monitoring and resource management  allowing them to balance and  manage their resources  i e  staffing levels against the traffic levels of incoming calls  and therefore improve  customer service and reduce costs  Call Center View contains 18 real time screens showing all aspects of the  Contact Center activity  Alarms may be set on up to 16 parameters per device  with three levels per alarms  available  ensuring that a supervisor will be infor
203. e    The Call Intrude feature allows a user  if permission through IP Office Manager is given  to join an existing  conversation whether this is an internal or external call     A user with the  Can Intrude  option can join a call on any extension on the system  however  a User with   Cannot be Intruded  setting would prevent others from joining their call        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 107  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Inclusion    This feature enables selected users to intrude on calls that are already in progress  The intruding party  intrudes on the existing call and all parties hear a tone  The speech path is enabled between the intruding  party and the called user  the other party is forced onto hold and will not hear the conversation  On completion  of the intrusion the called party speech path is reconnected to the original connected party  The feature is  enabled or disabled on a per user basis through the Manager application        Private Call    Users can set a status of private call using short codes or a programmed button  Private calls cannot be  recorded  intruded on  bridged into or monitored        Hot Desking    Hot Desking allows a number of users non exclusive use the same extension  Each user logs in with their own  identity so they can receive calls and can access their own Voicemail and other facilities  For example  sales  personnel who visit the office infrequently can be provided with telephony a
204. e    This module provides additional analog telephone interfaces   e Two Wire  e DTMF signaling  No rotary or Loop Disconnect   e Time Break Recall  No Earth Loop Recall   e Caller ID capable    e Message Waiting Indication  MWI  capable   High Voltage  Pulsed High Voltage  Line Reversal    The IP400 Phone module is available in 3 versions  giving 8  16 or 30 extensions  Telephones can be located  up to 1km from the control unit  For extensions located  out of the building  additional line protection will be  needed  For more information on cabling and out of building guidelines  see the IP Office Installation Manual     11 1  19 20 21 22 23 24 POT 25 26 27 28 23 30    us RE EEE EEE S ee    Oc P         OTE EXPANSION  ca       24Y DC     5 04 MAX   DIGITAL STATION Y2  24  DC     1 54   PHONE V2       e IP Office Phone Modules provide support for a variety of analog MWI methods  These methods are 51V  Stepped  81V  101V and Line Reversal  The 101V method is only supported when using a Phone V2  expansion module     e Each analog port can support a device of maximum 1 REN     e On analog ports  call information is sent while the phone is ringing  and cannot be updated during a call  or set on an outbound call  the phone may do a local match but this is not controlled by the IP Office    The primary purpose of displays is to give information about incoming calls  Where the Caller Display  standard chosen supports the delivery of text  extension name  as well as the number  both 
205. e  e External O P socket supporting two relay on off switch ports  e g  for door entry systems   e Audio input port for external music on hold source   e Two trunk interface card slots for analog  BRI  PRI  Ti  E1  or CAS  E1R2   e 2 internal sockets for IP Telephony expansion   voice compression modules  from 4 to 30 channels   e Internal socket for internal modem  2 or 12  for Remote Access Services  e 108 Data channels    e Up to 30 VoiceMail Pro ports    e Two 10 100 switched Ethernet ports  Layer 3         Expansion Module WAH Port Unit Status LED Trunk Port LAH Ports  Status LEDs Status LED Red   Starting  Status LEDs 104 00Mbps auto sensing  Green   Started  Layer 3 Ethernet Switch          EXPANSION  2 4 6 8 10 12  COMBEIE       LILI    183 5 7 9 1        D                   DTE Serial Port WAH Port Expansion Ports 1 12  9 pin D type socket  37 pin D Type socket     X21  V35 or V24  Audio input Port  DC Power Input Socket 3 5mm Stereo jack socket         To external power supply unit        Trunk Interface Card Slots  External Output Socket All trunk card types   3 5mm Stereo jack socket   Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 32    IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Expansion Modules    Through support of up to twelve external Expansion Modules  IP412 can be enhanced to support a mixture of  analog  digital or IP phones  to maximum of 360 phones in any combination     If additional analog trunks are required  these can be aggregated in 
206. e 249  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Alarms   The Small Business Contact provides different levels of alarms for the supervisor and agent to properly  manage their call center activity  As parameters move from a normal to alarm state  the color of the field  within the realtime view will change depending upon the level of alarm  white for normal  yellow for caution   red for alarm  and blue for alarm acknowledged  The following statistics can have alarms set against them  within the IP Office Customer Call Reporter     Statistic Full Name   ANE TIE  TEE  os Warning   Alarm Type      Queue Agent    Agent State Queue Time          lt     gt 1 999    Agents ACW    lt 4   150       Agents Available NN NN  lt v          lt 1 150     Agents Logged On   7         lt 1 150     Answered Calls   1 999       Answered External  Non Queue           gt 1 999       Answered Internal  Non Queue           lt     gt 1 999       Answered Internal  Queue       lt       lt     gt 1 999     Average Answer     SO      lt      lt 1 100     Busy Not Available     lt         gt 1 150     Calis Waiting C t  lt 7        gt 1 99    Current Wait Time     lt         gt 1 600     Grade of Service              lt 1 100     Internal Made        lt     gt 1 99    Longest WaitTime      lt        1  gt 1 600    Lost Calls    lt 4    lt     gt 1 99     No Answer    lt 4    lt     gt 1 99     Outbound Calls  External           lt     gt 1 999     Overflowed Answered     lt         gt 1 99     Overflo
207. e 3711 phone supports the same features as the 3701 IP DECT handset but with the following differences   e Full handsfree speakerphone operation   e Headset connection  2 5 mm jack    e Vibrating alarm   e Personal phone book with 100 entries  e Access to system phone book   e Voice Mail indication   e Choice from 30 ring tones   e Speaker and handset volume  7 levels and mute capability   e Automatic call pick up using a headset     e 10 menu languages  Danish  Dutch  English  Finnish  French  German  Italian  Portuguese  Spanish and  Swedish     e Illuminated 5 line graphic display   96 x 60 pixels   variable 7 level contrast     Optional handset accessories include   e Desktop charger   e An adapter cord for use with headsets     e Heavy duty belt clip        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 81  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Digital Wireless 3810 Telephone       Features    2 line  32 character Handset Liquid Crystal Display  LCD     10 hours of talk time  and 4 days of standby time    4 displayed operation modes indicating Talk  Ringer On Off  Battery Low  and Message Waiting   Single button access to fixed features   Hold  Transfer  Conference  and Redial    4 programmable buttons to access features on the PBX    20 Number Memory for quick and easy speed dialing   10 channels  supporting up to 10 simultaneous conversations in overlapping radio coverage areas   Headset jack    Ringer and Handset volume control    User selectable
208. e call activity is shown on the matching  call appearance button  The call appearance button user can join or takeover the call using their call  appearance button     Bridged appearance buttons allow paired  manager secretary  style operation between two users  and are only  supported for users who have call appearance buttons        Call Coverage    Feature  e Allow unanswered calls to alert at other user extensions and be answered there before being forwarded  or going to voicemail     Benefit  e Provide users the opportunity to answer colleague   s unanswered calls before they go to voicemail     Description   When a user has an unanswered call ringing  after a configurable delay  the call will also start alerting on any  call coverage buttons associated with the user on other extensions  The call can then be answered by pressing  the call coverage button  If still unanswered the call is forward or goes to voicemail as normal     The time a call rings before also alerting on any associated call coverage buttons can be adjusted for each  user        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 113  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Outbound Call Handling Features       Every business needs to make calls  but depending on the type of business these calls may need to be treated  in a special way  such as recorded against a project or client through the use of Account Codes  A business  may have several sites linked via a private network but certai
209. e call to proceed  for example long distance or  international numbers  Analog phone users can only enter account codes before making a call or in response to  an audible system prompt to enter a code when making the call     Account codes can also be entered through the IP Office Phone Manager application  a system wide setting   determines whether Phone Manager will display a list of account codes from which users can select the code  required or will hide the account code list     In all the cases above  the account code entered is included with the call details in the IP Office s call record  output   CDR and SMDR         Authorization Codes    Authorization codes allow an IP Office user to go to another extension on the system and make calls using  their personal toll restrictions  this may grant the user greater or fewer privileges than the normal owner of  the extension they use  Since Authorization Codes are independent of Account Codes  the user has to enter  both if the required by the system configuration  All entered codes are logged in CDRs        Dial Emergency    Dial emergency is an IP Office Short Code and  permits certain numbers to be dialed regardless of call barring  or a phone being logged off        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 114  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Call Barring    Feature  e It is possible to prevent or allow calls to certain numbers such as international numbers or premium rate  numbers for 
210. e generally lower cost and their global reach is normally greater   Access to the IP VPN is via one of IP Office s WAN ports     A managed IP network or IP VPN is a private network of routers managed and partitioned by a single network  service provider who assigns IP addresses and manages the network  Because of this  the network service  provider can guarantee throughput levels  minimize latency and ensure transmission speeds to give greater  quality of service supported by a contracted service level agreement  Avaya do not recommend networking IP  Office systems over a unmanaged public IP networks where neither QoS nor service levels can be guaranteed  by the provider     VoIP across the LAN    In a factory or campus environment  voice calls can sent over 10 100 Mbps LAN connections on systems  equipped with optional Voice Compression Modules  VCM   In order to avoid bandwidth contention issues  VoIP  across the LAN will require some form of bandwidth management through Diffserve        VoIP networking across the LAN    VoIP across the Public Network    IP Office is capable of realizing the benefits of Q 931 and H 450 supplementary service support across a public  connection where an appropriate QoS connection can be established        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 151  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Supplementary Services within IP Networks       Supplementary services within an IP environment are provided via Q 931 and H 323 
211. e in this mode calls are presented to the  Out of Service group    Voicemail can also be used in conjunction with Hunt Groups to take all group related messages  play an  announcement when the Hunt Group is in Night Service or Out of Service mode and give announcements while  a call is held in a queue  For internal voicemail use a broadcast option is provided  This feature will alter the  voicemail box operation so that the message notification will only be turned off for each hunt group member  when they retrieve their own copy of the message        Small Community Networking  SCN  Distributed Hunt Groups    Small Community Networking  SCN  Distributed Hunt Groups    Hunt groups in a Small Community Network can include members located on other systems within the  network  This feature requires entry of an Advanced Small Community Networking license in each system in  the network     Note  Distributed Hunt Groups are not supported for use with CCC        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 121  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Night Service    When a Hunt Group is in Night Service mode the Hunt Group is temporarily disabled  Callers to this Hunt  Group will     e Pass to a Night Service Fallback group used to provide cover  e g  pass calls to a manned extension or  an external number    e Be played the Out of Hours greeting if Voicemail is operational    e Receive the busy tone    A Hunt Group can be switched in or out of Night Service mo
212. e licenses will continue to be available for systems that need to expand their current  coverage or capacity     IP DECT Capacities    Maximum handsets 120  Maximum base stations 32  Total base stations repeaters 32  Maximum simultaneous calls 100      May be limited by the available VCM voice compression channels for calls to non IP destinations        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 70  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Wireless   900MHz Digital Wireless    The Avaya Digital Wireless uses the 902 to 928 MHz ISM  Industrial  Scientific  and Medical  band  Unlike  some other in building wireless systems  there are no airtime charges  and no license is required  This handset    uses digital radio technology and spread spectrum frequency hopping to provide extremely secure wireless  communications     The Avaya 3810 wireless telephone is a digital telephone designed to work with IP Office  minimum release  2 0   It offers the mobility inherent in a wireless telephone plus access to a number of features and  functionality of the connected communications system  The Avaya 3810 wireless telephone uses 900 MHz  digital technology allowing a maximum range of 160 feet from the base station     A maximum of 5 Avaya 3810 wireless handsets can be used in the same zone of radio coverage  Site Planning  rules do apply  please refer to installation guides available in the IP Office Knowledge Base        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights r
213. e operation are intended for individual use only  not for group and    conference room operation        Product Description    IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 98  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Chapter 4   Features       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 99  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     4  Features    IP Office provides a comprehensive telephony feature set to enable a fast and efficient response to a telephone  call  Features such as Caller ID display and call tagging allow employees to see who is calling and who they are  calling before they pick the call up  Client information can even be  popped up  on the user s PC     For those who are not tied to a desk  Wireless handsets and twinning offer mobility around the office  For  those out of the office  be it on the road or working from home  comprehensive and easy to use call  forwarding facilities  PC Softphone and a remote access service allow them to remain in telephone contact and  access centralized resources at all times     Incoming calls can be efficiently handled using either Direct Dialling  DDI DID  or dedicated operators  For out  of hours calls or times when you just can t take calls  IP Office provides voicemail and optional Auto Attendant  services        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 100  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Basic Call Handling                      Tones  IP Office generates the correc
214. e protection will be  needed  For more information on cabling and out of building guidelines  see the IP Office Installation Manual     IP Office 500    17 1 13 20 21 22 23 24    EEES EEES    EEES    DC WP         OTE EXPANSION  io Le  K       24 DC     5 04 MAX   DIGITAL STATION V2  24 DC     1 54   PHONE   2       e IP Office Phone Modules provide support for a variety of analog MWI methods  These methods are 51V  Stepped  81V  101V and Line Reversal  The 101V method is only supported when using a Phone V2  expansion module     e Each analog port can support a device of maximum 1 REN     e On analog ports  call information is sent while the phone is ringing  and cannot be updated during a call  or set on an outbound call  the phone may do a local match but this is not controlled by the IP Office    The primary purpose of displays is to give information about incoming calls  Where the Caller Display  standard chosen supports the delivery of text  extension name  as well as the number  both are  delivered     e An analog extension port can be set for external Paging operation  It does not operate like a normal  extension and is connected to external equipment through an isolation device  The Port will always be  busy so it cannot be called directly and can only be accessed by using a short code  When not receiving  a Page the port will remain silent  when being paged the page tone is sent before the speech path is  opened        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights re
215. e supported on each bus  There is no hardware modification to the  cards and as a result there will be no    signalling power     This feature does require crossover cables and line  termination  if not provided by the terminal equipment   A suitable converter cable is available from Avaya   material code 700458649      Voice over IP Enhancements   IP Office 4 2 introduces changes to allow easier installation of Avaya 1600  4600 and 5600 Series phones as  well as T3 IP and IP DECT phones  with minimal user intervention and to allow greater configurability for more  complex network environments     DHCP Enhancements  IP500 only    In IP Office 4 2  the embedded DHCP server can now support 8 non contiguous pools of address ranges  each  fully configurable into different subnets  The server can be configured to only serve Avaya VoIP telephone  clients  It will also offer consistent IP addresses to clients after reboots     Server Enhancements  IP500 only   In IP Office 4 2 the total number of clients that can be served by all embedded servers  DHCP  TFTP HTTP   RAS H323  has been increased to 50     Embedded File Management  IP500 and IP406 V2 only   IP Office 4 2 provides a new user interface within Manager to list the directory content of the removable  Compact Flash card  as well as upload  download and delete files     IP Phone Forced Re Registration  This new option within the IP Office 4 2 System Status Application  SSA  permits the remote re registration of  individual or
216. e that the report is first scheduled to be run  Months are from the last full months data i e  if the  report is scheduled in February then January will be the last month in the report     e Report Range  The start and end date for the report     e Language  If the default language is not required then another language can be selected that your system  supports     Filters can be used in the report to provide exactly the type of information the customer is looking for  The  filter field is used to refine the data and offers the following options in a drop down list  All  Answered   Refused  Refused Overflowed  Overflowed All  Overflowed Off PBX  Overflowed on PBX  Transferred and Lost  Calls  The default setting is all     Reports can also be scheduled for future delivery to any network printer or email address in any of the  supported formats        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 247  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     IP Office Customer Call Reporter Report Examples    Call Details Report    LE  amp  K    gt      gt   FE 3      100  z     My Call Details    01 12 2008   22 12 2008 09 00   17 00  Supervisor Name    Status  Answered    Answered  Lost  Answered    Answered    Mark Gallagher    Reference  000140    000141  000143  000144  000145    01 12 2008   22 12 2008 9 00   17 00    Report Type Target Name  Call Details Report   All Queue  Ungrouped  Time Stamp Call Direction Number DDI Queue Queue Time Agent Duration  02 12 2008 13 09
217. e use of a DVD recorder for long term archiving is recommended   e A figure of 7 2MB per hour of archived recordings is given     e The archived messages held by IP Office ContactStore are accessed via web browser using the port  address 8888  This port address is not configurable and so it is necessary to ensure that it does not  conflict with any other web server service running on the same server PC        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 226  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 227  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Chapter 12   Audio Conferencing       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 228  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     12  Audio Conferencing    A problem familiar to any organization is that of communicating effectively  As more and more people work  from home or from dispersed locations  how do you ensure that employees are planning and working together  effectively  and regularly keeping in touch when separated by time and distance  In addition  many companies  choose to sub contract some services such as payroll  logistics or manufacturing to third party suppliers  How  do you ensure that you can act as one virtual enterprise  Audio conferencing provides a simple and effective  solution     Audio conferencing makes it easy to include key people in decision making wherever they are with minimum  interruption from their work
218. ected to a trunk port     e Users with the trunk appearance will be notified when a visitor has pressed the Push button located on  the weatherproof speaker     e Each controller supports two speakers  for example Front Door and Back Door   e Custom ringing mode distinguishes doorphone calls from external calls     e Call waiting tones indicate which doorphone is calling and distinguish a doorphone call from an external  line call     e Calls can be placed on hold when visitors call from the doorphone     e Commercial or residential security is provided via two way handsfree communication from a door or  gate        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 94  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Kalika Communications Doorphone Entry System        e Supports a doorway intercom system with up to 46 buttons     e The system can be programmed to enable multiple extensions to answer and control the operation of  the door and can be used with both single and multiple door entry systems     e It is ideal for apartment complexes or where different companies occupy different floors and require  their own unique door entry solution     e The Kalika Communications Control Unit is available in several versions and is equipped to provide two   way voice communications  electrical lock control and label lamps     e It is weatherproof and remotely programmable     e For sales enquiries and product information contact Kalika Communications at info kalika co uk     
219. ection which digits need to be regenerated by a local DTMF generator on behalf of the sending  IP extension  This is useful when navigating external voicemail systems and Auto Attendants     e Direct Media Path  Direct Media Path allows the speech path between two IP extensions  after call setup  to be routed  directly to each other  This allows the IP Office system to free up voice compression resources after  establishing the end to end connection  allowing the resources to be used in the most efficient way     e Auto Create Extensions  IP Office can automatically create an extension entry for new IP phones added onto the local area  network  In cases where the local area network is not secure this facility can be disabled  but simplifies  installation of IP telephone systems    e Fax Transport  Fax Transport allows fax calls to be routed over VoIP trunks between IP Office systems on an IP  network using a proprietary IP Office transport protocol  This is different from the T 38 protocol which is  not supported     LAN Switch Support    Avaya recommend the use of Extreme switches for IP telephony applications  For more information  contact  Extreme Networks        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 132  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Power Options for IP Telephones       Avaya supports the IEEE 802 3af  standard for Power over Ethernet  PoE  on its range of IP telephones  With  Power over Ethernet  both power and data are carried ove
220. ed Transfers No No Yes    Other Features    Embedded  VoiceMail  VoiceMail  Voicemail  Lite Pro    Call Recording       Test Conditions No No Yes  Personal Numbering No No Yes  Speaking Clock No No Yes  Campaign Manager No No Yes  VoiceMail Pro Manager No No Yes  Customized Voicemail No No Yes  Intuity TUI emulation mode  No No Yes  Forward Emails to External Systems  VPIM  No No Yes  Third Party Database Access  IVR  No No Yes  Text To Speech within call flows No No Yes  Support for Visual Basic Scripts No No Yes  Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 222    IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     IP Office VoiceMail Pro Intuity Audix Emulation Features    Voicemail Box  Intuity Feature support  Feature    Basic Commands    VoiceMail Pro support     4  or  H  Help Yes   7  or  R  Return to main menu Yes   9  or  W  Wait Yes    6  or   N   Look up number name Yes    Q  or   X   Exit system Yes  0 or  0 Transfer call to operator Yes   3  or  D  Delete Yes    8  or   U   Un delete Yes    4  or   H   Hold message in category Yes   8  or  T  Transfer out Yes    7  or   R   Log in again Yes   9 Increase speed Not supported   8 Decrease speed Not supported   4 Increase volume Not supported   7 Decrease volume Not supported  6 Skip forward Yes  5 Skip backwards Yes   6 Skip to next message component Yes   5 Skip to previous message component Yes  2 or   2  Rewind to start of message  skip to previous Yes   message   Play back header after pressing 2 Yes   1
221. ed with a range of selected special functions  These keys can be used for calling  other extensions on the system  Direct Station Select or DSS keys   or can be used for options from speed  dialing numbers to controlling features such as Do Not Disturb  Many features use an indicator to show  whether a feature is enabled  Button programming is done through the IP Office Manager application as part of  the system configuration  although some phones allow the user to program buttons and functions where given  administration rights        Busy Lamp Field  BLF  Indicators    Feature  e Status indicators which show the status of a programmable buttons associated feature or function     Benefit  e Indication of when a button or associated feature is active     Description   Avaya digital and IP phones have programmable buttons which can be assigned to various features  When  those buttons include some form of BLF indicator  the button can also be used to indicate when the feature is  active  For example  a button associated with another user will indicate when that user is active on a call  A  button associated with a group will indicate when the group has calls waiting to be answered     The speed dial icons within the IP Office Phone Manager and SoftConsole applications also act as BLF s  When  the icons are associated with internal users  the icons will change to indicate the current status of the users     Phone Manager and SoftConsole show these conditions      A Busy    e on 
222. email 203  Email addresses 207  218  233  Email application 203  email inboxes 20       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 325  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       Email Notification 203  233  266  Email Reading 207   email reading checkbox 207  Email Systems 20  203   email WAV 198   emails 201  203  207   e mails 150   Embedded 21   Embedded Applications 55  56  58  60  64  65  66  Embedded Messaging 21  104  Embedded Messaging Card 266  Embedded Voice Memory 290    Embedded Voicemail 10  20  21  25  122  126   135  198  200  220  266  273    Enable ARS Form 126  Enable Internal Forward Busy 126  Enable Internal Forward Unconditional 126  Enable Internal Forwards 126  enabled disabled 107  Encapsulation 166   Frame Relay 138  encoding   G711 75 78  Enlarged earpiece 79  Enterprise 72  84  182  206  229  ENTITY MIB 291  entry double 232  Entry level voicemail 200  EnumerateAddresses 282  equating   Exchange User 224  Equisys 206  ERP 206  escalates   doctor   s mobile cell 215  ESP 291  ESP DES CBC Cipher Algorithm 291  Estimated Time 259   Answer 220  Estonia 277  ETA 220  Ethernet 10  19  21  25  32  37  55  56  58  60  62   64  65  66  69  72  129  133  147  162  165  273  Ethernet eliminates 133  Ethernet LAN 72  129    Ethernet Ports 21 55  56  58  60  64  65  66  147   162  165    Ethernet Switch 10  19  162  165  273  EU24 40  42  60  62  Euro ISDN 30  Euro ISDN BRI 273  Excel 238  including 252  Except 63  67  88  1
223. ences 6   Telephone Adaptors   Telephone Cord 82   Telephone Devices 71  196   telephone establish 131   Telephone Extension Cable Lengths 287   Telephone Options 22   Telephone User Interface   telephone wishing 131   Telephones Compatible  Other Ranges 85   telephones including 18   telephones operating 138   Telephones Section 40  42   telephones utilizing Power 133   Telephony Functions 100   Telephony Signals 291   Telephony Tones 291   telesales 201   Terminal Support 10   Test Conditions 220   Text To Speech 20  22  201  207  211  220  224   Text    209   Text to Speech 201    21  164    201  213  214  215    TFTP 72  75  78  137  291  thats 6   that   s right 6   There   s 6   These Lite 22   theyre 174    Third Party Database Access 220  Third Party Fax 206  Third Party Text  Speech 22  Third Party Text To Speech 22  Through Network Address Translators 291  TIA EIA 646 B  conform 143    til 105  Time Division Multiplexing 24  time during  product 22  Time Entries 122  time linking  office 162  Time Profile 10  108  121  122  166  215  217  283    timebands 164   Timed Break Recall 41   Time Division Multiplexed Telephony 129  timeframe 220    timeout 10 101  102  215  283  timeout causes  user 10       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 339  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       TLS 10  TNS 143  ToEmail 201  203  220  Toggle Calls 101  126  toolkit 195  toolset 20  toolset including 20  Topic 254  Total base stations 
224. ense offers to the users is a web interface allowing voicemail access via a web    browser  such as IE7 or Mozilla Firefox  with the ability to listen to targeted voicemails by using either the PC s  multimedia equipment or the desk phone                                   Change Password u  User name h  Please enter your current password s     Please enter your new password  ose  L Please re enter your new password jo Sti Citi   s   SS  AVAYA ermemes    Welcome  Manke   Sanat  Change past AV  YA    X Delete ut in Folde Save fark as read lark as umeac watt A r  Det Pu f t k k M T j F j Voicemail Pro  CSC roe IE   amp  Inbox M Stat Caller ID Received on v Lenath Password  nase  E Trash cra 0001212 01 May 2008 16 24 03 im9s eat  C   0056269 30 April 2008 15 15 06 38s      r Q 0001905 22 April 2008 15 07 22 4is  oser   D 16 Anni 2008 15 16  Forward to Extensions  a   Woke Message is    I Number Name  AVAYA Manke  7675    19227 Exn9227 4  mere us Loge M 9228 Edn9228  A 16 April 2008 15 16 55 8s  M 9229 Edn9229 m  X Deto SO PuinFolier  flSave arose CR Matkasumead  3 Forward  F 9231 Exn9231  Fi chow ieda Pier T I 9232 Extn9232  Windows he Fley  r     been ne F 9233 Exn9233    a ail  M        Pry 4  gt   Fonol       Unified Messaging Services web services requires the VoiceMail Pro installation to be on a server with IIS  pre installed  In addition  the VoiceMail Pro web services option must be selected during installation     Once installed  the system will require the following add
225. enses in combination for the number of agents required    e    5 Additional Agents  IPO LIC IP400 CCC AGT RFA 5 LIC CU  171995    e   10 Additional Agents  IPO LIC IP400 CCC AGT RFA 10 LIC CU  174469    e   20 Additional Agents  IPO LIC IP400 CCC AGT RFA 20 LIC CU  174470    e   50 Additional Agents  IPO LIC IP400 CCC AGT RFA 50 LIC CU  174471     e CCC Wallboards  The display of realtime data and messages on wallboards is controlled by a number of CCC  applications     e CCC Wallboard Server  This application is used to share data with wallboards and to store pre configured wallboard  messages  It requires the base CCC license  above      e CCC Wallboard Client  This application is used to configure the wallboard messages setup on the CCC Wallboard Server   Up to 19 CCC Wallboard Clients can be run  They do not require a specific license     e CCC PC Wallboard   The CCC PC Wallboard client application can be run on a Windows PC to display call data or  wallboard messages  The application requires the user to login  with each logged in instance using a  CCC PC Wallboard license  CCC agents can login to view their own realtime call data  Non agents  can also login but will only see messages configured on the CCC wallboard server application    e    5 Additional PC Wallboards  IPO LIC IP400 CCC PCW RFA 5 LIC CU  172786    e   10 Additional PC Wallboards  IPO LIC IP400 CCC PCW RFA 10 LIC CU  174472    e   20 Additional PC Wallboards  IPO LIC IP400 CCC PCW RFA 20 LIC CU  174473  
226. eply email to the person who sent the email        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 207  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Networked Messaging       Where organizations are operating a number of voicemail systems across different sites it is important to be  able to provide integrated operation between voicemail systems so that messages can be passed between  systems and delivered to a user s mailbox seamlessly  This is achieved by IP Office VoiceMail Pro being  licensed to support Networked Messaging     The Networked Messaging Solution defines a common set of features to allow inter working between Avaya  voicemail systems  In INTUITY mode  while listening to or having listened to a message  the user can select  the option to forward the message to another mailbox  the mailbox entered can be any mailbox number on the  local system or any mailbox on a remote Avaya system     The IP Office Networked Messaging facility will allow configuration of up to 2000 remote mailboxes on each  VoiceMail Pro server and will operate with other IP Office systems supporting this feature  as well as the Avaya  Interchange and Avaya S3210 servers     IP Office            Public or  Private  Network    Intuity Audix          eaves Note  In this scenario   message for Avaya Interchange will  ext  3000 be required at the central  site   VoiceMail Pro Ext  2000 Ext  3000  Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 208    IP Office 4 2 Issue 
227. er   note that some of these phones are only available in certain countries and regions     Phones supported worldwide in addition to    4406D Telephone  85   4412D Telephone  86   4424D Telephone 874   4450 DSS Unit  885   T3 Compact  Upn and IP  644  T3 Comfort  Upn and IP  664    T3 Classic  Upn and IP   654          e 3616 Executive Wireless  WiFi  Phone  754  3620 Healthcare Wireless  WiFi  Phonel 764  3626 Ruggedized Wireless  WiFi  Phone  774  3641 Ruggedized Wireless  WiFi  Phonel 784  3645 Ruggedized Wireless  WiFi  Phonel 795  3701 IP DECT Wireless Handset  80    3711 IP DECT Wireless Handset  81    3810 Wireless Telephone  824    Interquartz Gemini 9281 AV  9330 AV and e  9335 AV analog telephones  91    5400 Series                    IP phones supported worldwide in addition to    the current 5600 and 1600 Series        2402 Telephone  56  2410 Telephone  584    2420 Telephone  604  XM24 DSS Unit     EU24 EU24BL DSS Unit  624  Analog Telephones  8              e 4601 IP Telephone 55  4602SW IP Telephone       4610SW IP Telephone       4621SW IP Telephone    4625SW IP Telephone     56   58   60        605    Q       Phones supported on IP Office 4 2 but no longer available for new sales     6408D Telephone  6416D Telephone  6424D Telephone    e 20DT DECT Telephone  with IP DECT only     5601 IP Telephone  5620 IP Telephone  4620 IP Telephone    e For maximum cabling distances please refer to the IP Office Installation Manual     e Those phones that support handsfre
228. er  Integrate your customer data base into your call  handling  Manage the quality of your customer interactions     Work anywhere     Give your employees all the communications capabilities they have at the office whether they are working  from home  a hotel or a remote office     A complete conferencing solution     Don t pay any more fees to outside conferencing service providers  Get Web and audio based conferencing  that are easy to set up and use     Secure converged communications     Use IP Office as a secure router with a built in firewall VPN  Route voice calls over a managed Internet service   VoIP  and pocket the savings  Simple administration Windows based  menu driven tools cut the time and  expense of administration        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 9  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        What s New in IP Office 4 2       For those already familiar with IP Office  this section lists the new features introduced in IP Office 4 2  This is  not an exhaustive list  however  it covers the major changes that are aimed at improving product  manageability  flexibility and end user mobility     Hardware Support    IP Office Control Unit Support  e IP Office 4 2 is supported on the IP Office 500 and IP412 as well as the Small Office Edition and IP406  V2  no longer sold      e IP Office 4 2 is not supported on the IP403 and IP406 V1     Note  Not all of the features in IP Office 4 2 are supported on all platforms   please see eac
229. ered by a user stops when that call is transferred to another user     e Recording triggered by a hunt group continues if the call is transferred to another member of the  same group     e Recordings triggered by an incoming call route last until the call is cleared from the system     Call recording uses the conference facility and so is subject to the conference restrictions of the IP Office  system  For some situations  it may be a requirement that call parties are advised that their call is about to be  recorded  This is done by switching on the Play Advice on Call Recording option via the VoiceMail Pro client   The maximum length of any call recording is 60 minutes       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 217  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        IP Office ContactStore       The standard Call Recording facilities provided with IP Office and VoiceMail Pro can be extended further by  using IP Office ContactStore  IP Office ContactStore stores and catalogs recordings so that they are easily  accessible for later retrieval  Any recordings that you instruct VoiceMail Pro to    send to the Voice Recording  Library    are placed in a database     IP Office ContactStore is provided with the VoiceMail Pro software CD set and has an inbuilt 45 day trial  license  A fully featured IP Office ContactStore system can be installed and used for 45 days from the creation  of the first recording  After this time the system will stop taking recordings unt
230. erling Court  15   21 Mundells  Welwyn Garden City  Hertfordshire   AL7 1LZ   England    Tel   44  0  1707 392200  Fax   44  0  1707 376933    Web  http   marketingtools avaya com knowledgebase       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 344  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     
231. ervice  UMS  is being introduced to replace the Integrated Messaging Solution  IMS   While  it delivers almost the same functionality that was available on IMS  the UMS solution dramatically simplifies the  installation and configuration  It delivers the user with two client interfaces through which voicemail messages  can be retrieved from VoiceMail Pro     Voice Mail Synchronization via IMAP  Email applications such as Outlook which support IMAP can connect to an IMAP server integrated with the  VoiceMail Pro server         l    IP Office     l  L     Mail Server       e g  Exchange             os Pi N  optional    PC with Desk Phone  Mail Client   e g  Outlook     When using a mail client new voice mails arrive as an email with wave attachment and the user can handle  them like every other email  If a voicemail has been listened to  its status will change to    read    everywhere  If  the user deletes it  it will be deleted everywhere     Users that have UMS access enabled just need to add an additional email account to their client to be able to  use the unified messaging features     The instructions how to add this account and configure the web address for the VoiceMail Pro Web Access can  be provided by an administrator email without the need for system administration or Business Partner support        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 204  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     VoiceMail Pro Web Access    The second interface the UMS lic
232. ery participant allowing them to be  recognized by the system and displayed on the Conferencing Center Web client  if selected   see paragraph  below   If caller announcements are required  VoiceMail Pro can announce each participant by asking them for  their name which is then announced to all participants already on the bridge  Similarly at the end of the  conference  each participant leaving the conference will be announced     MyProfile   Help   Exit  Create Hew Conference   Pending Conferences   In Progress Conferences   View Conference Resources   My Conference Templates   File Uploading      Add Conference Participants    Conference ID  690351  Date  20 07 2006 Start Time  HH MM    16 30  Duration  Mins   30 Participant Count  10  Show Conference Details    Donn pohn abecom  1508123456  Host z     anne Webb CSC ECS L   charles Poyser Jommenccenlee     W  Speak And Listen E     Gonn Deft Pohn avayacom  209  Speak And Listen 2       Peter  Petert xya com  17321234567  Speak And Listen        Saran  Sarah abecom  0147852363  Speak And Listen                                                 Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 234  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     A local address book facility is available to provide a convenient method of managing conference contacts and  using these contacts when booking a conference  The address book can be accessed in two ways  either from  the    My Profile    tab or from the Add Update Conference Part
233. es and button programming features are available so that users can trigger this activity at the  ISDN exchange when required  This feature is NOT available on standard ISDN DSS1 phones     e Advice of Charge   AOC   T3 digital and IP phones only  Phone Manager   Advice of charge during a call  AOC D  and at the end of a call  AOC E  is supported for outgoing ISDN  calls other than QSIG  The call cost is displayable on T3 phones as well as Phone Manager and included  in the IP Office Delta Server SMDR output for call accounting purposes  The IP Office allows  configuration of call cost currency and a call cost mark up for each user     e Call Completion to Busy Subscriber   CCBS   2400  4600  5400  5600  T3  T3 IP  DECT phones  Phone Manager   CCBS can be used where provided by the ISDN service provider  It allows a callback to be set on  external ISDN calls that return busy  It can also be used by incoming ISDN calls to a busy user  This  feature is NOT available on standard ISDN DSS1 phones     e Partial Rerouting   PR   2400  4600  5400  5600  T3  T3 IP  DECT phones  Phone Manager   When forwarding a call on an ISDN channel to an external number using another ISDN channel  partial  rerouting informs the ISDN exchange to perform the forward  thus freeing the channels to the IP Office   This feature is NOT available on standard ISDN DSS1 phones and it is NOT supported on QSIG     e Explicit Call Transfer   ECT   The normal usage of this feature is by a third party application
234. es giving any combination from 2 x 64 party conferences to 42 x  3 party capacity     Only two calls connecting through analog trunks are permitted in any single conference     For more information on managing conference calls  refer to Chapter 12 where IP Office Conferencing Center  is described       Dial On Pickup    Also known as  Hotline   Automatically dials a specified extension when the phone is taken off hook  This  facility is commonly used in unmanned reception areas or for door entry systems to allow visitors to easily  gain assistance        Off Hook Operation    Off Hook Station is designed for users who want their analog phone to operate like digital or IP feature phone   to isolate the user   s phone idle state from the Hook state  This is a useful feature when using Phone Manager  or SoftConsole to control the phone state when using a headset on an analog telephone and with call control  and dialing from Phone Manager or SoftConsole        External Control Port    The IP Office system unit has two electronic switches  similar to relays  which can be normally open  normally  closed  pulsed open or pulsed closed and activated by dialing a short code or through Phone Manager   SoftConsole or VoiceMail Pro action     These switches can be used for several purposes  for example as a means to control an electronic door  release  The External Control Port switches are used to trigger control purpose built door release equipment  which is supplied by a third party  A
235. es is only available in North America        The 4406 supports the following features   e 6 Programmable call appearance feature keys with twin lamps   e 8 Fixed Feature Keys  Speaker  Mute  Hold  Volume Up and Down  Conference  Transfer  Redial   e 2 x 16 Character Display   e Message waiting indicator   e Two way handsfree speaker phone   e Hearing aid compatible   e Optional wall mounting desk stand     e Connects to an IP Office DS  Digital Station  port     Note that this telephone does not support integrated directory access on the IP Office  This phone does not  support personalized ringing     This phone is not supported on the IP500 DS8 Extension Card  For the IP500 it will work on an external Digital  Station Expansion Module        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 85  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     4412D Telephone    This range of telephones is only available in North America        The 4412 supports all of the features of the 4406 with the following differences   e 12 Programmable call appearance feature keys with twin lamps   e 12 Programmable feature keys without lamps  not suitable for call appearance features    e 4 Display Navigation Keys  right of the display  Menu  Previous   lt    Next   gt    and Exit   e 4 Display Soft Keys below the Display   e 8 Fixed Feature Keys  Speaker  Mute  Conference  Transfer  Redial  Hold  Volume Up Down   e DSS port to support 2 DSS4450 adjuncts  Auxiliary power required   e 2x24 Charac
236. ese can be changed  to what ever the end user requires  within limits  This is useful for example  if IP Office is replacing a system  where DND was accessed by dialling  21  it is possible to change the IP Office Short Code to mimic the code of  the replaced system     In certain countries IP Office can support a Secondary Dial Tone when an access digit is dialled  though this  limits some functionality like Alternate Route Selection  ARS   IP Office can also be configured to work without  line access digits  by analyzing digits as they are dialled and determining if they are for an internal number or  should be sent out on a line   this is valuable in SOHO installations where users will not necessarily be used to  dialling an access digit for an outside line        Paging    All Avaya digital and IP phones supported on the IP Office that have loudspeakers can be used to receive  broadcast audio messages without having to install a separate paging system  Paging can be to individual  phones or groups of phones     Analog extension ports can be configured for connection to external overhead paging systems  usually through  an adapter  such that a port can be included in a paging group to permit mixed phone and overhead paging     Some Avaya digital and IP phones are able to answer a page by pressing a key while the page is going on  this  terminates the page and turns it into a normal call     This feature is supported across the IP Office Small Community Network       Intrud
237. eserved  Page 71  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Wireless   WiFi  802 11     The Avaya IP Wireless solution offers an advanced Voice over IP  VoIP  client for wireless networks  This  solution allows SME s to take advantage of the cost savings and simplified management of a converged voice  and data infrastructure     Avaya 3616  3620 and 3626 phones are optimized for Avaya IP telephony and emulate the wired 4606 IP  Telephone  They work in conjunction with the Avaya Voice Priority Processors  10  20 and 100  to ensure voice  quality over Wireless LAN s     The newly available 3641 and 3645 phones provide an improved user interface  a new lightweight design and  a radio that supports several WIFI standards  802 11a b g   With these handsets customers have an increased  choice to fit their needs and infrastructure     Based on global standards for wireless LAN s  the Avaya IP Wireless Telephone Solution simplifies network  infrastructure by enabling voice traffic to be carried along with data traffic over the same wireless network   3616  3620 and 3626 telephones are available for direct sequence 802 11b Wi Fi networks  the 3641 and  3645 will also work in 802 11a and 802 11g networks  These phones are also field upgradeable through  external TFTP clients  not included   so telephones can be updated with new protocols  features  and    capabilities as they become available   5     3616 20 26    802 11  Access Points    TFTP Server    E        Avaya IP Office   
238. ettings     e IP Office 500 Software License Feature Key A Law  700417488   Configures the control unit for A law voice encoding and multi country locale settings     IP412 Control Units   Includes  2 port Layer 2 LAN switch  9 pin DTE serial port for license feature key and system diagnostics  37   pin WAN port  3 5 mm jack for Music on Hold audio input and 2 switch external door relay control port   Internal expansion slots to support 1 x 12 port remote access modem module and 2 x Voice Compression  Modules  including VCM24 and 30 for non blocking IP dual PRI applications   12 x external expansion module  ports to support additional analog trunks  WAN interfaces  digital or analog extensions  Includes 60W earthed  external power supply  Regional power cord and software documentation CD pack not included     e IP412 Office Mu Law Base Unit  700350408   Mu law voice encoding base unit pre configured for US locale settings  2 x trunk module slots to support  US T1 PRI and 4 port analog trunk cards     e IP412 Office A Law Base Unit  700234479   A law voice encoding base unit pre configured for multi country locale settings  2 x trunk module slots  to support Euro ISDN BRI  E1 PRI and 4 port analog trunk cards        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 273  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     IP Office External Expansion Modules   Except where noted  all the following are supported by the IP406 V2  IP412 and IP500 control units  Note that  extern
239. evStatus and LineDevSpecific calls  The additional features  are     Agent login   e Agent logout   e Set and retrieve divert destination     e Set and retrieve extended divert status  Forward All Calls  Forward on Busy  Forward on No Answer  Do  not Disturb      e Retrieving the extension locale  language    e Set and clear the message waiting lamp   e Enable and disable group membership     e Generate and detect DTMF digits and tones  requires the TAPI WAV driver         Support for Developers       The Developer Connection Program   DevConnect   is the Avaya developer partner program  and is designed  for third party companies who are creating a product for sale  and who wish to receive technical support   Membership of the program is at the sole discretion of Avaya     DeveloperConnect members pay an annual fee  for which they receive technical support directly from Avaya   In addition  Avaya will perform interoperability testing between IP Office and the member s product  and may  also create opportunities for joint marketing  including exhibitions  use of Avaya s logo  and other benefits     More information on the DeveloperConnect program can be found at www devconnectprogram com        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 196  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Chapter 11   Voicemail       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 197  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     11  Voicemail    Voicemail provides a te
240. extensions can be supported  4  Analog  8 Digital and 16 IP         All IP Office   Small Office Edition s variants have a four port Layer 2 Ethernet Switch and a dedicated switched  Ethernet WAN port  Layer 3   making the system ideal for connection to local area networks and broadband  wide area network services such as ADSL and Cable  With Voice over IP as standard and optional IPSec  security  the system can be quickly configured to provide secure voice and data networking from remote  offices or branch locations back to a head office over a broadband connection     The IP Office   Small Office Edition includes a WAN option slot on the rear of the unit which can be used to  support other network connection types such as V35  V24  X21 and T1 leased lines     The back of the unit also features a twin PCMCIA socket that can support a plug in voice memory card for use  with the embedded voicemail function  and a Wireless LAN card when using the system as an Access Point     To enable licensed IP Office applications  a serial Feature Key can be attached directly to the IP Office   Small  Office Edition removing the need for an external PC for license verification     For resilience  under power fail conditions Analog trunk port 2 is connected to POT extension port 1        Analog Analog Digital  IP Extensions VoIP   Trunks Extensions Stations Channels  4T 4A 8DS  3 VoIP  4 4 8 16 3  4T 4A 8DS  16 VoIP  4 4 8 16 16    e During power fail  Analog port 2 is connected to POT port 
241. ey can give out one phone number to clients  but it will ring their mobile cell phone as well as the  desk extension  External mobile devices can be set as twinning targets even if the primary telephone is logged  out  e g  in the case of a    virtual    extension      From IP Office 4 2 onwards  the following additional Mobility features are available in addition to simple mobile  twinning  but need to be separately enabled per user in IP Office Manager      Mobile Call Control   This allows a user who has answered a twinned call on their mobile phone to dial a DTMF sequence     star star  to put the call on hold and receive IP Office system dial tone  The user will then be able to  perform supervised and un supervised transfers  shuttle  switch between held calls   and conference   Conference add and transfer to a meet me conference      Avaya one X    Mobile Client Support   IP Office 4 2 supports the Avaya one X Mobile    Single Mode    Client running on selected Symbian Single Mode  or Windows Mobile 5 or 6 handsets  This provides a graphical interface for call control and allows a  one number service for both incoming and outgoing calls  For a full list of supported handsets see  http   support avaya com  IP Office systems supporting one X Mobile require a dedicated DID DDI number for  each feature required  e g  hold  transfer      Mobile Call Control and one X Mobile support require twinned calls to be routed through specific trunk types on  IP500 only     e IP500 PRI
242. f analog  digital or IP handsets  If  additional analog trunks are required  these can be aggregated in groups of 16 on each analog expansion  module  Note that the Professional Edition also enables the licensing of advanced applications such as  VoiceMail Pro    The following table shows which features are supported by Standard Edition and which require the upgrade to    Professional Edition   Standard Edition Professional Edition   _Included   Optional_  Included _  Optional       Up to 32 extensions    IP phone support   Phone Manager Lite   TAPI   SMDR   64 way basic conferencing  IP Office Manager   System Status Application  Voice Networking  Advanced Networking  Embedded Voicemail  Phone Manager Pro   PC Softphone    KISIN S NE  KISIN S S SS S    SoftConsole   SIP Trunking   IP DECT   Mobile Twinning and Mobility  VPN phone support   CTI Link Pro   32   272 extensions supported     q  47 4  6  6  4  4  OES  q  4  4  6  8  4  4  OS    Expansion Module support   64 way Meet Me Conferencing  VoiceMail Lite   VoiceMail Pro   UMS   ContactStore   Conferencing Center   CCC   TAPI WAV    q  4  476    GOSSES       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 26  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        IP500 Cards    The IP500 control unit has 4 slots for the insertion of cards  These cards can be divided into two types  base  cards and daughter cards  Base cards include a front panel and ports for cable connections  Daughter cards  can be added to a base 
243. f these phones and the most popular VPN gateway products  the software extends  enterprise telephony to remote locations     VPN Phones offer the full IP Office telephony features that are available on IP Office IP phones at the users  desktop in a remote location like a home office     Licenses for VPN Phone are controlled by IP Office          IP Phone with  VPN Client Software    VPN Gateway Integrates the functionality of the VPN  device into the Avaya IP phone    VPN Phone is ideal for IP Office customers supporting    work at home    users   e Virtual Office workers  e Remote workers  e Remote call center  e Business continuity support  e Very small locations that require a single phone only    e Temporary installations such as conferences  off site meetings  and trade shows    VPN Phone has been tested with a number of VPN gateways from major vendors like Cisco or Juniper as well  as with smaller VPN access devices from companies like Adtran  Kentrox  Netgear  and SonicWall  Refer to the  support pages  support avaya com  for a list of available application notes on VPN gateways        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 84  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Other Ranges       Avaya has a wide range of communication products so we do our best to support as many telephones from  other Avaya product families established in the global market such as MERLIN MAGIX and DEFINITY        4400 Series  4406D Telephone    This range of telephon
244. face are enabled by default  This means that the single PRI has 8  channels enabled  while the dual PRI has 16 channels enabled  Further channels may be enabled by the  purchase of additional licenses in 2 channel or 8 channel increments     e The IP500 PRI daughter card works on any IP500 VCM or extension base card  not the Legacy Card  Carrier      e Up to four Universal PRI cards can be installed in any combination in the IP500 chassis   e Diagnostics capabilities    e Visual indicators to show service state   e Physical test points to monitor traffic     These trunks support the mobility features of Mobile Call Control and one X Mobile client support  introduced in Release 4 2        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 31  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        IP Office IP412 Control Unit    With a greater internal data transfer capability than the IP406 V2  the IP412 is more suitable for meeting the  needs of the small contact center or businesses with a CRM focus  The IP412 differs from the IP4060 V2 by  providing a greater trunk expansion capability of up to four PRI trunks  The IP412 is a stackable unit with an  optional 19  rack mounting kit  The IP412 includes        e 9 pin DTE Port  for maintenance or Feature Key connection for application licensing    e X 21 V35 WAN interface   e Support for up to 12 IP Office Expansion Modules   e Phone modules  8  16  30   e Digital Station modules  16  30   e Analog Trunk Module 16  e So8 modul
245. features  those feature will only work if a time profile of the same name also  exists on the remote IP Office     e Break Out Dialing    In some scenarios a hot desking user logged on at a remote system will want to dial a number using the  system short codes of another system  This can be done using either short codes with the Break Out  feature or a programmable button set to Break Out  This feature can be used by any user within the  Small Community Advanced Network but is of significant use to remote hot deskers     Note  Remote Hot Desking is not supported for use with CCC  Features handled by the telephone itself are not  affected by Hot Desking  e g  call log and phone speed dials         Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 108  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Relay On Off Pulse    IP Office is fitted with two independent switch outputs for controlling external equipment such as door entry  systems  Control of these switches is via allotted handsets allowing the switches to be opened  closed or  pulsed as required  Control of switches is also accessible via Phone Manager Pro  SoftConsole and VoiceMail  Pro        Pickup  Call Pickup allows a user to answer a call presented to another extension  Types of call pickup include   e Pick up any call ringing on another extension     e Pick up a Hunt Group call ringing on another extension  where the user must be a member of that Hunt  Group     e Pick up a ringing call at a specified Ex
246. ffice applications running on PC s connected to the IP Office system     Licenses are 32 character strings based on the feature being activated and a unique serial number for the IP  Office system which will be using the license  The unique serial number is taken from the Feature Key device  fitted to the IP Office system     e IP500 Smart Card Feature Key  For IP500 IP Office control units  the serial number is based on the Smart Card Feature Key fitted to the  control unit  A Smart Card Feature key is mandatory on all IP500 control units for correct operation of  the unit regardless of whether the unit is using any licenses     e IP400 Feature Keys  For IP400 control units  the serial number is based on an optional add on Feature Key     e Serial Port Feature Key  For IP406 V2 and IP412 control units this can be a Serial Port Feature Key attached directly to the  control unit      e Parallel or USB Port Feature Keys  Alternatively for all IP400 control units  a USB Feature Key or Parallel Port Feature Key can be  attached to a PC running the IP Office Feature Key server application     For licensing each IP Office control unit must have its own Feature Key and licenses  The Feature Key  associated with one IP Office system cannot be used to validate the licenses of another IP Office system     Since licenses are based on the serial number of the Feature Key  they cannot be moved between systems  with different Feature Keys  If a Feature Key is lost the license will become i
247. fice Platform 8  Phone Manager  IP Office 500 Control Unit    25 Phone Manager Lite    174  IP500 Cards   ss  Par in MA ie 27 Phone Manager Pro    177  IP500 Trunk Cards    30 Phone Manager PC Softphone  IP Softphone     180  IP Office IP412 Control Unit    32 Phone Manager Feature Summary    181  IP400 Trunk Interface Cards    34 Phone Manager PC Requirements            snsnseseee10  182  shear a A Hera ee Lane toate ata 5 9  SoftConsole  PEET oe NE OEE E ANE SoftConsole Options  detsate 190  3  Telephones SoftConsole Administration    191  1600 rss A eid ee 47 SoftConsole PC Requirements                                   191  4601 Telephone    55      ny Integration  5402  5602 SW  2402  4602 SW Telephone               56 i Pompe Telepho y teg at yee  5410  5610 SW  2410  4610 SW Telephones             58 wi ICO tante Hs ana ns nl  TAPILink Lite  1st Party TAPI Support     196  5420  5621  2420  4621  4625 Telephones                 60 TAPILink Pro  3rd Party TAPI S 196  EU24 and EU24 BL Expansion Modules    62    D      any MPP ON  Re nae  T3 Telephone Range    63 porn ance n a ener ener es  Wireless and Remote Phone Solutions    68 11  Voicemail  Other Ranges                                85 Voicemail Lite                                                          198  Headsets     ardt tt et ani dre 97 Embedded Voicemail                                           200  S  DA Len name e r 98 Voicemail Pro    201  4  Features ae  of pue ete Systems             a  Basic Call H
248. finding and diagnosis  SSA provides  real time status  historic utilization and alarm information for ports  modules and expansion cards on the  system  SSA connects to all variants of IP Office running release 4 0  using an IP connection that can be  remote or local  Modem connections at 14 4kbps or above are supported for remote diagnostics     SSA provides information on the following     Alarms   SSA displays all alarms which are recorded within IP Office for each device in error  The number  date  and time of the occurrence is recorded  The last 50 alarms are stored within IP Office to avoid need for  local PC     Call Details  Information on incoming and outgoing calls  including call length  call ID and routing information     Extensions  SSA details all extensions  including device type and port location  on the IP Office system  Information  on the current status of a device is also displayed     Trunks  IP Office trunks and connections  VoIP  analog and digital  and their current status are displayed  For  VoIP trunks  QoS information is also displayed  e g  round trip delay  jitter and packet loss     System Resources   IP Office includes central resources that are utilized to perform various functions  Diagnosing these  resources is often critical to the successful operation of the system  This includes details on resources  for VCM  Voicemail and conferencing     fl IP Office System Status   TechStaffSamba  135 64 181 220     AVAYA IP Office System Status    Help
249. going to 11 different locations  When using T1 as a Leased  Line it is possible to use the same circuit for switched circuit services  Not all types of leased line are available  in all territories  check for availability        Dial Up Circuit Support    Where the amount of traffic does not justify the cost of a dedicated leased line  the system can provide data  connectivity via ISDN dial up circuits using its E1 T1 or Basic Rate trunks  Where data speeds greater than a  single channel are required  64K 56K   additional channels can be added to the call as and when they are  needed        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 165  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Point to Point Protocol  PPP     PPP is an industry standard Wide Area Networking Protocol  that allows inter working with a wide range of 3rd  party routers  PPP is used over dial up or leased line circuits where a single channel is used to connect the two  locations together  e g  A single channel maybe a 64K channel on a dial up circuit or a 256K leased line etc        Multi Link Point to Point Protocol  ML PPP     IP Office supports Multi Link PPP allowing additional calls to be made where bandwidth greater than a single  channel is required  The maximum number of channels available to data can be set on a service by service  basis  When the available bandwidth reaches a user defined limit additional channels can be automatically  added  Similarly  when traffic falls then the
250. groups of 16 on each analog expansion  module     Data Channels    A Data Channel is used for Remote Access  RAS   Internet Access  and Voicemail sessions  A data channel is  an internal signaling resource used whenever a call is made from the IP network to an exchange line  Central  Office   For example  four people surfing the Internet will use a single data channel since they all share the  same line to the ISP  Two people remotely accessing the Office LAN from home will use two data channels  since they have dialed in on separate lines  IP extensions do not use data channels  Data channels are used for  voicemail connections with a maximum of 30 available for VoiceMail Pro on a IP412     Modems and Voice Compression modules    You can add additional hardware to the IP412 system to add one modem card  12 V 90 modems  and 2 Voice   Compression Modules  VCM   Each VCM supports from 4 to 30 simultaneous Voice over IP sessions and is used  for either providing networking between sites over a Wide Area Network or supporting IP Telephones and Soft   phones        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 33  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        IP400 Trunk Interface Cards    IP400 trunk interface cards fit into the card slots on the Small Office Edition  IP406 V2 and IP412 control units  and in any slot of the IP500 when combined with the IP500 Legacy Card Carrier  They provide analog  ISDN or  CAS trunk connectivity  Not all interfaces are available 
251. h                Branch  Branch           e a  Bi    Regional Office           Branch    Branch       Branch    Branch    Branch    For Small Community Networks VCM modules are required in all systems being connected  The IP lines should  be configured to connect the IP Offices in a star configuration  however the data network itself can be meshed   Also the names and numbers  groups  line  services  etc  on the separate IP Office systems should be unique  to reduce potential maintenance confusion     Each IP Office system broadcasts UDP messages on Port 50795  These broadcasts typically recur every 30  seconds but BLF updates are potentially more frequent  There are no updates if there is no activity and the  overall level of traffic is very low   typically less than 1 kbps per system     From IP Office Release 2 1 35  and higher  SCN is supported between IP Office systems with differing software  levels but network features will be based on the lowest level of software within the network  This option is  intended to allow the phased upgrading of sites within a SCN and it is still recommended that all systems  within a network are upgraded to the same level where possible     If larger networks are required QSIG can be used to link multiple Small Community Networks together   Functionality between the communities is governed by the QSIG feature set     Note  On IP500 systems  Small Community Networking requires one or more additional licenses        Product Description    20
252. h Embedded Voicemail for  IP500  IP406 V2 and Small Office Edition     Interactive Voice Response  IVR  and Text to Speech   Create automated customized systems allowing callers to interact with business information  for  example  reading email  account enquiry systems  automated ordering systems  ticket purchasing  systems  PIN number checking  remote time sheet management  etc  Enhance theses systems by using  Text To Speech to read information back to callers     Queue Manager and Campaign Manager  Powerful voice and IVR applications for the Contact Center that facilitate agent and traffic management  for better productivity and customer service     Compact Business Center  Report on overall system performance and basic call center functionality for up to three workgroups with  quality of service reports  selected group reports  simple installation  and more        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 20    IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Management Tools       The IP Office solution  phone system  router firewall DHCP server  is easily managed through the IP Office  Manager  IP Office Manager is a Windows PC software application that connects to the IP Office system using  TCP IP  It can be on the same LAN as the IP Office  remote on the WAN  or connected via the Remote Access  Server with a Telephone Adaptor  Router or the optional internal modem     The System Status application is a useful diagnostic tool that provides enhanced 
253. h feature s  description for details     1600 Series IP Telephone Support   IP Office 4 2 Q4 2008 supports the Avaya IP 1600 series telephones   models 1603  1608 and 1616  together  with the BM32 button module  The Avaya 1600 series form a family of cost effective IP telephones that deliver  familiar features at an attractive price point for customers with basic communications needs  Designed as a  stand alone portfolio these telephones may be intermixed with other Avaya IP telephones  Combining the  features of traditional telephones and the latest in telephone user experience  Avaya IP 1600 series telephones  provide critical capabilities not often found in competitively priced models     Legacy Telephone Support  The following telephones are not supported by IP Office 4 2  They may function but have not been tested with  IP Office 4 2 and any faults reported with IP Office 4 2 will not be fixed     e 20DT Analog DECT used with IP Office Analog DECT and Compact DECT  e 4606  4612 and 4624 IP phones  e TransTalk 9040    So To Interfaces for IP500 BRI   IP Office 4 2 permits circuits on the IP500 Dual and Quad BRI trunk interfaces  daughter cards  to operate as  So interfaces in the same way as ports on the S08 Expansion Module  IP Office provides clocking  and runs the  ETSI Protocol as network rather than TE equipment     The IP500 BRI card in So mode supports both point to point and point to multipoint connections  A maximum  of 10 terminal endpoints identifiers  TEIs  ar
254. h planned radio coverage with no blind spots    Avaya Wireless and Remote Solutions   IP Office supports the following wireless solutions   e DECT in the EMEA and NA regions and in selected APAC countries   e Digital Wireless North American market     e Avaya VoIP WiFi Solution offered worldwide in selected countries including North America  EU countries  and selected others     IP Office supports the following VPN remote phone solutions     e VPN phone client on 4610SW  4621SW  5610SW and 5621SW IP phones offered worldwide        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 68  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Wireless   Avaya IP DECT    The IP DECT solution delivers the productivity boosting benefits of IP and wireless communications across  multiple offices in a convenient  lightweight handset  It provides businesses with a highly functional wireless  solution with the ability to scale to support large numbers of users  This system also supports users in  different offices connected via a WAN  The Avaya IP DECT solution radio fixed part  RFP  or base station  connects to the IP Office using an IP protocol based on H 323     The Avaya IP DECT solution supports up to 120 handsets and 32 base stations  Each base station can be  powered over the LAN using the Power over Ethernet  PoE  standard  Each indoor base station can also  optionally be connected to main power via an external power adaptor  Each outdoor base station can only be  powered using
255. hannels   8 E1R2 Channels License  IPO LIC IP500 E1R2  ADD 8CH  215187   e   IP500 Universal PRI Additional Channels   22 E1R2 Channels License  IPO LIC IP500  F1R2 ADD 22CH  215188     e IP500 Universal PRI Additional T1 Channel Licenses  These licenses are used to enable additional T1 B channels for IP500 PRI U cards configured for T1 PRI  or T1 robbed bit operation  Each port can support up to 23 B channels  T1 PRI  or 24 B channels  T1  robbed bit  in these mode   e   IP500 Universal PRI Additional Channels   2 T1 Channels License  IPO LIC IP500 T1 ADD  2CH  215180   e   IP500 Universal PRI Additional Channels   8 T1 Channels License  IPO LIC IP500 T1 ADD  8CH  215181   e   IP500 Universal PRI Additional Channels   32 T1 Channels License  IPO LIC IP500 T1  ADD 32CH  215182        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 300  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Voicemail Pro Licenses   IP Office Voicemail Pro is a voicemail server application that runs on a Windows server PC  By default it  provides standard voicemail mailbox functions to all IP Office users and hunt groups plus support for call  recording and call waiting announcements to callers  A range of additional features can be enabled by further    e   Voicemail Pro  4 Ports  License  IPO LIC IP400 VM PRO RFA LIC DS  171991   Enables Voicemail Pro and an initial 4 ports  This license is a pre requisite for all Voicemail Pro features    e For IP Office IP500 control units  Voicemail Pro i
256. he IP Office Customer Call Reporter install   During installation the default location for the installation of the database is on the local drive  This can be  changed to a remote location on the network  If an existing database is to be used then the option for this to  exist on a remote server also applies        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 245  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Historical Reporting    The IP Office Customer Call Reporter reporting package has been simplified to enable the user to easily  retrieve the reporting information they need from one of seven standard drag and drop report templates  The  IP Office Customer Call Reporter offers    cradle to grave    reporting for businesses that want to track specifically  how a call was routed through their business  The historical reporting is accessed via the Supervisor login and  corresponding view as shown below        Q  Forgot Password  M Status  2   Help    AVAYA   IP VYA Call Reporter   Username   mak       i i   sC S   S   Password   s00000   Language   English UK  l  Logon      IP Office Customer Call Reporter Report Templates  The following main report templates are available with IP Office Customer Call Reporter        e Agent Summary Report  This report type details the call activity for agents in a queue or for specific agents     e Call Details Report  The Call Details Report contains details of the total number of calls  internal calls  optional   external
257. he efficiencies of universal functions and end user familiarity     e Leverage any existing investment in Avaya systems at other sites  e Centralize services  e g  operator  voicemail  as well as management and administration to reduce costs  e Speed deployment of remote offices   respond more quickly to market demands     e Improve inter site communication to simplify information exchange and enhance customer service        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 141  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Private Circuit Switched Voice Networking       Private voice networks are built using structured leased line circuits  E1 or T1  or by establishing permanently  connected  B  channels over ISDN circuits between IP Office systems  Each channel within the E1 or T1  interface can provide a single voice or 64K 56K data call  Where leased line circuits are used within a private  networking scenario  these E1 or T1 interfaces are typically configured to use QSIG signaling between sites     QSIG provides a level of voice feature transparency between PBXs and is the favored signaling standard within  multiple vendor and international voice networks  The IP Office E1 or Ti module terminates a QSIG connection  with a 120 ohm RJ45 interface     IP Office supports the following QSIG services across this network   e Simple Telephony Call Basic Call  ETS300 171 172   e Circuit Switched Data Call Basic Call  ETS300 171 172   e Called Calling Line ID Presentat
258. he voicemail notification can be sent for   e Any new voice messages    e Any new priority voice messages    Mailbox owners can configure their own options from their handset  Telephone User Interface or TUI  and  through their IP Office Phone Manager     e Create own Time Profile   defining when notification should take place  e g  office hours only     e Out calling destinations   defining where notification should take place and in which priority order    Five destinations can be defined by the mailbox owner through the TUI  Telephone User Interface   The  destinations selected in the escalation list are called in sequence  The possible destinations are     e Desk   e Mobile Cell  e Home   e Delegate    e Other    Each time an outcall event occurs  each number in the escalation list will be called until either the call is  answered  or the end of the list is reached  This process will be repeated on each retry attempt  for the  number of retries set     Out calling preferences are set for global operation via the VoiceMail Pro Client  Out calling is only available in  INTUITY Mode  The administrator sets the number of retries and time interval between retries on a system   wide level        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 215  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Campaign Manager       As part of VoiceMail Pro  Campaign Manager enables the gathering of repetitive information form inbound calls   such as brochure requests  to be fully a
259. ic invites can be  generated in conjunction with VoiceMail Pro  see IP Office Conferencing Center for more details    SoftConsole gives the operator visual status of calls in the conference room     Not Invited  Invited  Joined  Declined  Unavailable     GS E BE B B  U 9 5 v D  X b ei   e Queue Panel  The queue panel displays a bar graph of the number and the status of external calls held in a particular    queue  Up to 8 Call queues can be configured and labeled to reflect incoming calls for specific Hunt  Groups     Ci  00   0000    stomerdelp                00 07          Queue Name  CustomerHelp  Calls in Queue  2  Recall Calls  0    Status  Alarmed       e Held Calls Panel  The held call panel enables the operator to manage all calls held at the operator station  These calls will  appear as a list in panel  The operator can perform the following the functions  Answer the highlighted  held call  Answer the longest held call  Conference held calls  see conferencing section above  or  Transfer held call        O w    Ss Cees   ta    Anne Webb      Betty Edmund    00 07             e BLF Panel  Busy Lamp Field Panel   The BLF panel displays icons to indicate the status of selected users  Each icon provides information on  individual users such as  Unread  User  voicemail messages  User status information  for example Busy   DND and Forwarded is indicated by the various icons used  Up to 10 tabs with 100 icons on each tab are  supported     Ext209  1           Product Descrip
260. ice 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     3  Telephones    Avaya IP Office Desktop phones are designed to meet typical user needs in the small and medium business  market     e Walk Up  Phones in common areas like a meetings room  lobby or store  The phones are normally used by casual  users that walk up to a phone where they make a quick phone call  Normally  no sophisticated features  are needed     e Example user  Customer  Visitor     e Everyday  Users that need a phone on their desk as part of their everyday job  While having a phone is important   the phone is just another tool on the desk for users using several alternative communication  technologies     e Example user  Engineer  Accountant     e Receptionist  Assistant  A typical user manages a lot of calls  often as a significant part of their job  In many cases they also  manage calls for others users and need to be efficient in connecting callers to the right people     e Example user  Executive Assistant  Receptionist     e Executive  For these users  handling a lot of calls is essential and they are constantly on the phone  Quite often   they handle multiple calls  they must always be connected  even when mobile  They require a set of  rich  yet easy to use communication capabilities     e Example user  Sales Executive  Banker  Lawyer  Project leader     Phones for the different Usage categories   e Walk Up  1603  5602SW 4602SW  5402 2402  e Everyday  1608  5610SW 4610SW  5410 2410    e Receptionist Assistant  1616 
261. ice VoiceMail Pro complements the built in meet me conference bridge facility on IP Office systems by  adding guidance prompts as well as requesting PIN codes as participants enter the conference for security  For  example  if conference calls are regularly scheduled  VoiceMail Pro can have pre programmed Call Flows for  weekly conference calls e g   every Tuesday between 2pm and 5pm using PIN code 1234 for a sales call  etc   If multiple conference calls are scheduled  users can select which one they want to attend via a simple menu   Should users encounter any issues  calls can be automatically routed to the operator for assistance  For  additional security  if Caller ID information is provided by the network VoiceMail Pro can make CallerID checks  before allowing calls into a conference     Sales Director       IP Office 4 2    Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 230  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        IP Office Conferencing Capacity       IP Office provides a flexible conferencing solution with from 3 to 64 way calling on an IP500 or IP406 V2 or  128 conference resources on an IP412  IP Office Small Office Edition provides 2 to 6 way calling with a  maximum of 24 conference resources  This means that several conferences of different sizes can all run at the  same time if the total calls do not exceed the systems conference resources  IP Office does not impose limits  on the mix of internal and external calls in conference  but if all except one call 
262. ice users  hunt groups and external directory user  non IP Office extensions     e Single directory entry details  Including IP Office users  Hunt Groups and external directory user  non IP Office user      e Script    When a script has been configured for either the calling or called number  the script is displayed in this  panel  For example  an operator may be answering calls on behalf of more than one company  To  ensure the call is answered with the correct company name a script file can be created with the  company name details  The script is displayed whenever a call is received for that company        Call Information    Calling Name   Calling Number     Called Name   Called Number   Call Status   Duration     Company One  01707364416  Anne Webb   209   Alerting   Incoming  00 05             COMPANY ONE  All calls are to be announced    General Enquiries   Extension 123          e Conferencing    Within SoftConsole  calls can be conferenced when held  or a conference can be created through the    two conference rooms     e Conference Held Calls  An operator can conference calls that are in the Held Panel  All calls in the Held Panel will be    conferenced        Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 187    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     e Conference Room  An operator can configure up to two conference rooms including details on who is hosting the  conference plus the ability to send out invites to conference participants  automat
263. icensed application is a web based software package that consists in two parts     e a  Conferencing Center Scheduler  to book and reserve conferences     e a  Conferencing Center web client  to complement an audio conference with a visual presentation web  interface     The scheduler is independent of the web client  either or both can be used  Conferencing Center also interacts  with SoftConsole and Phone Manager     Note  Conferencing Center on the IP500 requires a license for IP Office Professional Edition        Conferencing Center Scheduler    The Web Scheduler allows registered users to create and book conferences online using a web client interface   The Scheduler offers secure conferencing while being very easy to set up  Users simply enter the date  time   duration and the number of conference participants required  The conference is created  if the resources are  available for that specific time  Once reserved  the conference resources are allocated to that conference call  for the specified number of participants at the selected date and time  Additionally Music On Hold  if available  on the system  can be played to callers while waiting for the conference to start     Create New Conference   Pending Conferences   In Progress Conferences   View Conference Resources   My Conference Templates   File Uploading    Create New Conference    Name   Sales Meeting  Date   20 07 2006  Start Time  HH MM     Duration  Mins     Participant Count     Music On Hold     5  gt   M
264. icipants process     TT TS  Dawn Smith  ismith wyz com   f07787123456    Loui Armstrong fiarmstrong abe com                    Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 235  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Conference templates can be used to book recurring conferences  all booking information including the  conference ID and participants PINs are retained  except for the conference date  Using a conference template  in this way can save re entering of repetitive information thus saving time and effort  Once a template has  been created they can be accessed via the    My Conference Template    tab         ce    Create New Conference   Pending Conferences   In Progress Conferences   View Conferei f    1    Conference Templates    190375  Core Team Meeting   4   AR  22x  357022  Documentation status Uncate      AA Mi  passas  New Projects    AB  22   82185 snonages meetng   4   AAR  22   ssssa Wooky Sales Meeting   4   AAR  22           Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 236  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Conferencing Center Reportin    The System Administrator can generate reports regarding conference usage and individual conference reports   This will detail the conference name and ID  the start date and time  duration and number of participants  If  PIN codes were used  individual reports can be run listing participant details and when they joined left the  conference  Finally  if voting was being used using
265. id     B call id  gt  B call id   3 Unique call identifier 3 Unique call identifier   Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 284    IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 285  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Chapter 17   Technical Specifications       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 286  P Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     17  Technical Specifications    Dimensions    IP406 V2  IP412 and all Expansion Modules 445mm 17 5  71mm 2 8  245mm 9 7    IP Office   Small Office Edition 255mm 10 0  76mm 3 0  241mm 9 5    IP500 445mmm 17 5  73mm 2 9  365mm 14 4   e The recommended minimum clearance  front and rear  for the connection of cables and other devices is   75mm 3     Weight   IP500 System Unit 3 2Kg 7 0lbs   IP406 V2 Control Unit 3 0Kg 6 7 bs   IP412 Control Unit 3 0Kg 6 71bs   Small Office Edition 1 2Kg 2 6lbs   Analog 16 Module 2 9Kg 6 51bs   DS16 Module 3 0Kg 6 71bs   DS30 Module 3 5Kg 7 8lbs   WAN3 Module 2 8Kg 6 3lbs   So8 Module 2 8Kg 6 31bs   Phone 8 Module 2 8Kg 6 3lbs   Phone 16 Module 2 9Kg 6 5lbs    Phone 30 Module 3 1Kg 6 94lbs    Environmental    e 0  C to  40  C  32  F to 104  F   95  relative humidity  non condensing     Call Capacity   Busy Hour Call Complete  BHCC  is a measure used to test IP Office systems under a high call load  For BHCC  tests  each incoming call rings for 5 seconds  is answered and stays connected for 6 se
266. ights reserved  Page 176  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Phone Manager Pro       Phone Manager Pro is licensed on a per user basis and provides all of the Phone Manager Lite features plus the  following     e Personal Productivity and Collaboration  Phone Manager Pro offers increased capacity from 15 to 1000 Speed Dial BLF entries  These are  distributed across 10 tabs to allow users to group speed dial Busy Lamp Field icons by department or  location  for example Sales  Support  etc  Each speed dial tab supports up to 100 speed dial BLF  entries     e Telecommuter Mode  Phone Manager Pro allows making and receiving calls and retrieving voicemails on an external phone  number as if they were in the office  with Phone Manager providing the call control  It also provides  billing convenience and potential cost savings for remote workers and mobile work force  Access to the  feature is controlled by the administrator in the User Rights         Speech  Connection         Telecommuter  Remote        Teieconmuer SSS A s  Intemal  Office  onnection  When logging on  a Telecommuter user will be asked to choose the phone number they can be reached    at  This number is either entered directly or is part of a previously saved profile  Once selected  Phone  Manager will use this number to make and receive calls and retrieve voicemails for the duration of the          session        s  Phone Manager Telecommuter Login    nn Mie COVOU WENO WOK2 ESS    l   internal  Office 
267. il a license is purchased and  installed onto the IP Office     IP Office ContactStore has a number of components  these are   e An MSDE database into which details of all recorded calls are inserted   e A browser based call search and replay application   e A browser based system configuration and status monitoring application   e Disk space management   Oldest recordings are automatically deleted as needed     e Optional archive management   Recordings are automatically written to a DVD  RW drive     To allow you to search for calls easily  the details of the recordings are stored within a MSDE database  It  contains one record for each call recorded and additional records for each party on the call and the owner of  the call  The information that is held for any recording is     e A unique reference for the recording  e The start date and time  e The duration of the recording    e The name and number of the parties on the call   where this was available to IP Office  through ANI   Caller ID or DNIS  at the time of the call     e The direction of the call  incoming  outgoing  or internal   e The owner of the call recording    e The target or dialed number  which may be different from the number that actually took the call     Recordings within IP Office ContactStore are stored as  WAV files  IP Office ContactStore uses the G 726  16kbps ADPCM compression standard  which provides the best compromise between storage capacity and CPU  loading  IP Office ContactStore is designe
268. in all territories  The following table shows how many of  each card type are supported by each of control unit           Small Office   IP406 V2   1P412   IP500   Edition    IP400 Universal Analog Trunk 4    x   2    IP400 Quad BRI  1   2     cas poa    aooe O O X   2      IP400 Dual E1R2   X A  Slot A     1P400 PRIT 1   2      1P400 Dual PRITE   X  LiGem   2   2        Each card requires the use of an IP500 Legacy Card Carrier  IP500 does not support E1R2 coax cards     N    NON  N          IP400 BRI Card    The BRI trunk card provides 4 Basic Rate ISDN T interfaces  8 trunks   Details of the supported ISDN  supplementary services on BRI interfaces are given in the  Public and Private Voice Networks  section        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 34  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     IP400 PRI Cards  T1 E1 E1R2     Available in single and dual versions the IP400 PRI card provides single and dual primary rate trunk interfaces  respectively  The PRI is available in Ti  E1 and E1R2 MFC variants depending on the territory  The dual version  is only supported on the IP412  in slot A of the IP406 V2 and in the IP500 using an IP500 Legacy Card Carrier   The Small Office Edition only supports the single T1 PRI card  not E1 or E1R2      Details of the supported ISDN supplementary services and protocols for each PRI are given in the    Public and  Private Voice Networks  section     T1 trunk cards incorporate an integrated CSU DSU  The CSU functi
269. individual users or on a system wide basis     Benefit  e Restrict the dialing of specific numbers or types of numbers system wide     e Restrict certain users from dialing specific numbers or types of numbers     Description   IP Office supports call barring at many levels  Short codes can be used at the system or individual user level to  block the external routing of specific numbers or types of numbers  Typically the barring short codes are set to  return busy tone  however they could route the call to an alternate number or to a Voicemail service that  returns a    barred dialing message        For users  the short codes can be allocated to a User Rights template  This template is then applied to the  Users whose calls need restriction  In addition to barring the dialling of certain numbers  IP Office can be set to  bar the forwarding of calls to external numbers on a per user basis        Alternate Route Selection  ARS     IP Office supports Alternate Route Selection  which is more flexible and easier to configure than Least Cost  Routing  LCR   If a primary trunk is unavailable  then ARS provides automatic fallback to an available trunk   e g   analog trunk fallback if a T1 or SIP trunk fails  or use PSTN for SCN fallback      By configuring ARS  calls may be routed via the optimum carrier  Time profiles can also be used to allow  customers to take advantage of cheaper rates or better quality at specific times of day     Multiple carriers are supported  For example  lo
270. iness   All standard report templates have common fields that can be completed to create a report  And when  entering details in a field a wildcard         can be used to represent everything  The common fields are listed  below     e Report Name  The text entered is used as the main title of the report  If the report is saved this is the saved name of  the report     e Subject  This is the main subject of the report  The drop down list offers a list of report subjects that are  pertinent to the report i e  Hunt Group  Agent  DDI etc     e Filter  The filter is used to refine the data and again offers filters that are pertinent to the report i e  All   Answered  Lost  etc     e Exclude Internal  When selected  internal calls are excluded from the report     e Working Hours  The start and finish time of the working day can be specified using the spin controls     e Group Results by  The drop down list offers a list of display options     e Scheduled  By default this field is shown as  Manual      If the option  Scheduled  is selected then additional fields are  available     e Report Format  The format that the report is to be produced in can be selected from Adobe  Word  Excel  Rich Text or  Crystal     e Email Address  An email address can be entered if the report is to be sent by email     e Printer  The printer path that the report should be sent to     e Report Period  Selection of days  weeks or months from a list box  The number of days or weeks is counted from the  dat
271. inesses or businesses with greater reliance on the telephone for internal and external  communications some of the more advanced features will improve efficiency and customer service  Features  like Pick Up which permit users to take a call for a colleague who is temporarily away from their desk  of  Absence Text which can quickly give information to internal callers about a person s availability        Absence Text    Feature  e Display a text message on the user s phone and IP Office Phone Manager application     e Display the same message on other internal phones and IP Office applications when calling the user     Benefit  e Inform other internal users of your current status and likely availability     Description   Any user can set Absence Text on their phone  even users of standard analog phones  but it can only be  displayed on selected display phones  Phone Manager and SoftConsole that call the user  Most supported  feature phones give the option of adding some text  for example     At lunch until 16 00                                       F1 s  Absent Status           Absent Message On Holiday Until                 Q Do Not Disturb l    OF orward Unconditional    When a user has an absence text message set  call processing is not affected to the user and they still have  the choice of using features like Do Not Disturb or Forward on No Answer as appropriate  Phones that support    the interactive setting of Absence Text will also display it on the users own phone fo
272. ing System Support  The following table gives a summary of the Server  amp  Client Operating Systems  OS  on which various IP Office  applications are tested and supported for IP Office 4 2     Microsoft Server OS 12 IP Office   SSA   VM VM TAPI SMDR4  CCC V5 Conf   Manager Lite   Pro     3rd party  Server   Center  Server    XP Professional  SP3    yes   Yes   Yes   Yes   Yes   Yes   No   No      a  64bit gt    2008Server     Yes   Yes   No   Yes  No   Yes   No   No    2008 Server 64bit   Yes   Yes   No   Yes  no   Yes   No   no      Microsoft Client OS 1 IP Office  SSA   CCC VM   VM Soft Phone TAPI Conf   Manager Clients   Lite   Pro    Console   Manager  ist Center  party  Client    XP Professional  SP3 ___Yes__  Yes  _Yes_  Yes   Yes   yes   Yes   Yes   Yes      XP Professional  SP3  No No No No No No  64bit gt    Vista Yes Yes Yes Yes   Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes  Business  Enterprise    SP1     Vista Ultimate  SP1    Yes   Yes  _Yes_  Yes   Yes   Yes   Yes   Yes   Yes      Vista No No No No No No  Business Enterprise  64bit      Vista Ultimate 64bit gt    No   No   No   No   No   No   No   No   No      Non OS Applications IMSS   UMS web Phone CCC V5 Conf  Conference Contact  voicemail   Manager   Reporter  amp   Center Center Store  Database Client Database Database    2003  Microsoft Exchange  2007    n a  Microsoft Outlook 2003  Microsoft Outlook 2007    Microsoft Outlook 2007         1 Windows ME  Windows 95  Windows 98  Windows NT4 and Windows 2000 operating systems are no
273. ings should a user wish to change their Forwarding or Follow Me number from  an external telephone  VoiceMail Pro provides message handling for individuals or groups  audio information  to callers so assisting the operator during periods of heavy call activity and links to business applications  through services such as Text to Speech  VoiceMail Pro provides a full telephony applications environment  where call flows can be set up and interact in real time with business workflow   callers can interact via menus  and data entry and VoiceMail Pro applications can speak back results  For example  users can listen to their  email messages through the telephone    A single PC based VoiceMail Pro server can provide voicemail services to multiple IP Office systems in a Small  Community Network over the LAN  WAN or a Frame Relay network  This is referred to as    Centralized  Voicemail    and can reduce costs  while facilitating communication between IP Office sites     Other uses for VoiceMail Pro include     e Whisper Announce that prompts callers for information  usually their name  which is recorded and  passed on to the user s extension on answer  allowing them to choose to accept the call or not  This is  particularly useful on  CLI ANI withheld  numbers   usually calls from telesales companies where  somebody is trying to sell you something  VoiceMail Pro will not intrude onto busy extensions     e Assisted Transfer allows transfer of a call to a destination  but allows the ca
274. ins Duration          Access to the Web Scheduler requires a user to be granted a user logon and password by the administrator  and have Internet Explorer  6 0 or above  installed on their PC  No other software is required  The System  Administrator can set up an unlimited number of registered users on the Conferencing Center application   Once registered  users can review the system resources before booking a new conference  book a conference  as well as list pending conferences they have previously set up        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 233  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     The user setting up the conference can then add participant details including their email address and their  telephone number  This allows email notification to all participants confirming the conference call details  including the conference name  description  host contact details  bridge number  conference ID  their unique  participant PIN code  if PIN checking has been selected  and the URL web address for the web client  if web  support has been selected   At any time prior to the start of the conference  Participants    details can be  changed     Voice Conferencing Notification  VCN  can be activated for selected participants  This allows VoiceMail Pro to  dial out to participants when the conference is about to start and bring them to the conference bridge if they  are available     Advanced security is available by generating unique PIN numbers for ev
275. integration available to wireless users with DECT  there are a variety of means by which  calls can be routed to wireless handsets     e DDI DID  Since each wireless handset is an extension on the IP Office system calls may be routed directly using a  DDI DID number     e Transfer  Calls may be transferred to DECT extensions by operators or other extension users and DECT extension  users may transfer callers to any other extension user     e Hunt Group compatibility  Wireless handsets may be programmed as members of groups and answer calls in the same manner as  any other extension within that group     e Group working  Wireless handsets may be programmed as members of groups and attract calls in the same manner as  any other extension within that group  DECT handsets must NOT be configured into collective groups     e Divert destination  Users may initiate any or all diverts from an Avaya desk phone to a wireless handset     e Twinning  Twinning allows calls to a user main extension number to alert at both that extension and a secondary  extension  Though not restricted to DECT  this feature is aimed primarily at users who have both a desk  phone and a wireless extension  Calls from the secondary twinned extension are presented as if from  the users main extension  Presentation of call waiting and busy is based on whether either of the  twinned extensions is in use  In North America this functionality became available in Release 4 0 7        Product Description    2009 AVAYA
276. ion  ETS300 173   e Called Calling Name Presentation   SS CNIP  SS CONP  SS CNIR  ETS300 237 238   e Message Waiting   SS MWI  EN301 260 255   e Transfer   SS CT  ETS 300 260 261              QSIG E1 T1       Circuit Switched Voice Networking       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 142  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Public Voice Networking       The IP Office platform supports a range of trunks and signaling modes for connection to the public switched  telephone network  Central Office   Some of these lines are only available in certain territories  please check  with your distributor for local availability  Primary rate trunks are available with either a single  24 30  channels  or dual trunk  48 60 channels      ISDN Primary Rate  ETSI CTR4   Provided by the IP400 PRI E1 and IP500 Universal PRI cards     ISDN Primary Rate provides 30 x 64K PCM speech channels over an E1 circuit and one signaling channel   Signaling Conforms to the ETSI Q 931 standard with Cyclic Redundancy error Checking  CRC      The following supplementary services are supported     e Calling Line Identification Presentation  CLIP  provides the telephone number of the incoming call to the  IP Office     e Calling Line Identification Restriction  CLIR  prevents the telephone number of the IP Office being  presented on an outbound call     e Connected Line Identification Restriction  COLR  Inhibits the COLP service     e Direct Dialing In  DDI  where the exchange p
277. ion  This is set with IP TCP    quality of service    and  should not be ignored  In situations where LAN Bandwidth is limited  a quality of service capable LAN switch  should be used to ensure voice packets are transmitted with the required priority on the network  If not  the  conversation carried over IP appears as broken up  due to packet loss  or has unacceptable delays introduced  in the conversation  latency andjitter   With IP hardphones there is need for Power over Ethernet  PoE  or     midspan power    to be provided to the phones as the IP phones are no longer powered by IP Office   a list of  Avaya approved PoE options is available at the end of this section        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 130  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Gateways  Gatekeepers and H 323   Technology Overview       IP Office uses the H 323 signaling protocol which has the following architectural components    e Telephones are H 323 service endpoint devices that can support Audio calls  Other types of H 323  devices can support video as part of H 323    e Gateways provide media translation to allow calls to be made to non H 323 devices  for instance an  analog telephone or the public network to connect with a H 323 device    e Gatekeepers control the call processing and security for H 323 devices    e Multipoint Connection Units  MCU  for conferences by adding together media streams    These elements are grouped together in what is known as an H 
278. ion  that direct dial number is also used as their Caller ID  for outgoing calls  Alternatively short codes can be used to specify the Caller ID that should be sent with  outgoing calls   Note that the sending and receiving of Caller ID is subject to the service provider supporting that service  The  service provider may also restrict which numbers can be used for outgoing Caller ID   Hold  A call may be placed on hold with optional Hold music  A held call cannot be forgotten as it is presented back  to the extension after a timeout set by the system s administrator   See also Park 10 gt    Toggle Calls  Toggle Calls cycles round each call that the user has On Hold to their extension locally within the system   presenting them one at a time to the user  Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 101    IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Hold Call Waiting    Hold Call Waiting is a compound feature combining hold and answer and provides a convenient way to hold an  existing call and answer a waiting call through a single button press        Hold Music  Music on Hold     The IP Office system supports up to 4 sources of music on hold   one system source which may be external   internal  WAV  or tone  plus up to 3 additional internal sources  Small Office Edition supports either one  internal or one external music on hold source at a time  The internal sources are  WAV files saved either in  volatile memory  or on the optional memory card in an IP500  
279. ion module required for IP trunks and extensions  Includes 64ms echo  cancellation     e Voice Compression Module 30  700293939   30 Channel Voice Compression module required for IP trunks and extensions  Includes 25ms echo  cancellation     IP400 Modems cards  e IP400 Modem 12  700343452   Internally fitted card allowing twelve simultaneous V 90 modem calls  Not supported on the IP500        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 275  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     IP400 Trunk Interface Cards  Except where noted  all of the following can be installed in the IP500 using the IP500 Legacy Card Carrier   700417215      e IP400 BRI 8  UNI   700262017   Interface card for the Small Office Edition  IP406 and IP412 providing 4 x ISDN T Bus Basic Rate  Interface ports  8 lines      e IP400 PRI 30 E1  1 4   700272461   Interface card for the IP406 and IP412 providing 1 x ISDN Primary rate port  30 lines      e IP400 PRI 30 E1R2 RJ45   CALA  700241631   Interface card for the IP406 and IP412 providing 1 x E1R2 Primary rate port  30 lines   RJ45  termination     e IP400 PRI 30 E1R2 COAX   CALA  700241656   Interface card for the IP406 and IP412 providing 1 x E1R2 Primary rate port  30 lines   Co Ax  termination  Not supported on the IP500     e IP400 Dual PRI E1  700185184   Interface card for the IP406 and IP412 providing 2 x ISDN Primary rate ports  60 lines      e IP400 PRI T1  700185200   Interface card for the IP406 and IP412 providing 1 x T1 PRI p
280. isplay will not function     Common Features     Display  2 lines x 24 characters     Fixed Feature Buttons  10   Conference  Transfer  Drop  Redial  Speaker  Messages  Hold  Mute   Volume Up  Volume Down     Programmable Feature Buttons     e DS Phones  2 plus an additional 12 programmable feature keys can be accessed via the FEATURE  key     e IP Phones  2     Key Labels  Icons used on fixed feature keys  Display labels and icons used on 2 programmable  feature keys     Speakerphone  Listen only handsfree speaker  no microphone    Hearing Aid Compatible  Yes     Message Waiting Indicator  Yes  On the 2402 and 5402 this is also used as a ringing call alert  indicator     Personalized Ring Patterns  Yes  8  via Conference button when idle    Headset Socket  No  this telephone does not support headset operation   Embedded Applications  None    Upgradeable Firmware  DS Phones   No  IP Phones   Yes    Expansion  None    Color  Multi gray    Mounting  Desk or wall mountable     Adjustable Desk Stand  No        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 56    IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Requirements for 5402 and 2402   e Connect to  Digital Station  DS  port     e Power Supply  From phone system     Requirements for 5602 SW and 4602 SW     e Power Supply  IEEE 802 3af Power over Ethernet  PoE  or individual power supply unit  Avaya 1151  series      e Codecs  G 711  G 729a b    e QoS Options  UDP Port Selection  DiffServ and 802 1p q  VLAN    e 
281. it  Connection to switched mains supply requires separately supplied  country specific IEC 60320 C13 power cord  3 wire earthed cold kettle lead      e Input  100 240V AC  50 60Hz  81 115VA  2 5A maximum        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 289  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Interfaces       DTE Port    ISDN Ports    Analog Trunk Ports  Power Fail Ports    ISDN  Data Rates    Analog Phone Ports    LAN  WAN    Audio    External    Output Port    Wireless Module    Embedded Voice    Memory    25 way D Type female connector  V 24 V 28   9 way D type on IP412  IP406 V2  IP500 and IP Office   Small Office Edition     EU Interfaces     BRI    RJ45 sockets  ETSI T Bus Interface to CTR3 for Pan European Connection   PRI E1    RJ45 socket  ETSI T Bus Interface to CTR4 for Pan European Connection   PRI T1 J1    RJ45 socket  FCC Part 68 JATE connection     USA Interfaces     PRI T1 Service    Ground Start  GS    Default  E amp M  56k data for SESS  56 64 64 restricted for  4ESS    PRI ISDN Switch support    4ESS  5ESS  DMS 100  DMS 250  includes conformance to ANSI T1 607 and  Bellcore Special Report SR4287  1992     PRI ISDN Services    AT amp T Megacom 800  AT amp T WATS  4ESS   AT amp T SDS Accunet 56kB s and 64kB s   4ESS   AT amp T Multiquest  4ESS     RJ45 sockets  Loop start Ground start  regional dependant    RJ45 sockets     BRI  B channel 64kbps or 56kbps  D channel 16kbps   PRI  B channel 64kbps or 56kbps  D channel 64kbps     RJ
282. itional configuration   e UMS licenses  for the number of users that will be configured to use UMS   e the users selected for UMS support must be enabled by the system administrator in Manager  e each user must have a voicemail passcode  a blank passcode is not acceptable     As the UMS solution is not reliant on integration with Exchange significant savings are made in the cost of  installation and maintenance        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 205  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Fax Messages       While not directly supplying or supporting fax software  integration with fax to the desktop or client fax  applications can be done through the use of fax servers  This then allows an email client  for example  Microsoft Outlook  to be utilized as an easily affordable unified messaging solution  The many benefits of  unified messaging include security  as faxes are sent to the users PC rather than on paper for everyone to  see   ease of use and efficiency in terms of storage and retrieval of messages and the great gains that can be  made in overall workforce efficiency and productivity     To enhance the support of third party fax solutions  VoiceMail Pro supports the automatic detection of incoming  fax calls  Traditionally a dedicated telephone number is provided for all incoming fax calls  In addition to  or as  an alternative to  the VoiceMail Pro  Menu  action or a subscriber s voicemail box  INTUITY mode  can  automatically de
283. ity for the host to have a private conversation with one of the participants    e Viewing area for reviewing PowerPoint presentations  Word documents and Excel spreadsheets     e Questions and Voting facility        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 238  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Phone Manager Conferencing Center Integration    Phone Manager users can join a conference or book a conference via the Conferencing Center application by  clicking the relevant icons within Phone Manager  This will launch the Conferencing Center Web Client and the  Conferencing Center Scheduler respectively  Note this feature is only available if permission is specified by the  system administrator and if the Conferencing Center system is installed and available        System Requirements for Conferencing Center  Conferencing Center Server PC Specification    e Always refer to the latest Avaya SMB Technical Tip or Technical Bulletin for any updated information  with regard to operating systems  service packs or PC hardware     e Refer to the Technical Specifications section of the Product Description for operating system and  hardware requirements     Conferencing Center web client   e Internet Explorer 6 0 or higher     e No download required        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 239  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 240  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    2
284. l and limited to Avaya  Messaging Servers  not third party messaging platforms        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 157  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Common Networking Features          Alternate Route Selection    Alternate Route Selection  ARS  allows calls to be routed via the optimum carrier  Time profiles can also be  used to allow customers to take advantage of cheaper rates or better quality at specific times of day     If a primary trunk is unavailable or congested  then ARS provides automatic fallback to an available trunk  e   g   analog trunk fallback if a T1 or SIP trunk fails  or use PSTN for SCN fallback      Multiple carriers are supported  For example  local calls are to go through one carrier between specific hours  and international calls through an alternative carrier  Carrier selection using 2 stage call set up via in band  DTMF is possible  It is possible to assign specific routes on a per user basis  e g  only allow expensive routes to  be used by critical staff     Note  Existing Least Cost Routing  LCR  configurations are automatically converted to ARS when upgrading to  4 1          Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 158  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Network Numbering Schemes    IP Office uses fully flexible network numbering options  Dialed digits can be manipulated to add or remove  digits  access codes etc  in order to fit into any numbering scheme  Two types
285. l calls    e External  The greeting to be played to external callers    e Out Of Hours  The greeting played when a hunt group is operating    out of hours     Out of hours is defined with IP Office  Manager and is only applicable to Hunt Group mailboxes     A greeting can be recorded for each of the above conditions through the Telephone User Interface  TUI   If a  recording is made for each condition  the order of play back to a caller will be     1  Out of hours  Hunt group mailboxes only    2  Internal External greeting    3  Busy Engaged    4  No reply     A mailbox owner will need to record greetings against these conditions to deliver the greeting that they wish to  present to a caller  Phone Manager Pro users can record and manage their voicemail greetings through the  Phone Manager GUI       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 213  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Hunt Group Broadcast Messages       With VoiceMail Pro  two modes of operation exist for the handling of hunt group messages  The method used  is configured for the group through the IP Office Manager     e Hunt group mode  Messages are stored in the Hunt Group mailbox and Message Waiting only informs those individuals  configured for message waiting indication from that group  This is ideal for scenarios where only a few  people such as a call center supervisor need to be initially aware of group messages  Any message  waiting light lit by this is extinguished when the 
286. l handling instead of going to voicemail  This can be particularly useful in a sales or support  environments where a number of people may be out of the office on Mobile Cell Phones and still participate in  the hunt group as if in the office        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 116  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Follow Me    Follow Me is similar to Forwarding except that the destination can only be an extension on the same IP Office  as the user making use of the feature  Follow Me is typically used when a user is going to be working away  from their desk  for example in a workshop  All the call settings the user has on their main phone will apply to  calls that follow the follow me feature  including forward on busy or no answer     Follow Me can be set either from the users main phone   Follow Me To   or from the phone where they want  calls to be received   Follow Me Here  Several people can have their phones forwarded to a follow me  destination and if the phone has a display it will indicate who the call is for        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 117  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Avaya Digital and IP Phones          Programmable Buttons    As well as the usual dialing keys  Avaya digital and IP phones have dedicated function buttons like Mute   Volume  Hold  Conference and Transfer  In addition to these  on many Avaya digital and IP phones there are  keys that can be programm
287. l of User Datagram Protocol  UDP  Through Network Address  Translators  NATs     RFC 3824  24    Using E 164 numbers with the Session Initiation Protocol  SIP        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 292    IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        PC Specification       Server Applications Dependencies       Applications Minimum  Intel Intel  PC Pentium  Celeron    VoiceMail Lite    VoiceMail Pro  Standalone    VoiceMail Pro  IMS  Campaign    VoiceMail Pro    VoiceMail Pro  ContactStore    VoiceMail Pro    Compact Contact    Center V5    Compact Contact    Center  Standalone    Conferencing  Center    Delta Server   SMDR     Key     VM Lite   VoiceMail Lite   VM Pro   VoiceMail Pro   IMS   Integrated Messaging Pro  CM   Campaign Manager    Resources    256MB RAM  Any    256MB RAM    512MB RAM Pentium 4  2 8GHz    512MB RAM    Pentium 4  2 8GHz  clock    256MB RAM  Min 10GB       e TTS   Text To Speech  e IVR   Third Party Database Access  e CCC   Compact Contact Center    Attempting to run the applications on  lower specification PC   s may cause    To avoid replacing the server when adding  new applications we recommend that a    If the database being queried is located on  the VM Pro server the query speed of the  database will be affected by the amount of    account the memory requirements of the  database being queried     VM Pro and CCC can be run on the same  server up to a maximum of 25 agents  8  ports of VM Pro     Windows XP Profes
288. l rights reserved  Page 91  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     CLI Feature phone 9335 AV       All features of 9330 AV plus     e Caller ID with 80 memories  shows date  time and new repeat answered unanswered calls       Large 3 line LCD display    IP Office feature activation through programmable keys   100 name and number personal directory    20 lockable direct access memories    Full handsfree working    Headset port    Switchable Time Break Recall 100   200   300   600 ms   Call timer    Alphanumeric keypad     Last number redial with 5 memories        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     IP Office 4 2    Page 92  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Hotel Phone 9281 AV       e Removable inlay card for personalized logo printing    e Triple standard message waiting light  high voltage  reverse polarity and voltage drop    e 10 non volatile memories    e Ringer indicator light    e Ringer volume and pitch adjustment    e Last number redial and Recall button    e Hearing aid compatible    e Wall mountable   no additional bracket required    e ELR TBR switchable    e MF Only        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 93  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Doorphone Entry Systems for IP Office    Doorphones offer convenience and security  Depending on the needs of the environment  door phones may  allow internal users to not only speak with someone who is outside  but also to easily allow the visitor entrance  to the f
289. l that enables the interconnection of LANs and is  usually offered as a service by a public network provider  Frame Relay is a connection oriented protocol  which  means that it relies on an existing end to end path between devices connected across the network  It  implements these connections using Permanent Virtual Circuits  PVCs      Like a leased circuit  a PVC is a logical path that connects two devices  This path between the source and  destination point is a dedicated connection  so the PVC is always available to the connected devices  However   unlike a leased circuit many PVCs can coexist on a single access circuit which allows devices to share the  bandwidth of a given transmission line     Voice over a managed Frame Relay network is similar to Voice over a managed IP network except that the  access interface is usually an unstructured leased circuit via IP Office s WAN port  IP Office employs a Frame  Relay Assembler Disassembler  FRAD  to allow voice and data traffic to be formatted and framed for a Frame  Relay network     VoIP over a Managed IP VPN    Even though IP Office can operate as a pure circuit switched system with analog and digital TDM handsets   because IP Office includes an integrated Voice over IP  VoIP  Gateway significant cost savings can be made by  sending voice and data over a single managed IP VPN     IP VPNs have advantages over Frame Relay networks  access bandwidth need not be pre allocated between  sites like Frame Relay s PVCs and they ar
290. l wall mountable   Adjustable Desk Stand  No    Features for T3 Upn only     Upgradeable Firmware  No    Optional Add Ons  up to 3 DSS Modules  T3 Headset link for wired headsets only  Headset Socket  No   Connect to  Digital Station  DS  port    Power Supply  From phone system     Features for T3 IP only     e Upgradeable Firmware  Yes  e Headset Socket  Yes  e Optional Add Ons  No  e Power Supply  IEEE 802 3af Power over Ethernet  PoE  or individual power supply unit   e Codecs  G 711  G 729a b   e QoS Options  UDP Port Selection  DiffServ and 802 1p q  VLAN   e SNMP Support  No   e IP Address Assignment  Static or dynamic IP address assignment   e Ethernet Ports  Two port full duplex 10 100 BaseT Ethernet switch   e Auto negotiation provided separately for each port   e 802 3 Flow Control        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 64    IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        T3 Classic       Common Features     e Display  graphical  4 lines x 26 characters    e Fixed Feature Buttons  5 preprogrammed keys with printed text labels and 2 for Audio Volume  control    e Programmable Feature Buttons  6 preprogrammed keys with indicators and printed text labels  4  programmable keys with printed text labels    e Speakerphone  Two way handsfree speaker and microphone    e Hearing Aid Compatible  Through optional handset   e Message Waiting and call log Indicator  Yes   e Personalized Ring Patterns  Yes  8 ring patterns    e Headset Socket  no   e
291. lephone answering machine with a personalized greeting on every employee s desk and  allows callers to leave spoken messages when the user cannot answer a telephone call  Voicemail messages  are retrieved either locally or remotely via any telephone  users are prompted for a PIN if they are using any  telephone other than their allocated extension or a trusted location e g  mobile telephone      For users that prefer to have email as their main message store  they can forward their voice messages to  their email and collect them via their email account     The voicemail server is multi lingual and can offer different prompts depending on the user s preferred  language  independently of the default system setup  Similarly  external callers can hear prompts in their own  language depending on their incoming call route  e g  based on caller ID      Four voicemail options are available   e VoiceMail Lite  e Embedded Voicemail  IP Office 500   e VoiceMail Pro    e Centralized INTUITY Audix   Modular Messaging Voicemail    Positioning Summary    For further details refer to Voicemail Feature Comparison  220 at the end of this section     Feature Embedded Voicemail Voicemail Lite VoiceMail Pro    Supported IP Office Systems IP500  IP406 V2 and PC Based   All IP Office systems   Small Office Edition   Mailboxes IP Office automatically creates mailboxes for each user and hunt group on  the system   Message Storage Capacity Up to 15 hours  1MB per minute up to hard disk capacity   Maxi
292. ll History 118  174  177  181  185  191  Call Hold 152  155  Call Identifier 254  284  Call Intrude 107  126  Call List 126  Call Listen 126  201  CallLog 46  58  60  64  65  66  101  108  114  177   181    Call Park slots zones 174    102  103  153    Call Pickup 109  126  Call Pick up 81  153  Call Pickup Any 126  Call PickUp Extension 123  Call Pickup Extn 126  Call Pickup Group 126  Call Pickup Line 126  Call Pickup Members 126  Call Pickup User 126  Called Calling Line ID Presentation 142  Called Calling Name 142  152  Called Calling Name Presentation 142  Called Calling Number 152  Caller Display 41  89  119  Campaign Manager 20  201  216  220  Can Intrude 107  283  Cancel All Forwarding 126  Cancel Ring Back When Free 126  Captaris 206  Carriage Return 267  carrying  Fax 137  CAS 32  34  Cascaded Out calling 215  Castelle 10  206  Castelle Fax 10  206  Castelle Fax Server 10  Castilian 201  CAT 133  CATS 133  287  Catalyst 133  CCBS 143  CCC 25  108  121  153  201  252  254  258  CCC Reporter 252  254  CCC System Administration 252  CCC Version    Microsoft CRM    Reporting Integration New  254    CCM WB 22 258   CCP 291   CCV 252  253   CCV Supervisory Screens 253   CD 218   CD Rom 195   CDRs 114  267   CE UL Dentori Safety Approved 287  cell mobile 209   Central Office 30  32  34  143  162  164    Centralized 10  22  100  141  150  153  155  198   201  219  220    centralized billing 10  Centralized INTUITY Audix 198  Centralized Messaging 219  Centralized VM 219  Ce
293. ll that needs to be done is to wire the trigger control output of the third  party device to the appropriate External Control port pins           E911  This is a specific service for North America  When an emergency call is connected  IP Office provides calling  party information to an external line interface unit  The external unit carries out a number to text translation  and forwards this to the emergency services bureau so that the originating location of the call is clearly  identified   Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 125    IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        System Short Codes       Short Codes are used as commands the IP Office to make changes for the user  group or system  so need to  set up with consideration to security  The command may need additional information included with it  such as  for forward  the phone number forwarded to  Short codes are a flexible and quick way of setting up certain  features  IP Office has short codes provided by default on the system  or more advanced codes that need  programming by the system administrator     The full set of short code commands are listed below  please see product configuration documents for more  detail on how to set them up     AOC Previous Call  AOC Reset Total   AOC Total   Auto Attendant   Break Out   Busy   Busy On Held   Call Intrude   Call List   Call Listen   Call Pickup Any   Call Pickup Extn   Call Pickup Line   Call Pickup Group  Call Pickup Members  Call Pickup U
294. ll to return to VoiceMail Pro  automatically for other options should the called party be engaged  or not answer within a pre   determined time     e Conditional routing of calls  Conditions are constructed from a set of basic elements  These elements can  be combined within a single condition to create complex rules  For example  the Week Planner can be  used to define the company s standard working hours  and then combined with the calendar to define  exception days such as public holidays   vacation     e Call modules  Modules allow you to create sequences of actions that you want to share between a  number of different call routing scenarios   like a    macro    in PC applications  These modules can be  used to create a library of vertical voicemail applications or just easy dissemination to other IP Office  voicemail sites  thanks to its import and export functionality     e Activation of the external relays on the IP Office system  For example  remotely checking the status of  the office heating and then turning it on from your Mobile Cell Phone on your drive in to work     e Finally  a Speaking Clock  that takes its time from the voicemail server  is built into VoiceMail Pro to  minimize call charges        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 201  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Key features of VoiceMail Pro include     VoiceMail Pro client  a graphical user interface for programming and configuring applications both locally  and rem
295. llow IP Office to establish end to end connections for the voice path through the IP  network  It ensures each end of the connection is able to transmit and receive voice and provides the network  addressing for end to end packet transmission  IP Office also allows for connecting between the different  technologies by translating the signals they use  for example an analog phone may wish to connect to a VoIP  destination  This requires both the signaling and voice transmission to be translated   IP Office does this easily  as it contains technology elements called gateways and gatekeepers that enable translations to happen     With a conventional telephone system you plug your analog or digital TDM telephone into an extension socket  connected to your PBX or Key System  With IP Telephony you connect your digital IP telephone to your IP PBX  via the LAN  There are two basic types of IP phones     e A physical phone  which looks very similar to a standard telephone  IP Hard Phone     e A software application  Phone Manager PC Softphone  which runs on the user s PC  allowing them to use  either a headset microphone to make receive calls anywhere they have IP connection    IP telephony has the advantage of allowing extensions to be deployed both locally and remotely through the  use of IP routing and IP VPN services     When making use of IP telephony  there are a number of data centric considerations such as which data types  have priority on the IP network when there is content
296. ls including File Transfer  Protocol  FTP  and Internet browsing  HTTP   Each protocol passing through the firewall can be restricted   allowed access in four different ways     e Drop  No sessions via this protocol will be allowed through the wall    e In  An incoming session can  punch a hole  in the wall to allow traffic in both directions    e Out  An outgoing session can  punch a hole  in the wall to allow traffic in both directions    e Bothway  An incoming or outgoing sessions can  punch a hole  in the wall to allow traffic in both directions     In cases where a protocol is not supported by default  the firewall can be customized to control packets based  on their content     IP Office allows the configuration of as many firewalls as needed through IP Office Manager  This permits  different security regulations to be applied to individual dial in users and data services        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 168  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Light Weight Directory Access Protocol  LDAP     IP Office supports LDAP directory synchronization  This allows the telephone number Directory  names and  telephone numbers  held in IP Office to be synchronized with the information on an LDAP server  limited to  500 entries   Although targeted for interoperation with    Windows 2000 Server Active Directory   the feature is  sufficiently configurable to interoperate with any server that supports LDAP version 2 or higher        Remote Ac
297. m calls        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 21  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Telephone Options       IP Office supports multiple telephone solutions  giving the small and mid size business maximum flexibility to  choose according to their current and future needs     e IP Telephones  IP Office s integral H 323 Server supports Avaya 1600 and 5600 Series IP telephones  selected Avaya  4600 series IP telephones  Avaya T3 series IP telephones  Avaya 3600 series Wireless VoIP telephones  and Phone Manager PC Softphone     e Digital Telephones  IP500 Digital Station 8 cards plus IP Office Digital Station 16 or 30 Expansion Modules support the  Avaya 5400 Series of digital phones and Avaya T3 Series telephones  plus selected 2400 and 6400  Series phones  The IP Office Digital Station expansion modules also support existing selected 2400   4400  6400 Series phones    e Analog Phones  IP500 Phone 2 or 8 cards plus IP Office Phone 8  16 or 30 Expansion Modules support standard analog    phones  faxes and modems  with support for calling line identification and message waiting indication  where these services are provided     e Wireless Telephones  Avaya IP DECT base stations can be added to support the Avaya IP DECT 3701 and 3711 telephones   The IP Office Digital Station interfaces support the Avaya 3810 telephone  The Avaya 3600 series  wireless VoIP telephones are also supported        Application and Feature Licensing       IP Office
298. mail Pro  4 Ports          Optional IP500 Voice Networking  Additional e IP500 Voice Networking  Additional  Licenses Channels   Channels     IP500 VCM Channels  e IP500 VCM Channels    Additional Voicemail Pro  ports   e IP500 Upgrade Standard to Professional    Example 3  ContactStore in a IP500 Small Community Network    Remote IP500    Required IP500 Upgrade Standard to Professional   e IP500 Voice Networking  Base 4  Licenses IP500 Voice Networking  Base 4 Channels    Channels   e VMPro Recordings Administrator   Voicemail Pro  4 Ports    VMPro Recordings Administrator     Optional IP500 Voice Networking  Additional IP500 Voice Networking  Additional  Licenses Channels   Channels     IP500 VCM Channels  IP500 VCM Channels    Additional Voicemail Pro  ports   IP500 Upgrade Standard to Professional          Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 304  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 305  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Chapter 19   Appendix       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 306  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     19  Appendix    The following equipment is no longer sold by Avaya but is still supported by IP Office 4 2        IP406 V2 Control Unit    The IP406 V2 control unit is a stackable unit with an optional 19  rack mounting kit  The IP406 V2 includes        e Eight Digital Station  DS  ports for supported 2400  4400  5400 
299. mall businesses with a web based contact center  measurement tool  producing cradle to grave reporting in an easily understandable format with no client  software to load     e Standards Based  IP Office Customer Call Reporter uses standards based applications  such as Microsoft SQL 2005  Express  and supports all major web browser software  to provide small business installers with greater  flexibility in deployment     e Ease of Use  IP Office Customer Call Reporter   s real time charts can be customized by the user in the manner that  suits their business best  with historical reporting templates that allow the business to filter on the type  of date they want to see        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 243  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Ordering Small Business Contact Center  Small Business Contact Center supports the following maximum configurations for IP Office     e 150 Agents    e 30 Supervisors    IP Office Customer Call Reporter Sales Order Codes    SAP Description  Code    217650 IPO CUSTMR CALL Agent packages come in 1  5  10 and 20  REPORTER 1AGT LIC    217651 IPO CUSTMR CALL  REPORTER 5AGT LIC    217652 IPO CUSTMR CALL  REPORTER 10AGT LIC    217653 IPO CUSTMR CALL  REPORTER 20AGT LIC    217654 IPO CUSTMR CALL  REPORTER 50AGT LIC    217655 IPO CUSTMR CALL Supervisor licenses for Real Time and Historical Reporting  REPORTER 1SPV LIC    217656 IPO CUSTMR CALL  REPORTER 10SPV LIC    217657 IPO CUSTMR CALL  REPORTER 20SPV 
300. maximum of four SoftConsole applications can be run per system  An IP Office license controls the  number of simultaneous SoftConsole users        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 191  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 192  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Chapter 10   Computer Telephony  Integration       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved   e 4     Issue    Page 193  18 s    22 May 2009     10  Computer Telephony Integration    Computer Telephony Integration  CTI  is about bridging the gap between the telephone system and business  applications  On IP Office  this is achieved by use of the IP Office CTI Link  a CTI middleware product and  Software Developers Kit     On IP Office  CTI is delivered through adherence to open standards  This gives businesses access to a wide  range of third party solutions  addressing vertical markets  and designed to meet their requirements  For  developers  migrating their offering from other platforms to IP Office is quick and easy  and the advanced CTI  features IP Office offers makes it easy to demonstrate full integration  and more business benefits     IP Office provides two levels of CTI interoperability  CTI Link Lite  which is free of charge  provides all the  functionality required to support the vast majority of applications  including screen popping  and many third   party products     CTI Link Pro provi
301. med should an exception occur  thus freeing the supervisor to  continue with other  more productive activities     CCV Supervisory Screens Agent and Queue Based Screens  e Alarm Handling  e Group Monitor  e BLF Details  e Agent Group Details  e Extension Activity  e Real Time Status  e Callback Request  e Group Status  Percentage     e Individual Agent Details    Trunk Related Screens e Percentage Time in State  e Trunk Group Monitor  e Individual Group Details  e Trunk Group Details  e Queue Monitor  e Real Time Status  e Individual DDI DID Details    e Group Status  Percentage      e Individual Trunk Details     Gy Percentage Time in State ie  Es    8  w   Fiona Macintosh   4120                                FN Display Labels  Dr   205 EA   Outgoing M  10 42   1226      Ready M  38 32    44 16      Holding M  0 22     01 57      Basywrapup    3 07 40   00 00      muyna  00 00 _   00 00      SF Forte   00 34    DE CT  10 27 00    00 00       Ringing   02 02   02 33        interna Made LATE  00 20     DT  00 00    00 00       8 48     1 ore            30 85     44 16   12 26              Call Center View Real Time Example       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 253  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        CCC Reporter   Historical Reporting    CCC Reporter provides in depth historical reporting on the customer facing department s activity  Report  Manager provides standard reports for measuring overall contact center call handling and individ
302. motely attached PC s and other devices  including IP  phones     e Remote Access Server  Access to local LAN servers via optional two channel V90 modem or digital trunks  individual firewall  security  access control per user  and standards based security enable remote workers     e LAN Switching  The IP500 and IP412 offer 2 switched Layer 3 Ethernet ports     e LDAP client support  For standards based directory synchronization with Phone Manager        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 19  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Applications Platform Features       IP Office provides big business benefits and enhanced productivity for small and mid size businesses with a  full complement of sophisticated applications  IP Office provides free of charge applications  including Phone  Manager Lite and CTI interfaces  These free of charge applications can be upgraded to provide enhanced  functionality through the purchase of license keys     Operator SoftConsole  A graphical User Interface  GUI  for attendants on their PC desktop for call handling  Works with a  telephone and is an easy way to learn and use sophisticated tools in a comfortable environment     Phone Manager  A powerful desktop application for the IP Office  available in Lite  Pro  and PC Softphone versions to  allow you to control and manage phone calls from your Windows desktop     Open CTI interfaces   IP Office has a built in TAPI server that integrates easily with popular cont
303. mum Simultaneous Calls 4  4  Small Office Edition    IP406 V2   20   IP412   30   IP500   30    Centralized operation  No  No  Yes    Queue Announcements Yes  Yes  Yes    Auto Attendant Yes  No  Yes    Call Recording No  No  Yes    Intuity Emulation No  No  Yes      Small Office Edition  Up to 3 on VC3 models  up to 10 on VC16 models        Voicemail Lite       VoiceMail Lite is the IP Office basic voicemail application and can handle up to 4 simultaneous calls  Each user  has the option of turning their voicemail on or off  When on  the system automatically answers their telephone  when they are not available to take a call  plays a personal greeting to confirm that the intended recipient will  actually receive the message  and records a message     When a message has been left  the user will see a message waiting lamp lit on their telephone and can press a  retrieval button to collect their messages     VoiceMail Lite can ring the extension to deliver any new messages  When voicemail messages are left they are  time and date stamped and the caller s number noted  Once listened to  old messages are automatically  deleted 36 hours after being left  unless the user chooses to save the message permanently     Voicemail can be collected remotely by calling into the VoiceMail Lite server  If the number the user is dialing   from is recognized  home number or Mobile Cell Phone for example   they will listen to their voicemail straight  away  If the source number is not recognized 
304. n be used from C  C   and Delphi  Visual Basic cannot directly use TAPI 2 1  but does  support TAPI 3 0 without any third party tools     e TAPILink Lite provides detailed information on telephony events  including the ability to screen pop    based on CLI and or DDI        Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 282  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Device Specific Data       The following table shows the device specific data available via TAPI     e Phone s extension number e Force login flag   e Forward on busy flag e Login code flag   e Forward on no answer flag e System phone flag   e Forward unconditional flag e Absent message id   e Forward hunt group flag e Absent message set flag   e Do not disturb flag e Voicemail email mode   e Outgoing call bar flag e User s extension number   e Call waiting on flag e Users Locale   e Voicemail on flag e Forward number   e Voicemail ring back flag e Follow me number   e Number of voicemail messages e Absent text   e Number of unread voicemail messages e Do not disturb exception list   e Outside call sequence number e Forward on busy number   e Inside call sequence number e User s priority   e Ring back sequence number e Number of groups the user is a member of  e No answer timeout period e Number of groups that the user is a member of that        are currently outside their time profile  e Wrap up time period    e Number of groups the user is currently disabled  e Can intrude flag from    e
305. n users  like customer services agents  may need  to be able to call colleagues in other offices even when the network is busy  while other users can wait for a  line to come free  Least Cost Routes can automatically translate the internal number to a direct dial call over  the public network while other users wait        Account Codes    Feature  e Associate an account code with a call     e Validate account codes used against list stored by the IP Office     e Include the account code used with call log details     Benefit  e Through the call records  group calls by account code for the purpose of call costing and tracking     e Restrict outgoing calls by requiring users to enter a valid account code     Description   IP Office stores a list of valid account code numbers  When making a call or during the call  the user can enter  the account code they want associated with that call  IP Office will check the account code against its list of  valid codes and request the user to re enter the code if it is not valid  For incoming calls  the Caller ID can be  used to match it with an account code from the IP Office s list of valid codes and report the account code with  the call for billing     Individual users can be set to Forced Account Code operation where they are required to enter a valid account  code before making external calls  By using IP Office Short Codes it is possible to identify certain numbers or  call types as requiring a valid account code before permitting th
306. nalog Trunk 16 Module 39  IP500 Analog Trunk Card 30  IP500 BRI 10  30  37  39  143  IP500 BRI So8 10  37  39  IP500 BRI So8 Expansion Module  IP500 BRI So8 Module 39  IP500 BRI Trunk Card 30  IP500 Cards 27  IP500 Compact Flash voicemail 20  IP500 Control Unit 25  27  273  278  IP500 Digital Station 30  37  40  278  IP500 Digital Station Expansion Module 37  IP500 Digital Station Module 40  IP500 DS 16 10  IP500 DS8 Extension Card  IP500 Expansion Modules  IP500 Feature Key 278  IP500 Feature Key A Law 278    IP500 Legacy Card Carriers 27  30  34  36  273   278    IP500 Media Card Voice Compression Module 32  273    IP500 Media Card Voice Compression Module 64  273    IP500 Phone 10  37  IP500 Phone 16 10  IP500 Phone Expansion Module 37  IP500 PRI 10 30  IP based WiFi 68  IPCP 291  IP DECT 69  IP Office Manager 10  IPSec 10  19  150  170  291  IPSec Tunneling 170  IPSec Virtual Private Network 10  IPSec VPN 150  IP telephony 133  Ireland 277  ISAKMP 291  ISBN  asked 211  enters 211  ISDN 18  30  34  39  120  135  138  142  162  164   165  174  181  267  273  290  BRI S interfaces 37  following 143  incoming 143  outgoing 143  ISDN Basic 143    37  39    85  86  87  88  10  25       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 330  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       ISDN Basic Rate 143  ISDN BRI S interface 273  ISDN DSS1 143  ISDN MSN 120  ISDN Ports 290  ISDN Primary 143  273  ISDN Primary Rate 143  273  ISDN T Bus Basic Rate Inte
307. nd Voicemail services without  being permanently assigned a physical extension  When finished  they simply log off to make the extension  available to others or if users log on at another phone  they are automatically logged off the original extension        Remote Hot Desking    Feature  e The ability for a user to Hot Desk to other locations within the Small Community Network   e Available on Digital  Analog and IP phones   Benefit  e Auser can make and receive calls from any office as if using the phone on their own desk   e Single number  improved mobility and easy access to familiar features   e Great for consultants  managers  lawyers working on different offices on different days   Description    IP Office 4 0 supports remote hot desking between IP Office systems within a Small Community Network  The  system on which the user configured is termed their    home    IP Office  all other systems are    remote    IP Offices   To log on at a remote IP Office requires that IP Office to have a Small Community Advanced Networking  license  A license is not necessary on the user s home IP Office    e User Settings    When a user logs on to a remote IP Office system  all their user settings are transferred to that system   e The user   s incoming calls are rerouted across the SCN   e The user   s outgoing calls use the settings of the remote IP Office     e However some settings may become unusable or may operate differently  For example if the user uses  a time profile for some 
308. ndows 2000 operating systems are no longer supported by IP Office across applications  They may  function but have not been tested with IP Office 4 2 and any faults reported with IP Office 4 2 will not    be fixed   2 32 bit only   3 32 bit only        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 17  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Voice Communication Solution Features       IP Office offers a comprehensive list of features and benefits for the small or mid size business  including     e Full PBX features  Caller ID  Call Forwarding  Conference Calling  Voice Messaging and more     e Trunk Interfaces  A variety of network trunk interfaces  including E1  T1  PRI  ISDN  analog loop start and analog ground  start for comprehensive network connectivity  Not all trunk types are available in all territories  please  check for local availability     e Extensions  Support for a range of extensions  from 2 to 360 that provide sophisticated voice performance for new  and growing businesses     e Telephones  A variety of telephones including analog  digital and IP hard and soft phones  wired and wireless  that  provide the appropriate desktop or device phone for every need     e Advanced Call Routing  Incoming calls are directed to the best available person or messaging service  according to the  company s unique criteria     e Alternate Call Routing  Ensures reliable handling of calls by selecting from analog  digital or VoIP trunks     e QSIG Networking  
309. ndset is not available in North America     ae    AA4ACE    Or R   gt   3  0  Le        e Listen only handsfree speaker   e SOS Emergency key for speed dialing an emergency number   e Information key that can be used for   e Phone number lists and voice mail indication   e Information and speaker key flash when active   e 50 phone book entries in every handset  e 10 possible ring tones with temporary mute   e 4 level signal strength display   e Speaker and handset volume  3 levels and mute capability   e Manual and automatic key lock  1 minute timer    e Temporary ring tone muting   e Silent charging     e 12 menu languages  Czech  Danish  Dutch  English  Finnish  French  German  Italian  Norwegian   Portuguese  Spanish and Swedish  However  in the Czech and Norwegian language mode some menu  items may appear in the English language     e Illuminated 3 line graphic display  96 x 33 pixels   variable 3 level contrast   e Stand by time  Up to 100 hours    e Talk time  Up to 10 hours    e Charge time  max  6 hours for empty batteries    e Weight  138 grammes including 3 AAA  NiMH  batteries    e Dimensions  Height x Width X Depth   146 x 55 x 28 mm     Optional telephone accessories include   e Desktop charger   e An adapter cord for use with headsets     e Heavy duty belt clip        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 80  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        3711 IP DECT    This telephone is supported on the Avaya IP DECT system only        Th
310. ne the shortest route to a destination network   It does this by measuring the number of intermediary routers that need to be traversed to reach the  destination network  If more that one route exists to the same destination the shortest route is used  If a fault  occurs on the shortest route it will be remarked as being infinite and any alternative route will become the new  shortest route  This behavior can be used to add resilience into a data network  Where a customer has an  existing data network comprising of third party routers  IP Office added to the network can provide back up  using its routing and dial up capability  RIP enabled routers share their knowledge of the network with each  other by advertising and listening to routing table changes  IP Office Supports both the RIP I and RIP II  standards        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 169  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        VPN  IPSec Tunneling    192 168 42 0   192 168 43 0       IPSec tunnels allow a company to pass data between locations over unsecured IP networks such as the public  internet  The company data is secured using 3DES encryption making it unintelligible to other parties that  might be    eaves dropping    on the traffic  Tunneling can be applied to link offices together or provide workers  access to the office over the internet  All IP Office systems support up to a total of 256K worth of encrypted  traffic to multiple locations  Initially  inter working is
311. new hunt group message is accessed by a user  This is  the default mode of operation     e Broadcast mode  Messages are not stored in the hunt group mailbox  Instead they are broadcast  copied and forwarded   to the individual mailboxes of the entire hunt group membership  This lights the individual messages  waiting light of each user of the Hunt Group until they access their mailbox        Personal Distribution Lists       Personal Distribution Lists are only available with VoiceMail Pro when operating in INTUITY emulation mode   The feature provides the ability for a user to distribute a voicemail message to a list of recipients  simultaneously  Lists can be configured by a voicemail box subscriber either through their voicemail box  telephone user interface  TUI  or through the desktop PC application Phone Manager Pro     The features available to a voicemail box subscriber include   e Create up to 20 lists with 360 members per list    e Mark a list as Private or Public  Private lists can not be accessed by any other voicemail subscriber   Public lists can be used by other subscribers but can not be edited     e Public lists can be copied from one subscriber to another by adding the contents into a new list   e Subscribers can    Create    new lists     Scan    contents of an existing list or    Modify    existing lists     e List members can be added by using the station number or mailbox name  names are not supported for  VoiceMail Pro Networked Messaging mailboxes     
312. nfigured on the system     e Gateway  The Voice Compression Module provides the H 323 gateway function that allows IP extensions to make  calls to other non IP devices  The maximum number of simultaneous calls is limited by the number of  channels available on the Voice Compression Module  IP Office must be fitted with an optional Voice  Compression Module to enable IP telephony     e Silence Suppression  Silence suppression is a technique used to make the best use of available bandwidth  such as the  connection over which the caller is listening  not speaking  Silence suppression works by sending  descriptions of the background noise  rather than the actual noise itself  during gaps in conversation  thereby reducing the number and frequency of voice packets sent on the network  Background noise is  very important during a telephone call  Without noise the call will feel very unnatural and give a  perception of poor quality     e Compression  IP Office supports a wide range of voice compression standards including G 711  G 729a and G 723 1   The method of compression can be either automatically established on a call by call basis or be  configured on an individual extension basis     e Fast Start  When fast start is supported by an IP extension  this facility reduces the protocol overhead allowing an  audio path to be established more quickly     e Out of Band DTMF  When out of Band DTMF is configured on an IP extension  the extension will signal to the other end of  the conn
313. ng control   In IP Office 4 2  Phone Manager Pro and Phone Manager PC Softphone provide the ability for users to change  their Out calling options  including the ability to set phone numbers and associated timeouts  The Out calling  information is passed between Phone Manager Pro 4 2 and VoiceMail Pro 4 2     Voicemail Forward  Phone Manager Pro and PC Softphone allow users to forward their voicemail messages to other IP Office users     Password Changing   Phone Manager Pro 4 2 can now interact with the IP Office to change the User password  The Phone Manager  User password is also used by the TAPI driver  if installed  The Phone Manager Password mechanism also  accommodates the requirements of the Avaya TAPI Driver when changed     Softphone Vista Support  Phone Manager PC Softphone 4 2 supports operation on Windows Vista Business Ultimate     Softphone supports Login  Phone Manager PC Softphone 4 2 now allows users to login as an agent and therefore supports interaction with  Compact Contact Center and Small Business Contact Center        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 13  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Four Sources of Music on Hold   IP Office 4 2 allows up to 3 alternate WAV file sources for music on hold  selectable for Incoming Call Routes  or Hunt Groups  not available on the Small Office Edition   On IP500 systems  each source can be up to 90  seconds long  30 seconds on IP406 V2 and IP412      Call Priority Enhancements  The
314. ngle VCM while the IP412 can have any two VCMs installed     The following table shows how many of each card are supported by each platform       ea mp4i2__ _1P500_   1 2 2     IP400 VCM 4  IP400 VCM 8 1 2 2   IP400 VCM 16 1 2 2   IP400 VCM 24 1 2 2   IP400 VCM 30 1 2 2   IP400 VCM 5 10 20 1 2 x   no longer sold    IP500 VCM 32 x x 2  IP500 VCM 64 x x 2     Each card requires the use of an IP500 Legacy Card Carrier     IP400 Internal Modem Card    An internal modem card with 12 modems can be installed in both the IP406 V2 and IP412 to provide dial up  capacity that is better matched to remote access requirements of customers  The Internal Modem card allows  up to 12 simultaneous V 90  56kbps  analog modem calls into the IP Office        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 36  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        External Expansion Modules       Unless otherwise stated  each of these modules may be used with the IP500  IP406 V2 and IP412     e IP500 Phone Expansion Module  32 gt   Available in two variants for 16 or 30 analog extensions with calling line presentation     e IP500 Digital Station Expansion Module 4   Available in two variants for 16 or 30 digital extensions for Avaya series digital telephones       IP500 BRI So8 Expansion Module  395  Available regionally  offering 8 BRI S interfaces for ISDN connection     e IP500 Analog Trunk 16 Expansion Module   3  US version only   Provides 16 analog loop start or ground start trunks  with 
315. ngle click  A single Direct Station Select icon allows you to dial their work  mobile cell phone and home  numbers  The Busy Lamp Field feature allows you to see at a glance  who is available to take a call  who is  already on a call and who has placed their phone on Do Not Disturb  BLF information is also available on  remote users as long as they are on a Small Community Network  SCN   Phone Manager Lite supports up to  15 Speed Dial BLF entries              DE     A                  n Abbey Nortin Anne Webb Betty FAX     Edmunds  pus x om   a  O    g etek  8     SES  gt       amp        Fred Fred Home Theresa  re cree       Internal User External Number      ee  Bi  A New Voicemail Message a    not for remote SCN users   LA    Where Microsoft Live Communications Server  LCS  is also available within the user s business  Phone Manager  users can view colleague   s presence  online  offline  as well as send Instant Messages  IM  via Phone Manager   For example users can send an IM to alert a colleague that an important call is waiting for them even though  they   re busy on another call        Phone Manager also offers Conferencing Center toolbar buttons that allow users to book a conference or join a  web conference  Note  The booking feature is only available if the user has been granted permission by the  system administrator and Conferencing Center has been installed  see the Conferencing Center section for  further details         Product Description    2009 AVAYA All r
316. ngle orderable item results in a set of licenses in the IP Office configuration     For example a number of license sets of available for Unified Communications for Small Business  These are  available in 20  25  30 and 50 user variants and can be combined for the actually number required  Each  Unified Communications for Small Business license actually adds the matching number of Mobility Features   Phone Manager Pro and Phone Manager Pro IP Audio Enabled licenses to the IP Office configuration     e   Unified Communications for Small Business License   20 Users  IPO UC SML BUSINESS SOLUTION  20 LIC  216761    e     Unified Communications for Small Business License   25 Users  IPO UC SML BUSINESS SOLUTION  25 LIC  216762    e     Unified Communications for Small Business License   30 Users  IPO UC SML BUSINESS SOLUTION  30 LIC  216763    e   Unified Communications for Small Business License   50 Users  IPO UC SML BUSINESS SOLUTION  50 LIC  216764     Licensing Examples  Some features require a combination of licenses     Example 1  IP500 Small Community Network    Each IP500  Required e IP500 Voice Networking  Base 4 Channels    Licenses  Optional e IP500 Voice Networking  Additional Channels    Licenses e IP500 VCM Channels     Example 2  Voicemail Pro in an IP500 Small Community Network     Central IP500 Remote IP500    Required IP500 Upgrade Standard to Professional   e IP500 Voice Networking  Base 4  Licenses IP500 Voice Networking  Base 4 Channels     Channels     Voice
317. nits     e IP400 Analog Trunk 16   North America only  700211360   Provides an additional 16 Analog trunks  loop start or ground start  and two power fail sockets     e IP400 Analog Trunk 16 EU  700241680   Provides an additional 16 Analog trunks  loop start  and two power fail sockets  European CTR21  specification        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 274  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     IP500 Voice Compression Modules   e IP Office 500 Media Card Voice Coding Module 32  700417389   Voice Compression Module required for IP trunks and extensions  4 channels are enabled by default   Additional channels up to the maximum of 32 are enabled through license keys  Includes 128ms echo  cancellation     e IP Office 500 Media Card Voice Coding Module 64  700417397   Voice Compression Module required for IP trunks and extensions  4 channels are enabled by default   Additional channels up to the maximum of 64 are enabled through license keys  Includes 128ms echo  cancellation     IP500 Base Cards  Only supported in the IP500     e IP Office 500 Extension Card Digital Station 8  700417330   e IP Office 500 Extension Card Phone 8  700417231   e IP Office 500 Extension Card Phone 2  700431778     e IP500 Media Card Voice Compression Module 32  700417389   Voice Compression Module required for IP trunks and extensions  4 channels are enabled by default   Additional channels up to the maximum of 32 are enabled through license keys  Includes 128ms ech
318. ns can be set as call  appearance buttons through the IP Office Manager application  The number of call appearance buttons set for  a user determines the number of simultaneous calls they can make and answer     Note that the use of call appearance buttons overrides IP Office call waiting features  It is only when all call  appearances are in use that subsequent callers receive either busy tone  voicemail or follow a forward on busy  action    When call appearance buttons are used  a minimum of three call appearance buttons is recommended where  possible  although some phones are restricted to two call appearance buttons by the number or design of their  programmable buttons        Bridged Appearance Buttons    Feature  e Allow the user to have an appearance button that matches another user s call appearance button     Benefit   e Answer and make calls on behalf of the other user    e Audible indication of calls presented to the bridged user  where programmed   e Visual indication of when the other user has calls presented  held or connected    e Join and exchange calls using the paired call appearance and bridged appearance buttons   Description  A bridged appearance button matches the activity on one of another user s call appearance button  For    example  when the call appearance shows a ringing call  the bridged appearance button will also show the  ringing call and can be used to answer that call     Similarly  if the bridged appearance button is used to make a call  th
319. ntifying who the caller is   This may then be used for routing or computer telephony applications     Ti trunk cards incorporate an integral CSU DSU  eliminating the need for an external unit  The CSU function  allows the trunk to be put in loop back mode for testing purposes  This can be set manually  using the monitor  application  or automatically from a Central Office sending a Line Loop Back  LLB  pattern  The DSU function  allows the T1 trunk to be shared between data and voice services     North American Primary Rate Interface  Provided by the IP400 PRI T1 and IP500 Universal PRI cards     IP Office supports Primary Rate ISDN trunks on 5ESS or DMS100 central office switches provided by AT amp T   Sprint  WorldCom and other Local Telcos  Channels can be pre configured for the supported services or  negotiated on a call by call basis     Special Services can be configured to route calls to local operators or pre subscribed carriers for both national  and international calls  SSS   Alternate carriers can also be selected through the configuration of IP Offices  Transit Network Selection  TNS  tables     IP Office also supports the Calling Name and Number service over Primary Rate Trunks  NI2         Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 145  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Analog Trunks    e Loop Start  Loop start trunks are available on the IP Office Analog Trunk cards installed within the IP Office control  unit  or on the Analog Trunk 
320. ntral  database  MSDE or SQL   This provides the data source for a set of standard reports to the business   and the capability to create custom reports     CCC Reporter   The system allows up to 20 separate Report Viewers within the contact center  for MSDE installations   up to 5 viewers are supported   Access to the standard reports is a thin client application based on  Crystal Reports  Up to 73 standard reports are available  with the ability to create 3 more custom  reports  see custom reports section below  Reports can be exported to a variety of formats  including  Excel  CSV  HTML  and PDF     Report Scheduler  All historical reports created within CCC can be scheduled for individual delivery to anyone via email or  sent to multiple network printers     Custom Reports   All CCC reports are created through Crystal Reports  This application provides a much richer experience  for the small to mid market customer  and creates an environment where custom reporting is more  accessible  To create more than 3 CCC custom reports requires the designer license  IPO CCC  DESIGNER RFA  AND a compatible version of Crystal Reporting software  Crystal version 9      Wallboards    e Fixed Wallboards  Fixed scrolling wallboards enable key statistics and messages to be displayed for everyone in the  contact center to see  Supervisors can send ad hoc messages to wallboards to broadcast important  information  or to make announcements     e PC Wallboards  PC based wallboards allow indivi
321. ntralized Voice Mail 153       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 321  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       Centralized voicemail 10  22  141  155  201  220  centralized VoiceMail Pro 10  Centralized Voicemail Services 220    Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol 167   291    Channel Associated Signaling 143  Channel Monitor 126  Channel Voice Compression 273  CHAP 164  167  169  170  291  Character Display 85  87  Charger Unit 82  checkbox 207  Checking 143  Circuit ID  Incoming 267  Outgoing 267  Circuit Switched 142  Circuit Switched Data Call Basic 155  Circuit Switched Data Call Basic Call 142  155  Circuit Switched Voice Networking 142  Circuit switched 129  Cisco 84  133  Cisco Systems 133  Citrix 182  C LAN  DEFINITY 9 5 155  Clear Call 126  Clear CW 126  Clear Hunt Group Night Service 126  Clear Hunt Group Out  Service 126  Clear Hunt Group Out Of Service 126  Clear Quota 126  CLI 91  181  254  282  290  existing 10  CLI Feature 91  CLI Schemes 290  CLI ANI 201  CLIP 143  CLIR 143  Clock 165  Speaking  closet switch  wiring 133  Co Ax 273  Code Dialed 267  Code Used 114  267  Codec G 711 69  Codecs 55  56  58  60  64  65  66  135  155  Cold Start 262  Collaboration 174 177  Color Backlight Display 60    201  220    COLP  Inhibits 143  COLR 143    Comfort 46  72  97  comma separated 195  Common Features 55  56  58  60  62  64  65  66  Compact Business Center 20  22  Compact Call Center 252  Compact Contact Cente
322. nvalid  If it is necessary to  exchange a Feature Key due to faults the existing key and licenses can be exchanged     Some licenses enable a number of ports  channels or users  Depending on the particular license  each  supported instance may be consumed either when it is configured for use or alternatively when it is actually  being used  When no further instances of a license are available  further use of the licensed feature is not  allowed     Typically for port  channel and user licenses  multiple license can be added to give a higher number of  supported ports  channels or users  However licenses above the capacity supported by the particular IP Office  control unit will not work     The following sections detail the current individual IP Office licenses  The actual licenses are indicated by a     icon and the following information     e   License Name in IP Office Configuration  Avaya orderable part name  Material Code   License description        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 297  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     General Licenses  The following licenses are supported on all current IP Office control units     e   Advanced Small Community Networking License  IPO LIC ADVANCED NTWKG LIC  202966   This license enables the use of the Distributed Hunt Groups and Remote Hot Desking features within an IP  Office Small Community Network  A license is required in each IP Office system in the network     e For IP500 systems  a Voice Netw
323. o  cancellation     e IP500 Media Card Voice Compression Module 64  700417397   Voice Compression Module required for IP trunks and extensions  4 channels are enabled by default   Additional channels up to the maximum of 64 are enabled through license keys  Includes 128ms echo  cancellation     e IP Office 500 Carrier Card  700417215   Supports a range of IP400 trunk cards     IP500 Trunk Daughter Cards  Only supported in the IP500  Each requires an IP500 base card other than the IP500 Carrier card     e IP Office 500 Trunk Card Analog 4 Universal  700417405    e IP Office 500 Trunk Card Primary Rate 1 Universal  700417439   e IP Office 500 Trunk Card Primary Rate 2 Universal  700417462   e IP Office 500 Trunk Card Basic Rate 4 Universal  700417413    e IP Office 500 Trunk Card Basic Rate 8 Universal  700417421     IP400 Voice Compression Modules  All of the following can be installed in the IP Office 500 using the IP500 Legacy Card Carrier  700417215      e Voice Compression Module 4  700359854   4 Channel Voice Compression module required for IP trunks and extensions  Includes 64ms echo  cancellation     e Voice Compression Module 8  700359862   8 Channel Voice Compression module required for IP trunks and extensions  Includes 64ms echo  cancellation     e Voice Compression Module 16  700359870   16 Channel Voice Compression module required for IP trunks and extensions  Includes 64ms echo  cancellation     e Voice Compression Module 24  700359888   24 Channel Voice Compress
324. o  meet your needs starting Day One     Keeping ongoing management simple     Concerned about needing extra resources to administer a system as powerful as IP Office  There   s no need for  worry  IP Office comes with a whole set of menu driven tools to keep ongoing management simple     Does my current phone system give my business what it needs     If it is based on old technology  probably not  Your competitors will react faster and appear more professional  with the latest in communications software  IP Office delivers the capabilities that allow you to keep up with or  overtake the competition     Do I need to understand the technology to implement it     No  IP Office is designed specifically to give you more functionality without making more demands on your  resources  Rely on your certified Avaya BusinessPartner for support before  during and after your purchase   We ll take care of you so you don   t have to worry     Do I need to spend a lot     Not at all  You have choices based on your budget needs  Easy leasing or financing plans not only make this  affordable  they help you quickly cut monthly expenses immediately  And you only have to buy lease what you  need  when you need it        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 7  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Is IP technology so new that it   s not reliable     With over 130 000 systems deployed worldwide  Avaya is  1 in Enterprise and IP Telephony shipments    source Dell Oro and 
325. o IP Office Phone Manager  the  instigator of the conference can keep control  the Caller ID number  and the associated name if  recognized  of each participant is displayed within the Conference tab of Phone Manager  If required   he she can selectively hang up a specific participant     e Customized greeting  Record a personalized greeting per conference  requires VoiceMail Pro      e Conference entry exit tones  Single beep on entry double beep on exit    e Conference call recording  Manual recording initiated by user on IP Office via Phone Manager  digital IP display phone or a short  code  requires VoiceMail Pro     e Security  To prevent unauthorized access to the conference bridge  PIN codes  Caller ID number screening as well  as time and date profiles can be set up using IP Office VoiceMail Pro     e Privacy  In cases where the security of calls is critical  in house conferencing is the only way to ensure privacy     e Remote Management  Allows a single person to manage the conferencing bridge facility from any location  Furthermore  the  full IP Office solution   phone system  voicemail  CTI server  router  firewall and DHCP server  can all be  managed from a single management interface called IP Office Manager        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 232  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Conferencing Center       The integrated conferencing functionality on IP Office is enhanced by adding Conferencing Center  This optional  l
326. o the same destination  a Priority level can be associated with the call   This priority level is used to determine a call s queue position in place of simple arrival time  but note that calls  already ringing a free extension are not considered queuing and are not affected by a high priority call joining  a queue  unless the option  Assign Call On Agent Answer  is selected for that Hunt Group   In Release 4 2 a  new Priority Promotion Timer can be configured to increase the priority of calls which have been in the queue  for more than a defined time     An optional tag can be added to calls on the Incoming Call Route  which can be displayed on the alerting  telephone        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 120  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Hunt Groups    A Hunt Group is a collection of users  typically users handling similar types of calls  e g  a sales department   An incoming caller wishing to speak to Sales can ring one number but the call can be answered by any number  of extensions that are members of the Hunt Group     Four modes of call presentation are supported on IP Office   e Sequential  One extension at a time sequentially always starting at the top of the list     e Collective  All extensions in the Hunt Group simultaneously     e Rotary  Start with the extension in the list immediately following the extension that answered the last Hunt  Group call     e Longest Waiting  Start with the extension that has been free fo
327. obility Licenses   These licenses enable users to be configured to use the IP Office Mobility features  Those features include  Mobile Twinning  Mobile Call Control  IP500 only  and one X Mobile Client  IP500 only   The license instances  are consumed by a user being configured for any mobility feature    e   Mobility Features License   1 User  IPO LIC MOBILITY RFA 1  195569    e   Mobility Features License   5 Users  IPO LIC MOBILITY RFA 5  195570      Mobility Features License   10 Users  IPO LIC MOBILITY RFA 10  195571      Mobility Features License   20 Users  IPO LIC MOBILITY RFA 20  195572    e   Mobility Features License   50 Users  IPO LIC MOBILITY RFA 50  195573     3rd Party IP End Points Licenses   Avaya IP phones supported by the IP Office can register with the IP Office without requiring any license  Other  IP phones require a IP End Points license and will consume one instance of that license  Note that Avaya  cannot guarantee operation beyond making and receiving calls    e   IP End Points License   1 Phone  IPO LIC IP400 IP ENDPOINT RFA 1 LIC CU  174956    e   IP End Points License   5 Phones  IPO LIC IP400 IP ENDPOINT RFA 5 LIC CU  174957    e   IP End Points License   10 Phones  IPO LIC IP400 IP ENDPOINT RFA 10 LIC CU  174958    e   IP End Points License   20 Phones  IPO LIC IP400 IP ENDPOINT RFA 20 LIC CU  174959    e   IP End Points License   50 Phones  IPO LIC IP400 IP ENDPOINT RFA 50 LIC CU  174960    e   IP End Points License   100 Phones  IPO LIC IP400
328. omer Contact Center 242  Customer Tracking 254  Customized Voicemail 220  CW 126   CW1308 287   Cyclic Redundancy 143   Czech Republic 277    D    D Message 284   Data Access Components 210  Data Call 120  122  142  167  Data Channels 32  135   Data Communication Solution 19  Data Communication Solution Features 19  Data Compression 167   Data Header Compression 167  Data Jack 90   Data Rates 290   data traffic 72  136  150  166    Database 101  201  206  210  211  216  217 218   252  254    Datagram Protocol 291  Date Records 267  Date Routing 10  Day One   starting 6  day month 267  Day Night service 94  D channel 16kbps 290  D channel 64kbps 290  DDI 10  103  143  254  282  DDI Call Duration 254  DDI Distribution 254  DDI Response 254  DDI Routing 254  DDI Summary 254  DDI DID 10  69  100  120  143  209  253  DDI DID call 120  DDI DID Details 253  DECT 68  69  143  DECT Networking 69  Default   E amp M 290  default greeting 104  default numbering 107  Definable PIN Code 220       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 323  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       DEFINITY 46  85  155  DEFINITY 6400 46  DEFINITY 9 5  C LAN 155  DEFINITY G3si 155  DEFINITY ACM  branches 155  DEFINITY ACM occupying 155  Delete Message 220  deleting 104  Delphi 282  Delta Server 268  Denmark 277  Deploying  IP 133  Depth 80  254  287  Designing  IP Telephony 131  Reports Using 254  Reports Using Crystal Reports 254  Desk Wall Mount 90  deskers 108  de
329. on allows the trunk to be put in loop back  mode for testing purposes  This can be set manually  using the monitor application  or automatically from a  Central Office sending a Line Loop Back  LLB  pattern  The DSU function allows the T1 trunk to be shared  between data and voice services     IP400 Universal Quad Analog Trunk  LS  Card    This card provides four analog trunk ports  These are 2 wire loop start interfaces and are available in all  territories  This card supports Caller ID where provided  With IP Office R3 1 and later  this module supports  optional 16ms echo cancellation     Please note that ground start analog trunks are supported via the IP Office Analog Trunk 16 Expansion Module        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 35  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Internal Daughter Cards       Internal Daughter Cards are fitted inside the IP406 V2 and IP412 control units        IP400 Voice Compression Module   4 8 16 24 30 ports    The Voice Compression Module  VCM  is used for Voice over IP  VoIP  applications in the IP406 and IP412  control units  Five VCM variants are available supporting 4  8  16  24 and 30 channels of compression  The  echo cancellation capabilities of the VCM cards vary  The VCM 4  8  16 and 24 cards offer 64ms of echo  cancellation while the VCM 30 card offers 25ms     On IP Office   Small Office Edition systems  either 3 or 16 VCM channels are built in and cannot be changed   The IP406 V2 supports a si
330. on error state where the user s association to an extension is  broken due to the extension being unplugged or a network fault        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 11  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Management Enhancements    Static NAT  This new feature is designed primarily for dial up diagnostic requirements and maintenance abilities  For  example this could be utilised to give access to VoiceMail Pro servers     IP Office Firewall settings now support Static NAT  with the ability to   pair  external to internal IP addressing   Up to 64 such pairs can be created programming via the Manager     Static NAT allows the following applications though the Static NAT translations     e PC Anywhere  e Windows Terminal Server  e Ping and Tracert  e Manager  e Sysmon  e Upgrade Wizard  e SSA  e VM Pro Client    System Status Application enhancements    In IP Office 4 2  System Status Application  SSA  has a new real time configuration alarms screen which  shows the following new alarms     e Duplicate Numbers in Small Community Networking dial plan  e    No routing for Line      Incoming Line Group has no associated Incoming Call Route  e Call Routed to a non existent Start Point in VoiceMail Pro  e SSA displays the following new resource availability alarms in IP Office 4 2   e Attempt to use a feature for which no license is installed  e Voicemail storage full or nearly full  e The following new screens are provided in SSA in IP Office 4 2
331. on expansion module to a maximum of 10 x XM24 units per  system     e Two 4450 units on each Digital Station expansion module to a maximum of 10 x 4450 units per  system     e T3 DSS units     See the Telephones Section for specific limits on the number of each type of telephone supported on DS  modules        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 42  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        IP400 Analog Trunk 16 Module    This expansion module provides an additional sixteen Loop Start or Ground Start two wire analog trunks    Ground start trunks are not available in all territories  The first two trunks on the module which are  automatically switched to power fail sockets on the rear of the unit in the event of power being interrupted  must be loop start for correct power fail operation        Analog Trunk Ports  Individually switchable to loop or ground start     PF1 PF2 EXPANSION       DC Power Input Socket DTE Serial Port Functional Power Fail Analog To IP Office  To external power supply 25 pin D type socket  Grounding Phone Sockets Control Unit   unit  Point During power fail     PF1   Analog Trunk 1   PF2   Analog Trunk 2        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 43  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 44  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Chapter 3   Telephones       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 45  IP Off
332. one  the user will need an audio device such as a   headset or USB handset  both USB and soundcard interfaces can be used with PC Softphone        PC Softphone can be twinned with another IP Office extension offering mobility and choice so that calls can be  answered on either endpoint     AVAYA       Phone Manager PC Softphone  Barry Smith     en CUS CPV ER CNE      CIE     VIEW     ACTIONS     Dep           iit        f f Tag Extn280 Theresa    Cu P         5     Phone Manager PC Softphone has the significant advantage for mobile users with wireless or wired remote  access to the LAN  providing  a phone within their laptop  with all the features available in the office  From IP  Office 4 2 onwards  users can also login as a call center agent using Softphone  PC Softphone is supported on  Windows Vista Business Ultimate        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 180  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Phone Manager Feature Summary       Feature    Inbound outbound call handling   Phone call control   Configure phone preferences   onfigure keyboard short cuts   CLI  ANI    Name display   Speed dial   Busy Lamp Field management     Speed Dial tabs  to group Busy Lamp Field icons     Transfer call by drag and drop to a speed dial icon   Microsoft Live Communications Server  LCS  Integration  View internal users    presence via LCS   end Instant Messages  IM  to internal users via LCS  Telecommuter mode  Compact mode  Local Phone Directory    
333. ontrol Unit    307  IP400 WANS 10 1002  310  IP400 So8 Expansion Module    310  Small Office Edition    311  Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 4    IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Chapter 1   Introduction       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 5  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     1  Introduction    This document forms no part of a contract  the specification of the Avaya IP Office family is subject  to change without notice  Not all components and features documented are available in all  territories  refer to your Avaya Representative for further details  This document should be read in  conjunction with any issued technical bulletins and or product offer announcements        Avaya IP Office Family       The Intelligent Communications solution for small and midsize businesses     What is IP Office     A solution for voice and data communications  messaging and customer management  It uses IP technology to  deliver more functionality at a lower cost     How can I use it in my business     To connect with colleagues and customers    simplify access to information    keep remote workers in touch  To  save money through conferencing  networking  time  call management  Voice over IP and more     What are my choices     Does your business have one location  Multiple locations  Are you a branch office of a larger organization  A  home office  With IP Office you can choose from a range of models and add ca
334. ony settings  a subset of buttons and some  Hunt Group settings     e Transfer of the updated configuration back to the IP Office using a secure TCP connection  Support of this component is only available through the Avaya Developer Connection  DevConnect  program     New country support  New locales for German Swiss and Italian Swiss have been added  as has a Turkish locale     Enhanced Outgoing Call Barring   Release 4 2 adds a password protected mechanism to allow a user to enable and disable the ability to make  external outbound calls from an extension  This is supported through the introduction of a new Short Code and  makes use of existing Login Codes        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 15  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Operating System Support  The following Microsoft Operating Systems and Applications will be supported by IP Office 4 2 core  applications     IPO SSA TAPI TAPI   Manager  1st Party     3rd Party   Windows Server OS  2000 Server  SP4    2003 Server  SP2    2008 Server 32 bit   2008 Server 64 bit   Windows Client OS  2000 Professional  SP4      2  O    2  O     lt   vV   lt   D  za         lt   oO  Blo        lt   un    XP Professional  SP3 4  Vista Business Enterprise  SP1 5  Vista Ultimate  SP1  gt     Applications  Outlook 2003  Outlook 2007       Notes     1 Windows 2000 operating systems are no longer supported by IP Office  They may function but have not  been tested with IP Office 4 2 and any faults rep
335. or all users of the system  Neither the IP500 nor the IP406 V2 require voice  compression modules for storing messages and both support up to 15 hours of storage     Key features of Embedded Voicemail include     e 3 Port voicemail as standard on Small Office Edition  10 ports with 16VC variants of Small Office  Edition   4 port voicemail for IP500 and IP406 V2     e Up to 10 hours storage on Small Office Edition  15 hours message storage on the IP500 and IP406 V2   e Configurable record time  Default value 2 minutes  maximum value 3 minutes    e Mailbox security codes ensure a minimum of 4 characters to be set    e Multiple languages stored on the Flash Memory card    e Help menus  via  4   Greetings and Mailbox Navigation     e From Release 4 2  it is possible to send an email containing either notification or the complete voicemail  message from the Embedded Voicemail  IP406 V2 and IP500 units only      e Voicemail Breakout Personal Auto Attendant  Up to 3 breakout numbers can be set up  When callers are  directed to your mailbox  they can either leave a message or choose to be transferred to one of three  numbers  e g  Operator  mobile cell phone  colleague  etc      e Configurable system wide short code for Voicemail collect  e g   17    e 40 independent Auto Attendants with 3 time profiles per Auto Attendant   e Up to 12 menu items per Auto Attendant with automatic time out to fallback number     e Access and control of voicemail via the digital or IP terminal display  
336. orking license is required to support standard and advanced Small  Community Networking     e   IPSec Tunneling License  IPO LIC IP400 IPSEC VPN RFA LIC DS  182301   IP Office control units can be configured to support VPN tunnels using IPSec and or L2TP  While L2TP tunnels  can be configured without requiring a license  the use of IPSec tunnels requires this license  Note that IP  Office VPN tunnels are not suitable terminating VPN links for Avaya VPNremote client phones     e   Conferencing Center License  IPO LIC IP400 CONF CENTER RFA LIC DS  182302   Enables the Conference Center for scheduling calls and managing content delivery over an internet  connection     e   Centralized Intuity Audix Voicemail License  IPO LIC IP400 ACM CENTRAL VM LIC DS  177467   Enables the use of a centralized Intuity Audix system for the IP Office voicemail server     e CTI TAPI Licenses  The IP Office TAPI software can be run in two modes  1st party or 3rd party  1st Party mode does not  require a license and allows individual users to control their phone using a TAPI compliant application on  their PC  3rd Party mode requires licenses and allows a TAPI application to control calls for any users on the  IP Office     e   CTI Link Pro License  IPO LIC IP400 CTI RFA LIC DS  171988   This license allows the IP Office TAPI software to be run in 3rd party mode  A license is required for  each server configured to run the IP Office TAPI software in 3rd party mode     e   WAVE User License  IPO LIC 
337. ort  24 lines      e IP400 Dual PRI T1  700185218   Interface card for the IP406 and IP412 providing 2 x T1 PRI  48 lines      e IP400 Quad Analog Trunk  Universal   700359938   Interface card for the IP406 and IP412 providing 4 x Loop start analog trunks  Universal variant  supports specifications for North America  Europe and New Zealand        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 276  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Country Availability       IP Office is available from distribution partners in the following countries  Please refer to your country price list  for the availability of individual items     Argentina  Brazil  Canada  Chile  Colombia  Mexico  Peru    USA    Austria  Belgium  Bulgaria  Croatia   Cyprus   Czech Republic  Denmark  Estonia    Finland    France  Germany  Greece  Hungary  Iceland  Ireland    Italy    Latvia     Lithuania  Luxembourg  Malta  Netherlands  Norway  Poland  Portugal  Romania  Russia  Slovenia  Slovakia  South Africa  Spain  Sweden  Switzerland    United Kingdom    Australia    China  Hong Kong    India  New Zealand  South Korea    Taiwan       Product Description    IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 277  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Sample Configurations             IP500   Scenario 1   A US business requiring 190 display phones and 96 digital trunks with 20 analog lines for fallback purposes   This configuration uses an IP500 providing 196 extensions and 96 digital trunk
338. orted with IP Office 4 2 will not be fixed     2 32 bit only  Small Business Server 2003 is supported for the same applications as Windows 2003  Server     3  Subject to GA release of 2008 Server within acceptable timescales   4  32 bit only   5  32 bit only     VoiceMail Pro 4 2 and all of its components will be able to run under the following operating systems  32 bit  only  64 bit versions of 2003 2008 Server and XP Professional are not supported        e Microsoft Windows XP Professional SP3    except VoiceMail Web Access    e Microsoft Vista Business   Ultimate SP1    except IMS  Campaigns and VoiceMail Web Access    e Microsoft Windows Server 2003 SP2    e Microsoft Windows Server 2008    except IMS       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 16  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Notice about the support of Integrated Messaging  IMS    IMS will not be supported under Vista and Server 2008     e Continued IMS support for IP Office releases 3 2   4 x  e Supported operating systems    e IMS Client  Windows XP SP3   e IMS Server  Windows Server 2003 SP2  Windows Vista and Server 2008 will not be supported  e Support for    e Exchange Server 2000   e Exchange Server 2003    The following Microsoft Operating Systems and Applications will be supported by Phone Manager 4 2     Pe Phone Manager   Windows elent oS Sa   2000 Professional  SP4  11  No    XP Professional  SP3  21    eee    _               joutiook 2007 fn SSSCSC S       Notes     1 Wi
339. otely     IVR for individual business requirements    Personal Numbering    Broadcast group messages    Audiotex and Auto Attendant services  including dial by name    Sophisticated Queue Announcement facilities    Conditions  e g  test if    out of hours         Automatic and On Demand Call Recording with an option for ContactStore Search and replay of saved  messages    Voice Forms Questionnaire Mailboxes  Campaign Manager     Personal distribution lists    Access to Database information for building Interactive Voice Response  IVR  systems    Tag information retrieved from a database to a call and delivers it with the call to an agent     Visual Basic  VB  Script support to allow the configuration of the voicemail system through VB Scripts  rather than VoiceMail Pro call flows     Extended Personal Greetings to customize the information presented to a caller based upon the  availability of a user     Text To Speech facilities to allow emails to be read out over the telephone and or for database  information to be read to a caller in 14 languages     Housekeeping facilities for the management of messages     Automatic detection and routing of Fax calls within Auto Attendants and within a subscriber s voicemail  box     Forwarding of voicemail messages to Email systems via SMTP     Unified Messaging  UMS  offers voice mail   email synchronization between VoiceMail Pro server and  email client     VoiceMail Pro Web Access allows access to voice mails via a web interface    Su
340. oth  concurrently  IP Office has data capabilities built in  providing IP routing  switching and Firewall protection  between LAN and WAN  IP Office has an integrated software applications suite that delivers a contact center   voice and email messaging  Interactive Voice Response  conferencing and computer telephony integration     IP Office solutions are built from hardware units and application software  Hardware provides the connectivity  for voice and data circuits and processor units for the solution software  Each IP Office solution will require a  system control unit  IP500 or IP412   trunk connections to service provider  and expansion modules for TDM  phone cabling  IP Phones connect over LAN connections to the IP Office solution        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 24  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        IP Office 500 Control Unit       With a greater VCM channel capacity and performance  the IP Office 500  IP500  is the most suitable of the IP  Office range for IP Telephony applications  It also provides an entry level offer into the IP Office family through  IP Office Standard Edition software  The IP500 also differs from the IP412 by providing a greater trunk  expansion capability of up to eight four PRI interfaces  maximum 192 240 trunks   The IP500 is a stackable  unit with an optional 19  rack mounting kit and an optional wall mounting kit for smaller configurations  The  IP500 includes     e 4 slots to house a mixture
341. ound Call Handling       IP Office offers several features to provide versatile inbound call processing  including PC based applications   and a standards based TAPI interface for 3rd party applications        Incoming Call Routing    Incoming calls can to be presented to an Operator who then decides where to pass the call  but IP Office  supports intelligent call routing capable of making routing decisions based on a number of criteria     The system currently supports routing based on   e Call presentation digits from the exchange such as DDI DID or ISDN MSN     e Calling telephone number or Caller ID  This could even be part of the number received such as an area  code      e ISDN sub address     e ISDN PRI service type i e  Voice Call  Data Call  etc     It is even possible to look for multiple criteria so  for instance  a DDI DID call to a sales group could be  handled differently depending on which part of the country the call is originating from     Each incoming Call Route also supports a secondary destination  Night Service    that can provide alternative  routing for an incoming call based on    time of day  and    day of week  criteria  as well as calendar based routing  for specific dates     Calls that cannot be routed to the configured destination are re routed to a user defined    Fall Back  destination   This can be particularly useful where calls are normally answered by an auto attendant and a network fault  occurs     Where multiple call routes are set up t
342. ovides an additional 36 programmable buttons with associated  printed text labels and indicators  and can be programmed for lines  groups or speed dial numbers  3 DSS  Modules can be added to each T3 phone  Power is provided by T3 Upn telephones  but an external power  adapter is needed for each DSS module when used on T3 IP telephones     IP Office 406  IP412 and IP500 support a maximum of 30 T3 DSS modules per control unit        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 67  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Wireless and Remote Phone Solutions       Avaya IP Office Wireless Solutions include analog  digital and IP based WiFi wireless phones  These are  solutions employees can use every day to work more effectively and be more responsive to customers     all  while increasing revenues and keeping communication costs firmly under control  Also  Avaya IP Office Mobility  Solutions integrate seamlessly with IP Office  enhancing each customer   s investment  IP Office s in building  Mobility Solutions improve communication with staff that  because of the function they perform  are mobile  within the workplace  Using wireless technology  such individuals may be instantly contactable  with many  obvious benefits     e The wireless telephone is carried in the pocket  so users are not tied to the desk in order to remain in  contact     e Users may be contacted instantly to ensure fast  accurate decision making and immediate response to  problems throug
343. ox for voicemail messages  emails and fax message  VoiceMail Pro can  also provide the ability to retrieve email messages through the telephone  When operating in INTUITY mode  and with the system licensed for Text To Speech  TTS  facilities the user will be presented with a list of both  voicemail messages and email messages  The emails can be read out over the telephone in any of the  supported 14 languages  based upon the system or user localization settings  The benefit to the user is that  their messages are now accessible while in and out of the office through any telephone     When accessing messages through the telephone all new voicemail messages will be presented to the mailbox  owner before any new email messages  When accessing an email message the system refers to the message  as  New message with text      Configuring the reading of emails to users is a simple exercise  Firstly  TTS services will be loaded onto the  VoiceMail Pro server  the Avaya TTS media pack will install the Avaya TTS engine   Secondly  a TTS license  key will need to be purchased and entered into IP Office manager  Thirdly  for each user who is wishes to  utilize email reading  the user s email address will need to be entered into the user profile details in IP Office  Manager and the facility enabled through the email reading checkbox     Where the user has email reading in their voicemail box  they will be able to record a voice reply to the email   and send it as a  WAV attachment to a r
344. pacity  applications and phones   as you need them  Whether you have 2 employees  200 or more  IP Office is the right choice     IP Office  Three key things to know    Every small  and medium size business needs ways to reduce costs and improve the way it operates  Like  every business  you   re looking to keep all your customers  add new ones and grow at the pace that   s right for  you  Avaya understands this  With over one hundred years of experience as a leader in communications  we  know that the right solution for your business is one that helps you increase profitability  improve productivity  and gain competitive advantages     Get big business communications    at small business prices    Over one million businesses rely on Avaya solutions like Avaya IP Office    the award winning business  communications system that gives growing companies an    all in one    solution for telephony  messaging   networking  conferencing  customer management and much more  Growing businesses know they can rely on  Avaya for big business capabilities at small business prices   Avaya has an entire division focused on the needs  of small  and medium size businesses  We support extensive research into new technologies and standards   and we make it easy for businesses like yours to acquire our solutions by offering an array of financing  options     See what Avaya can do for you    You need a communications system   every business does  To find one that   s right for your business  start 
345. pectrum 258  Speed Dial 58  60  67  118  119  174  181  Speed Dial List 58  60  Speed Dial BLF 177  Speed Dial BLF 174  speed dial Busy Lamp Field 177  spread spectrum 71  Sprint 143  SQL 210  252  254  SQL Query Builder Wizard 210  SSA 10 269  SSA connects 269    201  220    SS CNIP 142  SS CNIR 142  SS CONP 142  SS CT 142  SS MWI 142  SSS 143  STAC 291    Stac Lemple Ziv 167  STAC LZS Compression Protocol 291  stackable 25  32  Stafford Technology 254  Stand 85  86  Charging 82  Stand Power Supply Adapter  Charging 82  Standard 40W Power Supply Unit 287  Standard Edition 10  22  254  Professional Edition 25  Standard Reports List 254  standards based 18  19  120  standards based TAPI 120  Start Call 177  Starter Kits    69    starting  Day One 6  Manager 10    PC Wallboard 258  State Province 254  station access 46    Status 10  21  25  62  75  105  108  113  118  121   174  185  190  196  201  218  238  252  253  254   261  269    Status Application  Status Bar 185  STD15 291  STD16 291  STD17 291  STD56 291  STD57 291  Still Queued 201  Stop Call 177  strings 143  Absence Text 105  Structured Query Language 210  STUN 147  291  Sub addressing  Allows 143  subject 6  101  123  173  217  email 203  subnet Phone Manager 182  Summary 30  98  137  233  238  254  Positioning 198  Supervised Transfer  called 103  supervisor   s Coverage Timer 110    10  21  25  269       Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 338  Issue 18 s    22 May 200
346. pending on whether your employees are working in the office  at home  or on the road  That   s why  when you choose IP Office you can also choose from a whole range of communication tools and applications  designed to boost productivity  Choose a basic phone or one with all the bells and whistles  Connect our IP  phones directly to your office LAN   also use them at home and get all the features you have at the office   Avaya Phone Manager software can turn the screen of your PC into a phone  And our wireless solutions make  it easier to roam the office  With all of our IP Office capabilities  our goal is to make your communications  simple and cost effective  Let your Avaya BusinessPartner put together a selection of tools and applications  that s right for you     Fine tuning performance     How many calls are you handling an hour  a day  What are your peak calling periods  How many calls typically  turn into sales  Avaya IP Office reporting capabilities can help you measure and manage your availability and  response to customers     Day to day administration     Once your system is up and running you will benefit from the menu driven administration tools that simplify  day to day tasks  such as updating directories and moving phone extensions     Getting started     Is your communications network ready for IP Office  We ll make sure  Avaya has created a whole set of  assessment and automated configuration tools to make sure that when your system is installed it   s ready t
347. pes are recommended as it then provides analog power failure support for one trunk extension  Not  applicable to the Analog Phone 2 base card      Each daughter card is supplied with the spacer pegs required for installation and a label to identify the card s  presence on the physical unit once installed     e IP500 Analog Trunk Card  Maximum 4    e IP500 BRI Trunk Card  Maximum 4    e IP500 Universal PRI Trunk Card  Maximum 4      IP500 Analog Trunk Card    This card can be added to an IP500 Digital Station card  IP500 Analog Phone base card  or IP500 VCM card  It  allows that card to then also support 4 analog loop start trunks  It also provides one analog V 32 modem        e When fitted to an IP500 Analog Phone 8 base card  the combination supports 1 power failure extension  to trunk connection        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 30  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     IP500 BRI Trunk Card  Euro ISDN     This type of card can be added to an IP500 Digital Station card  IP500 Analog Phone card  or IP500 VCM card   It allows that card to then also support up to 4 BRI trunk connections  each trunk providing 2B D digital  channels  The card is available in 2 port  4 channels  and 4 port  8 channels  variants        From IP Office release 4 2 onwards  the ports on IP500 BRI cards can be individually configured to operate as  an S interface  SO mode   When set as an S interface the settings for the Line will be exactly the same as for a  cir
348. ply a  matter of network architecture and good network management practices     The term  good enough    is intentional  Every customer will have different expectations and different budgets to  work to  Some will be willing to upgrade their networks to use the best possible equipment and practices  To  others the additional expense may be viewed as unnecessary     Examples of standards based Quality of Service protocols include DiffServ and 802 1p q        What are Voice Compression Modules  VCM s  for     VCM s are required to support the following scenarios     e Usage of Embedded Voicemail on the Small Office Edition  used as a memory boost by compressing the  voice files      e Internal phone calls between an IP device and a non IP device     e Analog digital phones to IP trunks  SIP H 323  including managed Frame Relay and managed IP VPN   provides echo cancellation      e IP phones to ISDN or PSTN trunks  convert IP to TDM and vice versa      IP device to IP device  Call progress tones  for example dial tone  secondary dial tone  etc  do not require voice compression  channels with the following exceptions     e Short code confirmation  ARS camp on and account code entry tones require a voice compression  channel     e Devices using G 723 require a voice compression channel for all tones except call waiting     When a call is connected   e If the IP devices use the same audio codec no voice compression channel is used     e If the devices use differing audio codecs  a 
349. power failover of two trunks     e IP400 Phone Expansion Module  4  Available in three variants for 8  16 or 30 analog extensions with calling line presentation     e IP400 Digital Station Expansion Module  42 gt   Available in two variants for 16 or 30 digital extensions for Avaya series digital telephones       IP400 So8 Expansion Module 31   No longer sold   Available regionally  offering 8 BRI S interfaces for ISDN connection       IP400 Analog Trunk 16 Expansion Module  435  Available in one variant for 16 analog loop start or ground start trunks  with power failover of two  trunks     e IP400 WAN3 10 100 Expansion Module 31   No longer sold   Provides 3 wide area interfaces and connects to IP Office via Ethernet  A maximum of 2 WAN3 10 100  modules are supported on the IP406 V2 and IP412  It is not supported on the IP500 or Small Office  Edition        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 37  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        IP500 Phone Expansion Module  This module provides additional analog telephone interfaces   e Two Wire   e DTMF signaling  No rotary or Loop Disconnect    e Time Break Recall  No Earth Loop Recall    e Caller ID capable   e Message Waiting Indication  MWI  capable   High Voltage  Pulsed High Voltage  Line Reversal     The IP500 Phone module is available in 2 versions  giving 16 or 30 extensions  Telephones can be located up  to 1km from the control unit  For extensions located  out of the building  additional lin
350. pport for a range of the INTUITY telephone user interface features in INTUITY emulation mode   Recording of system prompts through the telephone handset or using multimedia facilities on a PC   Speaking Clock     22 supported prompt languages  Chinese  Mandarin   Danish  Dutch  English  UK   English  US    Finnish  French  France   French  Canadian   German  Greek  Hungarian  Japanese  Italian  Korean   Norwegian  Polish  Portuguese  European   Portuguese  Brazilian   Russian  Spanish  Castilian   Spanish   Latin American   Swedish    Support for TTY hearing impaired text phone   Centralized voicemail within a multi site IP Office environment   Networked Messaging with other Avaya voicemail systems   Capacity of up to 30 ports  depending on IP Office Control Unit      Voicemail channels between VoiceMail Pro and the IP Office can be reserved for business critical  functions or left unreserved for any function     Access and control of voicemail via the digital or IP terminal display  Visual Voice      Improved voice recording  including recording of calls made over IP endpoints  including those using  Direct Media   automatic call recording triggered by Incoming Call Routes  pausing recording when call  is parked or placed on hold     User start points in VoiceMail Pro now include Queued and Still Queued options     Further details on some of the VoiceMail Pro functionality listed above are described later in this section   Further information on Queue Announcements can be fo
351. provides 8 analog extension ports for the connection of analog phones  The card can be fitted with  an IP500 daughter trunk card  which then uses the additional 4 RJ45 ports for trunk connections        e This card accepts one IP500 trunk daughter card of any type        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 28  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     IP500 VCM Card    This card provides voice compression channels for use with VoIP calls  SIP trunks and IP based voice  networking  The module is available in variants supporting up to 32 or 64 channels  The actual number of  channels provided is controlled by the VCM Channels licenses entered into the IP500 system configuration        Each VCM card has 4 VCM channels enabled by default  Further channels can be enabled up to the maximum   32 or 64  through adding one or more licenses  available in 4  8  16  28 and 60 channel increments      The maximum number of voice compression channels supported  using IP500 VCM base cards and   or IP400  VCM cards on IP500 Legacy Card Carriers  is 128     Please note  the maximum number of channels which may be used on each IP500 VCM card card varies  according to the codec used  as shown in the following table     Maximum VCM channels available  by codec type     EN VCM32   VCcM64    G 711 32 64  G 729 30 60  G 723 22 44    The card can be fitted with an IP500 daughter trunk card  which uses the 4 RJ45 ports for trunk connections     e This card accepts one IP500 t
352. ption    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 162  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Firewall   NAT  DNS Server   Service Quotas          Internet Access       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 163  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Remote Access Features       IP Office s integral firewall  service quotas and timebands all apply to remote access calls  Remote access  security can be supplemented by CHAP  encrypted passwords  to verify the end users  or PAP which does not  support encryption  Timebands can control the hours within which the remote access service is available     A  trusted location  can be set for dial in  These are locations that the System will allow either data access  e   g  a user dialing in from home  or access to voicemail without a voicemail code for a user collecting their  voicemail messages from a mobile  The trusted location is also the location the Voicemail Server will call to  inform the user of a new message     Conversely a  specified location  can be set which restricts remote access from only that location  this  specified location can also be a designated dial back number thereby minimizing the threat of unauthorized  remote access     IP Office systems can also incorporate remote access dial back services so that if a user always remotely  accesses the office from a single location e g  their home  then after logon verification the system will  disconnect their call and dial them back  In a
353. r 20  201  252  254  Compact Contact Center Version 254  Compact DECT 10  Compact Flash 273  Compact Mode 177  181  companies    LANs 129  company   s  IP Telephony unites 129  compared 69  Service Provider conferencing 229  Compressing  IP UDP RTP Headers 291  Compression Control Protocol 291  Computer Telephony Integration 24  194  195  Concise MIB Definitions 291  Concurrent Calls  Maximum Number 220  Condition Code 267  Conference Add 126  Conference Bridge 6  122  230  231  232  233  Conference Calling 18  125  Conference Control Display 181  Conference entry exit 232  Conference Held Calls 185  Conference ID 233  238  Conference Meet Me 126  Conference Resources 231  Conference Room 98  185  190  conferencing 18  24  25  39  55  56  58  60  82  85   86  87  101  118  174  185  190  229  230  231  233   269  benefits relating 232  Eliminating 6  manage 232  relating 232  Conferencing Center  231  233  238  239  adding 233  IP500 233  Requirements 239  Conferencing Center application 233  238  239  Conferencing Center Integration 239  Conferencing Center Reporting 233  Conferencing Center Scheduler 233  239  Conferencing Center Server PC Specification 239  Conferencing Center toolbar 174  Conferencing Center Web 233  238  239  Conferencing Center Web Client 233  238  239  launch 239  Conferencing Center Web Client offers 238    22  25  125  174  181  185        Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 322  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009 
354. r PC hardware    e Refer to Technical Specifications section of the Product Description for Operating System and  Hardware requirements    e Licensing     e Phone Manager Pro   Requires a Phone Manager Pro license for each user     e Phone Manager PC Softphone   Requires an IP Office PC SoftPhone license in addition to the Phone Manager Pro user license  There  must be equal or greater Phone Manager Pro licenses than PC SoftPhone licenses  The use of a  headset is strongly recommended  Operation through standard speakers and integral PC microphones  is possible but not recommended     e Phone Manager Pro screen popping provides integration with Microsoft Outlook 2000 2003 XP   Act  6 0 and 2005  Maximizer 7 5 and 8 0 Enterprise  Goldmine 6 0 and 6 7     e Phone Manager PC Softphone supports QoS in the form of DiffServ for both Windows XP 2000     e Phone Manager PC Softphone can be used over a wireless LAN  in this configuration no more  than 3 simultaneous calls can be supported per access point     e Up to 360 Phone Manager users can be supported on the same LAN subnet as IP Office  Where  remote subnet Phone Manager users are deployed  up to 10 remote users will receive BLF updates     e Up to 5 Phone Manager users can be supported on a single Citrix thin client server    e Instant Messaging options require the network to have a Microsoft Live Communication Server   LCS  with both a server license and client licenses for each user  Phone Manager has been verified  as compa
355. r PC hardware    e Refer to Technical Specifications section of the Product Description for Operating System and Hardware  requirements    Network  e The Voicemail PC must be configured and tested for TCP IP networking     e The Voicemail PC must have a fixed IP address     Disk Space    A compact or typical installation requires 500MB for the VoiceMail Pro software  A full installation requires up  to 2GB of disk space  However prompts and recorded messages consume an additional 1MB of disk space per  minute     e For Avaya IP Office   Small Office Edition  you can expect to require at least 200 minutes of message  recording space  that is 200MB     e For a busy environment you can expect to require at least 1 000 minutes of message recording space   that is 1GB     Web Server Operation    If web browser access to Unified Messaging Services  UMS  web service and or campaigns is required   Microsoft IIS Web Server must be installed on the Voicemail PC before VoiceMail Pro  Both applications must  run as a service  A server operating system is required for IIS     UMS Client Requirement    UMS IMAP access requires IMAP4 capable email clients such as Outlook  For voicemail web access see Web  Server Operation above    Voicemail Email Connection    Voicemail Email operation is supported using either MAPI or SMTP  MAPI requires the VoiceMail Pro server PC  to have a MAPI compliant email client install  See Voicemail Email Integration     If Text to Speech is installed  email text
356. r one CAT 5 Ethernet cable  Deploying IP telephones  utilizing Power over Ethernet eliminates the need for local power supplies  AC adapters and cables  and allows  power to be provided from the wiring closet switch room where it can be easily connected to a UPS system     There are several power options  in addition to IEEE Power over Ethernet  available to customers to power  their Avaya IP telephones     e Avaya Individual Power Supply for 4600 and 5600 phones    Avaya provides individual power supplies that can be used to power each IP phone which provides a  single 48 volt output  The power supply can operate globally within a wide range of Alternating Current   AC  input voltages  90   264 Volts Alternating Current  VAC   47 63 Hz  This power supply has a green  indicator  LED  that shows the unit has power to the PHONE socket on pins 7 amp 8 of the CAT5 cable  This  item is available in two different versions  with and without an internal battery for uninterrupted power  to the phone     Avaya individual Power Supply for 1600 series phones  The 1600 series phones have a special power connecter to allow the connection of a cost efficient power  supply  These power supplies come in several versions for different countries and voltages     Avaya Power over Ethernet adapter for the 1603 phone   The 1603 phone does not support Power over Ethernet natively  A small adapter is needed  The adapter  will fit completely in the stand of the phone  offering a cost efficient option
357. r the benefit of people who  come to their desk  There are 10 predefined strings for Absence Text              e None  no text message  e  Don t disturb until   e  On vacation until  e  With visitors until   e  Will be back  e  With cust  til    e  At lunch until  e  Back soon    e  Meeting until  e  Back tomorrow    e  Please call  e Custom    All may have additional text entered  eg message 4 plus 10 00 will show  Meeting until 10 00  and the text  strings are localized to the system language    This feature is supported across the IP Office Small Community Network       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 105  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Call Tagging    Feature  e Display a text message on the user s phone  or Phone Manager application  when a call is presented to  it     Benefit  e Provide additional information about the call     Description   This feature is used to provide additional information about the call to the targeted user before they answer it   Call Tagging may be used when transferring a call from Phone Manager or Soft Console to give caller info if the  user doing the transfer is not able to announce the call     It is possible to add a tag to a call automatically using CTI and IP Office VoiceMail Pro  This is also possible  based on an Incoming Call Route  On some telephones  displaying the Tag may mean that it is not possible to  display the usual call source and target information        Reclaim Call    Feature 
358. r the longest time     In Release 4 2 a new option has been added  Assign Call On Agent Alert  which means that CTI applications  will always correctly report the details for the call that is alerting  The previous  default  behavior is now  termed  Assign Call On Agent Answer  and ensures that the call at the head of the queue is always answered  first     If all extensions in the Hunt Group are busy or not answered  another Hunt Group  called an Overflow Group   can be used to take the calls  An overflow time can be set to stipulate how long a call will queue before being  passed to the Overflow Group  in Release 4 2 this can be configured either for individual calls or for all calls in  the group   The system can change the status of users who do not answer a hunt group call presented to  them  The user can be put into busy wrap up  busy not available or logged off  The change of status can be  set per user and the use of this option can be set per hunt group     Outside normal operation a hunt group can be put into two special modes  Night Service and Out of service     In Night Service calls are presented to a Night Service Group  This can be controlled automatically by setting a  time profile which defines the hours of operation of the main group or manually using a handset feature code     Night service fallback using a time profile is no longer applied to a hunt group already set to Out of Service     The Out of Service mode is controlled manually from a handset  Whil
359. rage Answer Time     OY   4  x  Average Wait Time       7      x   Busy Not Available   OY          Calls Waiting       7y      7  Current Wait rime     7        Grade of Service     OY       x  Internal Made       7          Longest Wait Time   7         Lost Cas   y   y J  i    Outbound Calls  External         4   lt   Overflowed Answered   OY      x  Overflowed Calls   7y      x    sss    LA ES    5       s    GISI    Overflowed Calls Waiting   OY        Z    lt     gt 1 99  Overflowed Lost M            lt    Z     gt 1 99    QS    7   ia  Queue State Time   7          OoOo M   7 UE  bonne     7 Ci  Transferred SSC    LA LS LAS LAS       Alarm  Int    Type From             None     None     gt 1 999   gt 1 999   7    wo     gt 1 600 21   gt 1 999   gt 1 999     gt 1 999       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     IP Office 4 2    Page 251  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Compact Contact Center       IP Office Compact Contact Center is a modular contact center solution catering for all contact center sizes from  2 to 75 agents  The following modules are available as part of the CCC software application     Compact Call Center  CCC  Server   Base System   Provides one supervisor position with real time information view  management by exception  and  historical reports for any aspect of the contact center  Up to 73 standard reports can viewed or printed   Also included are reporting capabilities on 5 agents and one license for a PC Wallboard  PCWB   appli
360. rd Carrier   e 1 x PRI 60 E1 trunk card    e 1 x Region specific power cord    e 1 x IP500 VCM 64 card  4 channels enabled by default     e 1 x IP500 VCM 60 channel license   e 60 x 5610 IP phones    e 1 x IP500 Feature Key A Law   e 1 x IP400 Phone Manager Pro RFA 50    e 1 x IP400 Phone Manager Pro RFA 10    e 1 x IP400 Phone Manager PC SoftPhone RFA 50    e 1 x IP400 Phone Manager PC SoftPhone RFA 10    Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 278    IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        IP412    Scenario 1     A US business requiring 180 display phones and 96 digital trunks with 20 analog lines for fallback purposes   This configuration uses a IP412 providing 180 extensions and 96 digital trunks  4 x T1  and two IP400 Analog  Trunk 16 modules offering capacity of up to 32 analog trunk lines   With the addition of a single Dual PRI T1  interface  the system is fitted with an extra trunk card in its spare slot to provide the additional 48 lines     Kit List  e 1 x IP412 control unit   e 9 x Region specific power cords   e 2 x PRI 48 Ti trunk cards   e 6 X IP400 Digital Station 30 external expansion modules   e 2 x IP400 Analog Trunk 16 external expansion modules     e 180 x Avaya 5410 digital phones     Scenario 2     A Business moving to a pure IP Telephony solution with 90 IP hardphones  90 IP softphones and 60 external  trunk lines for its main location and the ability to network with other sites using IP trunking    This configuration uses an
361. repeaters 69  TPAD 169  Traditional Wall Mounted Wallboards 258  Transaction Packet Assembler Dissembler 169  Transfer call 10  185  254  operator 220  Transfer Call Tracking Detail 254  Transmission Control Protocol 291  transmission reception 143  Transmit Power 100mw 75  Transport Layer Security 10  TransTalk 9040 10  46  Tray 174  185  191  Tray working 191  Tree International  Learning 254  tri color 258  trigger control 125  Trivial File Transfer Protocol 291  Trunk Access Code  Incoming 267  Trunk Cards 27  30  34  278  279  Trunk Details 253  Trunk Group Activity 254  Trunk Group Busy 254  Trunk Group Call Duration 254  Trunk Group Details 253  Trunk Group Monitor 253  Trunk Group Response 254  Trunk Group Summary 254  Trunk Interface Cards 32  34  273  Trunk Interfaces 18  21  32  34  273  trunk lines 112  278  279  trunk providing 30  Trunk Related Screens 253  trunk extension 30  trunk VolP 231  trunkinterfacecards htm 34  Trunks back 21  trunks VoIP 232  TTS 207  adds 211  TTS Licensing 211  TTY 201  TTY hearing 201  TUI 198  201  213  214  215  Tunneling Protocol 170 291    Twinning  Appearance Keys 10  two base station 69   U   UK 201  211  UK20 290  unencrypted 167  Uni 27 273  Unique computer generated 233  Unique computer generated Conference ID 233  Unique PIN 233  238  unique PIN numbers 233  238  United Kingdom 277  Universal PRI 10  30  Unlike circuit switched 129  unmaps 168  Un Mute All 238  Unpark 126  282  Unpark Call 126  Unread  User 185  unsecured 
362. ression standards  including the most popular G 723 1 and G 729a  These will occupy approximately 10K  and 13K of bandwidth respectively     Use the following chart to choose the most appropriate compression algorithm for your available bandwidth        Audio Codec RTP Voice Packets LAN   Overhead   Overhead  Algorithmi  Data Payload per  bps  LAN c Delay  Second  milli   seconds   G 723 1 24 Bytes 33 33 20 800 225  9 867 54  80  G 729a 20 Bytes 50 29 600 270  13 200 65  40  G 711  64K  160 Bytes 50 85 600 34  69 200 8  20       Acceptable Delay     End to end delay should be 150 milliseconds or below        How Many Simultaneous Calls Can I Get Down My Link     The following chart illustrates the theoretical maximum number of simultaneous voice calls that can be  delivered over a WAN for a given link speed  This does not take into account any bandwidth that may be  required for data traffic between sites or the physical limit of VoIP calls for the specific version of IP Office in  use     The number of simultaneous voice calls can be in excess of the capabilities of the individual platform  where  the calls transit the switch as data traffic  In this situation compression resources are not used but obviously  must be catered for in the overall bandwidth provision     G 723 1  6K3  G 729a  8K  G 711  64K     Algorithmic Delay        seconds      64Kbps Link 0    128Kbps Link 5 5 1    256Kbps Link 25 19 3    512Kbps Link 51 38 7    1Mbps Link 103 77 14    2Mbps Link 207 155 29
363. rface 273  ISDN PRI 120  ITAddress 282  ITU T Recommendation E 164 291  IVR 6  20  201  210  220  providing 211  Tis E  Japanese 201  211  joined left 233  Juniper 84   K   Kbps 153  LAN 137  Point 137  Kentrox 84  Key Management Protocol 291  Key System 129  Keyboard Actions 190  Keyboard Mapping 190  Kit List 278  279  Pay lea  L2TP  Securing 291  Lamp Operation 112  Language 80  81  105  119  196  198  200  201   207  209  211  262  language depending 198  Lanyard 72 78  Last Number Redial 91  126  last in first out 10  Latin 201 211  Latin American 201  Latvia 277  launch 269  Conferencing Center Web Client 239  Layer Two 291  Layer Two Tunneling Protocol 291  LCD 82 91  104    LCP 167  291  LCR 158  Existing 115    LCS 174  181  182  LDAP 19  119  169  leading  email 206  Learning  Tree International 254    Leased Line 19  142  162  165  166  types 165   Leased Line Support 165   Least Cost 114  115  122  141  Existing 158   Least Cost Routes 114  122   Least Cost Routing 115  Existing 158   LED 10  64  65  66  91  133   Legacy Card Carrier 10  25  30    License Key 22  170  195  200  207  210  258  278   279    License csv 262  LIFO 10  LIFO FIFO 10  220  Lightweight Directory Access Protocol 119  Link Control Protocol 167  291  Linked Numbering 159  Linked Numbering Scheme 159  Listen Only 10  238  Lite 20  177  181  198  Lithium lon Battery 78  Lithuania 277  LLB 30  34  143  Local Area Network 129  132  162  165  169  196  Local End Echo Cancellation 25ms 138  Local 
364. rights reserved     Page 326  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       Fax 10  22  39  132  138  155  174  200  206  207   220    routing 201   fax calls 132  137   Fax Messages 206  207   Fax Relay 138   Fax Transport 132   Faxination 206   FaxMail Pro 206   FCC 75  78  290   Feature Flag 267   Feature Key 22  25  32  56  69  273   Feature Licensing 22   FEATURE NAME 262   Feature Support 220   Feature Table 90   Fenestrae 206   Fenestrae Faxination Server  Microsoft Exchange 206   Field Data 284   FIFO 10   File Transfer Protocol  including 168   Finland 277   Finnish 80  81  201   firewall 19  24  150  162  164  168  232  Small Office Edition offers 165   firewall VPN 6   firewalled 162   firewalled Layer 162    firewalls 168  169  first in first out 10  Firstly   TTS 207    Fixed Feature Buttons 55  56  58  60  64  65  66  Fixed Feature Keys 85  86  87  Fixed Wallboards 252  Flash Hook 126  Flash Memory 200  Flow Control 56  58  60  64  65  66  138  Follow Me 110  116  117  126  201  212  283  Follow Me Here 126  For integrating 254  For report 254  Force login 283  Forced Account Code  set 114  Forward All 118  196  Forward All Calls 196  Forward Busy 116  Forward Emails  External Systems 220  Forward Hunt Group 116  126  283  Forward Hunt Group Calls Off 126  Forward Hunt Group Calls On 126    Forward Message 220    Forward No Answer 116  123  Forward Number 126  283  Forward on Busy 113  116  117  126  196  283    Forward On Busy Number 126  283  Forward On Busy Off 1
365. rol 138   IP PBX 129   IP Phone Adapter 133   IP Phone Power Adapter 133   IP Phones 24  25  56  58  60  119  123  131  133  IP Power 133   IP Security Document Roadmap 291   IP Service 162   IP Softphone 180   IP Telephone Power Consumption 133   IP400 3rd PRTY IVR RFA 210   IP400 Access Point RFA 273   IP400 Analog 16 21   IP400 Analog Trunk 16 21  39  43  278  279    101  119    IP400 Analog Trunk 16 Module 39  43  IP400 BRI Card 34   IP400 BRI 8 273   IP400 Digital Station 40  42   IP400 Digital Station V2 Module 40  42    IP400 Dual E1R2 34   IP400 Dual PRIE1 34  273  IP400 Dual PRI T1 34  273  IP400 E1R2 34   IP400 Internal Modem Card 36  IP400 Modem 12 273   IP400 Modems 273   IP400 Phone 41  103  278  279    IP400 Phone Manager PC SoftPhone RFA 10 278   279   IP412 10  19  21  24  25  32  34  36  37  67  125   132  137  162  165  198  220  231  273  279  287   290    IP412 Control Units 32  273  279  287  IP412 Maximum Heat Dissipation 287  IP412 Office A Law Base Unit 273  IP412 Office Mu Law Base Unit 273  IP412 PRI60E1 279   IP412 providing 273 279    IP412 Supports Two 64 party Conference Banks  231  IP500 19  20  21  22  24  27  34  36  37  39  40  67   85  86  87  88  125  132  137  143  153  162  165   198  201  220  231  273  278  287  290   Conferencing Center 233   default 25   Embedded Voicemail 10    existing 30  feel 10  require 10    voicemail 200  IP500 Analog Phone 30  IP500 Analog Trunk 16 10  37  39  IP500 Analog Trunk 16 Expansion Module 37  IP500 A
366. roportion of call control     Analog telephones that are compatible with caller display functionality can display the telephone number of the  calling party if available  Simple programming of IP Office can convert that numeric display in to the company  name associated with that number     Feature activation by analog telephones is via short codes  IP Office is pre programmed with a default set of  short codes but these can be changed to mimic a legacy telephone system as required     Avaya would like to stress that although most analog phones will work on IP Office   Avaya cannot guarantee  that all analog phones in every region of the world will work on the IP Office     e Analog phones connect to IP Office via ports marked PHONE ports        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 89  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Avaya 6200 Analog Telephone  North America     The 6200 range of telephones are single line analog phones that require one tip and ring pair for operation   This series of telephones have a Ringer volume control on the side of the telephone and a Handset volume  control on the front of the phone  They use DTMF dialing only and support the Positive Disconnect function  In  addition  these phones have a Message light  a recall button that allows access to system features  a redial  button that allows automatic redial  a hold button with a single associated light  and a data jack on the rear of  the telephone  The 6219 phone adds 1
367. rough its integral DHCP Server  IP Office can be configured to  hold a pool of IP addresses for users on the Local Area Network  When a user powers up their PC  the system  will allocate them an IP address for the duration of their session  The DHCP server also provides the user s PC  with the address of the Domain Name Service  DNS  server and the Windows Name Service  WINS  server   Alternatively  for customers who have a separate DHCP Server  IP Office can be configured to obtain its  address from that DHCP server or be set with its own static IP address  Both IP Office   Small Office Edition  and IP412 have two independent DHCP servers  one dedicated to each of the Layer 3 switched LANs        Leased Line Support    All IP Office systems are capable of connecting to leased line services     On IP400 systems X 21  V 35 and V 24 are supported via the WAN port on the back of the control unit  The  X 21  V35 and V24 are externally clocked and can operate at any speed up to and including 2M  Additional  WAN ports can be added using the WAN3 10 100 external expansion module  For the Small Office Edition an  optional WAN port card can be added  This type of WAN connection is not supported on IP500 systems     On all systems including IP500  WAN services are supported over E1 T1 PRI trunks and BRI trunks  E1 T1  trunks can be configured to operate in a fractional mode for    point to multi point    applications i e  a single 2M  interface could be treated as 3 x 512K and 8 x 64K 
368. rough the IP Office configuration the ports can be switched between  supporting E1  E1R2 or T1 line types as required for the trunk being connected  Each port supports 8 B   channels which do not need to be licensed  If additional B channels are required  they must be licensed  through the addition of the licenses below  Multiple licenses can be added to achieve the total number of  channels required  D channels are not subject to licensing  The licenses are consumed by those channels  which are configured as being    in service     in order of the installed IP500 PRI U cards   e IP500 Universal PRI Additional E1 Channels Licenses  These licenses are used to enable additional E1 B channels for IP500 PRI U cards configured for E1  operation  Each port can support up to 30 B channels in this mode   e   IP500 Universal PRI Additional Channels   2 E1 Channels License  IPO LIC IP500 E1 ADD  2CH  215183   e   IP500 Universal PRI Additional Channels   8 E1 Channels License  IPO LIC IP500 E1 ADD  8CH  215184   e   IP500 Universal PRI Additional Channels   32 E1 Channels License  IPO LIC IP500 E1  ADD 22CH  215185     e IP500 Universal PRI Additional E1R2 Channel Licenses  These licenses are used to enable additional E1R2 B channels for IP500 PRI U cards configured for  E1R2 operation  Each port can support up to 30 B channels in this mode   e   IP500 Universal PRI Additional Channels   2 E1R2 Channels License  IPO LIC IP500 E1R2  ADD 2CH  215186   e   IP500 Universal PRI Additional C
369. rovide only limited  mechanism for differentiating audio packets from data packets  It also delivers quality of service by limiting  the number of phones that are connected to one access point in order to avoid quality problems  In addition  AVPP ensures that the phone can run in energy efficient mode when not in use  The following AVPPs are  available to meet customer needs     e AVPP100  Serves 80 calls simultaneously   e AVPP020  Serves 20 powered on handsets   e AVPP010  Serves 10 powered on handsets     Wireless Access Points    When using the Avaya Wireless IP solution  customers can utilize wireless access points from various vendors   The list of compatible wireless access points is large and constantly growing  Please visit http   www   spectralink com consumer support index jsp and select    WLAN Compatibility List    for the latest information        Benefits    e Supports the 802 11b or 802 11 a b g standard for Wi Fi networks converging voice and data over a  single network     e Seamless integration with IP Office   e Excellent voice quality on converged wireless networks   e Lightweight  durable handsets specifically designed for workplace use   e Improved display  battery life  processor power all with lower costs   e Increased range of AVPP s to address the needs of diverse construct sizes   e Multitude of accessories are available   e Dual Charger  full charge accomplished in approximately one and a half hours    e Quick Charger  full charge accomplished in 
370. rovides the last x digits of the dialed number on an  incoming call  This allows IP Office to route the call to different users or services     e Sub addressing Allows the transmission reception of up to 20 digits  additional to any DDI DID or CLIP  information  for call routing and identification purposes     ISDN Basic Rate  ETSI CTR3   Provided by the IP400 Quad BRI and IP500 BRI cards     ISDN Basic rate provides 2 x 64K PCM speech channels and one signaling channel using Q 931 signaling and  CRC error checking  Both point to point and point to multipoint operation is supported  Multipoint lines allow  multiple devices to share the same line  however point to point is the preferred mode     Basic rate supports all the services that are supported on the primary rate version with the addition of    e Multiple Subscriber Number  This service is usually mutually exclusive with the DDI DID service and  provides up to 10 numbers for routing purposes  very similar to DDI DID        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 143  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Additional ISDN features    The following ISDN features are supported by IP Office 4 0  on both PRI and BRI trunks  Note that availability  of these features is dependant on their also being supported and available from the ISDN service provider  for  which there may be charges     e Malicious Call Identification   MCID   24xx  46xx  54xx  56xx  T3  T3 IP  DECT phones  Phone Manager   Short cod
371. runk daughter card of any type     IP500 Legacy Card Carrier    This card allows a variety of IP400 trunk and VCM cards to be used with the IP500 control unit  The front of  the card includes a number of panels that can be snapped off to match the ports available when an IP400  trunk card is fitted        e This card does not accept any IP500 daughter trunk cards     e The IP500 control unit can accept up to 2 IP400 trunk or VCM cards by mounting each card on an IP500  Legacy Card Carrier    e This card supports the following IP400 cards        e  lt    PRITI e   Dual PRI E1R2 RJ45 e  VCM8  e   Dual PRI T1 e    ANLG 4 Uni e   VCM 16  e   PRI 30 E1  1 4  e    BRI 8  UNI  e  VCM 24  e   Dual PRI El e   VCM 4 e    VCM 30  e   PRI 30 E1R2 RJ45  Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 29    IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        IP500 Trunk Cards    IP500 daughter trunk cards can be fitted to existing IP500 base cards to provide support for trunk ports  The  daughter card uses the ports provided on the base card for cable connection  The addition of an IP500  daughter trunk card is supported on IP500 Digital Station  IP500 Analog Phone and IP500 VCM base cards   They are not supported on the IP500 Legacy Card Carrier base card           For those base cards that support daughter cards  there are no restrictions on the combination of card types   However in systems with both Analog Phone 8 base cards and analog trunk daughter cards  combining the two  ty
372. s     What Advantage Does IP Office Have     IP Office can provide support of PSTN  POTs  digital time division multiplexed phones AND digital IP phones all  on the same system  This means you don   t have to abandon the past to embrace the future  IP Office allows  all the technologies to co exist  IP Office connects to the PSTN and to IP trunks  the VoIP equivalent  so  providing a    Hybrid    PBX function   where both legacy and future technologies can be used together to  minimize operating costs and offer optimize business communications through both voice and data     IP Office has digital telephones built on both TDM and IP technology that provide the same user interface  offering a flexible choice of solution that can mix  for example TDM phones in the office and IP phones at a  remote site of at home  With the choice of IP phones including real and virtual  software  phones  IP Office can  take communications to a new level     Buying IP Office allows you choice   you can use the pure POTs or the pure VoIP capabilities of IP Office  or  use both at the same time to allow seamless technology transition of your business without the disruption of  having to choose between them now        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 129  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     IP Office Turns VoIP into IP Telephony    In order to make use of VoIP  IP Office uses signaling protocols called H 323 right now  and Session Initiation  Protocol  SIP  which a
373. s   e Opportunity Activity and Notes   e Contact Activity and Notes   e Account Activity and Notes   e Contact Center Summary by State Province   e Contact Center Summary by Zip Code Postal Code  e Microsoft CRM Service Reports   e Account Activity and Notes    e Account Service Report       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 257  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Wallboard Server Client    Wallboard Manager    Two types of wallboards are available   traditional wall mounted units and PC based wallboards on the agent s  PC desktop  Both types of wallboards are managed from Wallboard Manager Wallboard Server     Wall Mounted Wallboards are not available in all territories  please check with your Avaya representative for  more information     Additional wallboard clients may be added and distributed across the LAN allowing additional supervisors  access to create and schedule wallboard messages     Traditional Wall Mounted Wallboards    CCC supports two physical wallboards  also known as reader boards or display boards   Spectrum  model  3214C  previously known as the 4120C  and the CCM WB 22  Both wallboards are 22 characters  tri color  and  two line unit each  Up to 16 wallboards may be driven from the wallboard server  The Spectrum wallboard   when purchased as a Master Kit  will provide a communications module for use with the boards which are  connected serialy  For those using the Wallboard 22  the communications card is shipped with
374. s  4 x T1  and two IP400 Analog  Trunk 16 modules offering capacity of up to 32 analog trunk lines    Kit List   e 1 x IP500 control unit    e 1 x IP500 Feature Key   e 1 x IP Office Standard Edition upgrade to Professional Edition license   e 9 x Region specific power cords    e 2 x IP500 Digital Station 8 cards   e 2 x IP500 Legacy Card Carriers   e 2 x PRI 48 Ti trunk cards    e 6 X IP400 Digital Station 30 external expansion modules    e 2 x IP400 Analog Trunk 16 external expansion modules    e 190 x Avaya 5410 digital phones   Scenario 2   A Business moving to a pure IP Telephony solution with 90 IP hardphones  90 IP softphones and 60 external  trunk lines for its main location and the ability to network with other sites using IP trunking   This configuration uses an IP500 fitted with a 64 channel Voice Compression Module  VCM   This card allows  up to 64 simultaneous calls to external parties  IP extension calling a non IP telephone or line   For IP to IP  calls  VCM resources are only required for initial call set up  Depending on the typical utilization of external  trunks  a lower capacity VCM variant could be employed  as appropriate   The IP Office softphone is  Phone Manager Pro PC Softphone    which is an enhanced version of the standard  Phone Manager Pro application enabled for each user using two License Keys as listed below   Kit List   e 1 x IP500 control unit    e 1 x IP Office Standard Edition upgrade to Professional Edition license   e 1 x IP500 Legacy Ca
375. s available to the operator to personalize the look and feel  The  Operator can tailor the usability specifically to each their personal preferences  The following configuration  options are available     e Incoming Calls  This tab enables the operator to manage the local SoftConsole directory by creating  editing and  deleting entries from the selected directory  Also the operator is able to associate a script or media file  with each specific entry     e Queue Mode  This tab enables the operator to configure the queue window with up to 8 hunt group queues  which will  include a recall queue  Queues can be created  edited and deleted while also providing the operator with  the additional benefit of positioning them in the queue window in order of operator preference   Management by exception is used to monitor queue status by enabling the operator to set up various  alarm thresholds such as the Number of calls in queue and Longest waiting call time  A WAV media file  can be associated with an alarm for further customization     e Park Slots  This tab enables the operator to define which park slots are accessible on a system wide basis up to a  maximum of 16  The operator is also able to assign which numbers are used to access each park slot  and where the slot appears in the park slot panel     e BLF Groups  This tab allows the operator to create and edit BLF groups     e Door Entry  This tab allows the operator to configure up to two door entries     e Directories  This tab
376. s billing convenience and potential cost savings for remote workers and mobile work  force as all the calls are established by IP Office  there is no need to check bills  nor to pay for expensive hotel  calls        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 109  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Twinning and Mobility    Twinning allows a primary extension and a secondary number  extension or external  to operate together as a  single telephone  When a call is presented to the primary phone the secondary will ring  If the primary  telephone does not ring  for example in Do Not Disturb  the secondary phone will not ring     Internal Twinning   This is typically used in scenarios like workshops or warehouses where team supervisors may have a desk with  a fixed phone but also have a wireless extension  e g  DECT   When a call is made from either twinned phone   the call will appear to have come from the primary phone  when the secondary is an extension on the IP Office  system   Other users of the system need not know that the supervisor has two different phones  The  supervisor   s Coverage Timer and No Answer Time are started for the call and if the call is not answered within  that time  the call will be delivered to available coverage buttons  if applicable  and then Voicemail  if  applicable      Mobile  external  Twinning   A typical use for Mobile Twinning would be for a salesperson who has a desk extension but is often out of the  office  Th
377. s if the user dialed the digits     Trunk Impedance Detection  North America only   IP Office 4 2 includes a utility to test the impedance of analog trunks and propose appropriate gain settings   This could be useful if echo or noise problems are encountered on the line     IP trunk fall back through ARS   A new Response Timeout option has been added to the IP Line  SIP Line and SES Line forms within IP Office  4 2 Manager to configure the timeout after which the line is considered unreachable  This enables fallback to  an alternative trunk within Alternate Route Selection  ARS  within a reasonable time     User Log Out Rule Change   In IP Office 4 2 facilitates the moving of users from one extension to another by allowing users to log out from  their old extension  which will automatically result in their being logged in at the new extension  providing the  new configuration has previously been merged      IP Office XML Configuration Service  IP Office 4 2 introduces a backend configuration service component that runs on a Microsoft Server  to provide  configuration services that can be accessed through a 3rd Party application via an XML interface  It enables     e Secure configuration access to supported IP Office 4 2 platforms  e Retrieval of configuration data from the IP Office using secure TCP connection    e Exposure of configuration services via a web Service interface to obtain an XML representation of the  configuration elements   this is limited to some User teleph
378. s in John s Answered  Answered Calls For Sales State   Incoming calls    John s Ov    5  Dick the sight mouse button to view the popup mersa   Connected   Agent 4680 S100 165654    PC Wallboard Example       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 258  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Queuing Announcements    VoiceMail Pro provides system wide messages and announcements programmed by VoiceMail Pro call flows   Through call flows it is possible tailor the pre connection call experience that a customer receives when calling  in  By using the functionality provided by Voicemail Pro s call in queue announcements  supervisors may create  sophisticated queue and call routing plans with access to a host of features such as message taking  interview  services  and the ability to play estimated time to answer or queue position information to customers     The VoiceMail Pro application provides Queue Handling facilities  allowing incoming Hunt Group calls to be  answered when department  group or individual telephones are busy  Customers entering a queue are played  a message informing them of the situation and then hear hold music  internally generated or from an external  source   while being regularly updated  Two unique messages may be recorded for each Hunt Group  queue  entry and queue update message   Queue announcements can also provide time in system  time in queue   position in queue and estimated time to answer to the caller  It always gives
379. s only supported on systems with an IP500 Upgrade  Standard to Professional license  see above     e Voicemail Pro can be used to support voicemail services to multiple IP Offices when they are connected  in an IP Office Small Community Network  SCN   In this scenario only the Voicemail Pro hosting the  voicemail server requires a Voicemail Pro license  The other IP Offices within the network do not require  a Voicemail Pro license  However if any of the other IP Offices is an IP500 system  each of those  requires an IP500 Upgrade to Professional License     e Additional Voicemail Pro Ports Licenses   The Voicemail Pro license includes support for 4 voicemail ports  The total number of voicemail ports  supported can be increased by adding combinations of the following licenses  up to the maximum  supported by the particular IP Office control unit  Small Office Edition   10  IP406 V2   20  IP412    30  IP500   30     e   Additional Voicemail Pro  2 Ports   IPO LIC IP400 VM PRO RFA 2 LIC CU  174459    e   Additional Voicemail Pro  4 Ports   IPO LIC IP400 VM PRO RFA 4 LIC CU  174460    e   Additional Voicemail Pro  8 Ports   IPO LIC IP400 VM PRO RFA 8 LIC CU  174461    e   Additional Voicemail Pro  16 Ports   IPO LIC IP400 VM PRO RFA 16 LIC CU  174462     e Voicemail Pro Feature Licenses  The following licenses enable specific Voicemail Pro features  These licenses all require the base  Voicemail Pro license  and for IP500 systems a IP500 Upgrade to Pro license  as a pre requisi
380. s to wait against a hunt group     While queuing  if Voicemail is operational  the caller will be played the announcements for this Hunt Group        Announcements    From IP Office 4 0 onwards  Hunt group announcements are separated from hunt group queuing and can be  used even when queuing is off  Hunt group announcements are now supported by Embedded Voicemail in  addition to VoiceMail Pro and VoiceMail Lite     Further  times for the first announcement  second announcement  and between repeated announcements are  configurable        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 122  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Contact Center Features       Contact Centers have specific needs for reporting on how calls are handled and these are covered in a  separate section of the Product Description  Basic handling of telephony requirements for a Call Center is a  standard part of IP Office from Automatic Call Distribution  ACD  and Call Queuing to agents logging on and  selecting the groups that they service        Login    A contact center agent function  login is required before the agent is able to make or receive calls from their  phone  A login idle period can be specified which will dictate how long an extension can be idle before the user  is automatically logged off  ensuring that an extension is not left logged in and calls go unanswered        Monitor Calls    A user can monitor other peoples    calls by listening in  This feature is not availa
381. ser   Call Queue   Call Record   Call Steal   Call Waiting On   Call Waiting Off   Call Waiting Suspend  Cancel All Forwarding  Cancel Ring Back When  Free   Channel Monitor  Clear Call   Clear CW   Clear Hunt Group Night  Service   Clear Hunt Group Out Of  Service   Clear Quota  Conference Add  Conference Meet Me  CW   Dial    Dial 3K1   Dial 56K   Dial 64K   Dial CW   Dial Direct   Dial Direct Hot Line   Dial Emergency   Dial Extn   Dial Inclusion   Dial Paging  DialPhysicalExtensionByNu  mber  DialPhysicalNumberByID  Dial Speech   Dial V110   Dial V120   Dial Video   Disable ARS Form  Disable Internal Forwards  Disable Internal Forward  Unconditional   Disable Internal Forward  Busy or No Answer  Display Msg   Do Not Disturb Exception  Add   Do Not Disturb Exception  Delete   Do Not Disturb On   Do Not Disturb Off  Enable ARS Form   Enable Internal Forwards  Enable Internal Forward  Unconditional   Enable Internal Forward  Busy or No Answer   Extn Login   Extn Logout   Flash Hook    Follow Me Here   Follow Me Here Cancel  Follow Me To   Forward Hunt Group Calls  On   Forward Hunt Group Calls  Off   Forward Number   Forward On Busy Number  Forward On Busy On  Forward On Busy Off  Forward On No Answer On  Forward On No Answer Off  Forward Unconditional On  Forward Unconditional Off  Group Listen Off   Group Listen On   Headset Toggle   Hold Call   Hold CW   Hold Music   Hunt Group Disable   Hunt Group Enable   Last Number Redial   MCID Activate   Mobile Twinned Call Pickup  
382. served  Page 38  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        IP500 Analog Trunk 16 Module    This expansion module provides an additional sixteen Loop Start or Ground Start two wire analog trunks    Ground start trunks are not available in all territories  The first two trunks on the module which are    automatically switched to power fail sockets on the rear of the unit in the event of power being interrupted  must be loop start for correct power fail operation     For installations in a rack  this module requires the IP500 Rack Mounting Kit  The IP500 Analog Trunk 16  Module is functionally identical to the IP400 Analog Trunk 16 Module     IP Office 500    Analog Trunk    PFi PF2 EXPANSION    LE          IP500 BRI So8 Module    The IP500 BRI So8 module provides 8 S Bus interfaces for Basic Rate ISDN devices  such as video  conferencing  fax servers or ISDN telephones     For installations in a rack  this module requires the IP500 Rack Mounting Kit  The IP500 BRI So8 Module is  functionally identical to the IP400 So8 Module     IP Office 500 BRI Sod    EXPANSION    a    ter       The IP500 BRI So8 expansion module supports both point to point and point to multipoint connections  A  maximum of 10 terminal endpoints identifiers  TEIs  are supported on each bus        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 39  IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        IP500 Digital Station Module    This expansion module provides additional Digital Station  DS
383. siness communication tool  Internet access is becoming  increasingly important for business to business communications  The ability to send and receive email  is now  considered mandatory when dealing with many suppliers and customers  while access to the Internet for e   commerce applications and information has become vital     IP Office systems provide shared  secure  high speed access to the Internet via exchange lines  Central  Office   digital leased line or IP VPN services     Internet security concerns are addressed through the provision of an integrated firewall so removing the need  for a standalone firewall  The firewall can be configured to cater for a variety of situations and will allow  customers to control who can access external resources and when  The firewall isolates your private networks  from the Internet  thereby ensuring that your network remains beyond the reach of hackers  while  configurable service quotas can be set against a remote access service to ensure authorized users can gain  access  Service Quotas place a time limit on outgoing calls to a particular IP Service so limiting costs  Each  service can be configured with an alternative fall back  for example  you may wish to connect to your ISP  during working hours and at other times take advantage of varying call charges from an alternative ISP  You  could  therefore  set up one service to connect during peak times and another to act as fallback during the  cheaper period        Product Descri
384. sing    TTS is an optional licensed component of VoiceMail Pro  and adds a TTS resource pool for VoiceMail Pro to use  and release as required  TTS licenses are independent of VoiceMail Pro licenses  If a system integrator wants  to use a different TTS language set from those supplied by Avaya this can be done by using the 3rd party TTS  license instead of the Avaya language TTS  Both license types are based on a concurrent usage model       Visual Basic  VB  Scripting       The VoiceMail Pro call flow programming interface has been extended to allow an administrator to provide  Visual Basic  VB  scripted logic that can be interpreted by the VoiceMail Pro server  This ability allows system  administrators to program the voice system via VB Scripts thus providing additional choice and flexibility in  providing IVR applications  The VB script action contains a VB Scripting parser  Syntax checker  to ensure the  legitimacy of the administrator derived VB Script before it s incorporation  Each VB script action used within a  call flow can contain a maximum of 10 000 characters  however a call flow may contain multiple VB script  actions within it     VB Scripting on IP Office VoiceMail Pro is an optional licensed component        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 211  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Personal Numbering       Contact ability is all important in winning and maintaining business  VoiceMail Pro offers users the ability to  remo
385. sional  2000  Professional can be used but would  typically support a maximum of 10 web    The Delta Server and CBC can be installed  on either the same PC or on separate PC s     clock speed  In both cases these are the minimum PC    specifications        Product Description  IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 293  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Client Applications Dependencies    een   Min PC Intel Intel AMD  preston  Resources Pentium  Celeron       Conferencing __ Internet  Web Client Explorer 6  or above    Phone Manager   Manager A sound card is needed if audio features    are required     SoftConsole i A maximum of four SoftConsole  applications can be run per system  a    simultaneous SoftConsole users   A    sound card is needed if audio features are  required     ContactStore Internet ANY ANY ANY Any desktop machine can be used as long  Web client Explorer 5 as it is capable of running IE5   or above  ane a Lu    1Ghz Requires Java Virtual Machine 1 4 2 or  later  Each SSA session takes about 35M of  RAM     Contact Center For OS of Windows XP  minimum RAM  View  CCV  increases to 256MB    CCC Reporter Internet  Explorer 6  or above  The Wallboard Server MUST reside on the    same PC as the Delta Server    For OS of Windows XP  minimum RAM  increases to 256MB    For OS of Windows XP  minimum RAM  increases to 256MB       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 294  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Windows Operat
386. sking 10  108  Desktop PC Telephony Controls 174  DevConnect 196  Developer Connection Program 196  Developer Edition 254  DeveloperConnect 196  Developers 194  195  196  254  283  284  Development Solutions 254  DevLink 195  284  DevLink Lite 195  DevLink Pro 195  DevLink Reserved Fields 284  DHCP 19  75  78  137  165  169  232  291  DHCP Server 165  169  232    Dial3K1 126  Dial 56K 126  Dial 64K 126  Dial calls 110  114  Dial CW 126    Dial Direct 126   Dial Direct Hot Line 126  Dial Emergency 114  126  Dial Extn 126   Dial Inclusion 126   Dial On Pickup 125   Dial Pad 185  190   Dial Paging 126    Dial Plan 107  Dial Speech 126  Dial V110 126  Dial V120 126  Dial Video 126  dial BLF 177    Dialed Number 101  103  115  143  177  218  267  controlling 118   Dialed Number Identification String 143   dial in dial out to from 164   Dialing In 32  135  143  164  169  238   dialing plan 107  141   DialPhysicalExtensionByNumber 126   DialPhysicalNumberByID 126   Dial Up Circuit Support 165   DID 103  143   DID DDI 143 177   Differentiated Services Field 291   Diffserve 150   Digital Station 16 Module V2 273   Digital Station 30 273   Digital Station 30 Module V2 273    Digital Station Expansion Module 40  42  85  86   87  88    Digital Telephones 22  71  82  Digital Wireless 3810 Telephone 82  Digital Wireless North American 68  Dimensions 80  287  Direct Dialing 100  110  209  Direct Dialing In 143  Direct Inward Dialing 103  Direct Media 63  132  135  201  Direct Media Path 132
387. speed wide area network links        Bandwidth Allocation Control Protocol  BACP     Bandwidth Allocation Control Protocol allows the negotiation with the remote end of the data call to request  additional calls to be made to improve aggregate data throughput        Callback    Three types of call back are supported    e LCP  Link Control Protocol   After authentication the incoming call is dropped and an outgoing call is made to a predefined number to  re establish the link     e Callback CP  Microsoft s Callback Control Protocol   After authentication from both ends  the incoming call is dropped and an outgoing call to a predefined  number made to re establish the link     e Extended CBCP  Extended Callback Control Protocol   Similar to Callback CP however  the Microsoft application at the remote end will prompt for a telephone  number  An outgoing call will then be made to that number to re establish the link        Domain Name Service  DNS  Proxy    Domain Name Service servers provide the translation of names such as www avaya com to the domain   s IP  address required to establish a connection  IP Office provides this service to PCs on the network by proxy        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 167  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Network Address Translation  NAT     Network Address Translation is a mechanism that allows you to use different IP address on your private  network behind a router with a public IP Address  When conne
388. ss to a total of 48 line feature keys or speed dial buttons  This will satisfy the needs of  even the most demanding secretary or receptionist  Each of the buttons features a dual LED  red  green   providing explicit status for the user  For a familiar look and feel  the 1616 includes several fixed feature keys  for common telephone tasks including conference  transfer  drop  hold  and mute  In addition  the 1616  includes a high quality two way speakerphone  and supports a broad portfolio of Avaya wired and wireless  headsets through its integrated headset jack     The 1616 features a context sensitive user interface along with three softkeys and a four way navigation  cluster   ideal for scrolling through the local contacts list or call logs  The display on the 1616 measures four  lines by 24 characters and is adjustable for optimum viewing angle  Additional caller related information is  displayed with active appearances for easier call handling  The display is backlit for easier viewing in all  lighting conditions     Common Features    e Display Housing   o Backlit display   4 rows by 24 characters with adjustable display angle   o Dual position flip stand    e Fixed Buttons  15 plus Four way navigation cluster button     o Volume up down  separate volume levels for the handset  speaker  and ringer   Mute button  Speaker  button  Headset button     o Avaya Menu button  options and settings access   Telephony application button   to return to main  telephone screen     o 
389. ssociated display  labels     Speakerphone  Two way handsfree speaker and microphone    Hearing Aid Compatible  Through optional handset   Message Waiting and call log Indicator  Yes   Personalized Ring Patterns  Yes  8 ring patterns    Headset Socket  No   Embedded Applications  Navigation Cursor Control  Call signaling via LED and or ringer  Optional Add Ons  T3 Headset link for wired headsets only   Color  Graphite gray or polar white    Mounting  Desk   Adjustable Desk Stand  Display adjustable    Features for T3 Upn     Upgradeable Firmware  No    Optional Add Ons  up to 3 DSS Modules  Connect to  Digital Station  DS  port   Power Supply  From phone system     Features for T3 IP     e Upgradeable Firmware  Yes   e Optional Add Ons  up to 3 DSS Modules with AEI Headsetlink   e Power Supply  IEEE 802 3af Power over Ethernet  PoE  or individual power supply unit   e Codecs  G 711  G 729a b   e QoS Options  UDP Port Selection  DiffServ and 802 1p q  VLAN   e SNMP Support  No   e IP Address Assignment  Static or dynamic IP address assignment   e Ethernet Ports  Two port full duplex 10 100 BaseT Ethernet switch   e Auto negotiation provided separately for each port   e 802 3 Flow Control        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 66    IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        T3 DSS Expansion Modules    The T3 DSS Module is a phone expansion module that is compatible with all T3 Upn and T3 IP Telephones  except the T3 IP Compact  Each module pr
390. t   PNA Authorisation Code  0  Config    lte    Record Description    fx E911 System  1  d   IPOfice 1 System IPOffice_1 The normal SMTP server port is 25       Full Name Extn201                      The IP Office Manager operates on a local copy of the IP Office configuration file  Configurations are prepared  and reviewed    off line  before committing to the IP Office  This has the benefit of ensuring a backup copy of the  system configuration is always available for disaster recovery        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 262  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     IP Office has a built in audit trail that tracks changes to the system configuration  and who has made them   Manager can display the audit trail to assist with problem resolution  The Audit trail records the last 15  changes in the configuration and records the following elements     e Configuration Changed   For configuration changes  the log will report at a high level on all configuration  categories  users  hunt group     that have been changed     e Configuration Erased    e Configuration merged    e Reboot   user instigated reboot     e Upgrade  e Cold Start  e Warm Start    e Write at HH MM   This is when the administrator saved the configuration via the schedule option    e Write with Immediate Reboot    e Write with Reboot When Free    ES  IPOffice Audit Trail          Date And Time Of Access    30 March 2006 12 41 24  30 March 2006 12 45 41  30 March 2006 12 47 43  03
391. t Manage Tools Config Window Help    4a S O Q D  BO 2   SIM sen          HA    192 168 44    i  amp  192 168 44 255    Client            IP_Office_403 sun    IP_Office_403 192 168 44 255  92 168 44       For Help  press F1 localhost  Administrator Supervisor YW    On customer sites where SNMP management is not available  IP Office can email events using up to 3 email  addresses each containing a different set of alarms  The following system event categories can be chosen for  email notification  if installed on the system        e Generic   e Trunk lines   e Embedded Messaging Card  e VCM   e Expansion modules   e Applications   e License   e Phone change    e CSU Loop Back    IP Office sends email notifications directly to the email server  no additional PC client is needed        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 266  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        CDR       For IP Office customers that want to capture simple call details  the system can output Call Detail Records   CDR  to a designated IP address and port  The records that can be included by IP Office CDR output are listed    below     Date Records    A date record is sent each time a CDR connection is started and then once a day  at midnight   The date  can be in month day or day month format  as selected on the System   CDR SMDR tab     Call Detail Records    Call detail records are sent at the termination of a call  in 5 second increments   For some formats   additional fields c
392. t New Next Active Next Processed       State DateTime  CLI  Name Brochure   Address     eq  New     19 04 2004 203   EE 00 02    14 02           New x  19 04 2004  E 14 10 203   Sf 00 04   Ki 00 04   SE 00 02       N g     i   New z   19 04 2004 F 00 02   W 00 01   SE 00 01    14 13                                        E Hold CTRL while selecting multiple qualifier    Internet       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 216  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Call Recording       VoiceMail Pro also offers call recording services that allow the automatic manual recording of calls for a variety  of applications  such as for training purposes or to monitor abusive callers  As standard  recordings can be  directed to the called extension   s voicemail box or to any other mailbox for later retrieval  Alternatively   recordings can be stored in a central database for retrieval through a Web based browser by using  ContactStore for IP Office     The system administrator can select whether all calls are required to be automatically recorded or just a  selection of calls  Alternatively  calls can be manually selected for recording  If for any reasons resources are  not available then a recording may not be taken  for example all voicemail ports are busy      VoiceMail Pro provides a number of methods for triggering the recording of a call     Most of the settings and controls for automatic voice recording are accessed through the IP Office Manager  
393. t from to either be  transferred to a predefined number  to another auto attendant or to replay the greeting  The greeting for the  menu is controlled by time profiles to allow three alternative messages to be played i e  Morning  Afternoon  and Evening  These messages can be labeled and then re used in as many auto attendants as required     Please note that the IP406 V2 and IP500 embedded voicemail memory cards are identical but these are not  interchangeable with the Small Office Edition card  Only Avaya supplied memory cards with the voicemail and  auto attendant applications pre installed can be used        IP Office 4 2    Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 316  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 317  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Index       Index     A   Absence Text 105  setting 105  strings 105  Absent Text Message 153  Acceptable Delay 136  Access Point 72  182  accessing  Database Information within Call Flows 210  Email 207  Office LAN 32    Account 10  20  114  136  143  169  174  177  195   198  206  217  224  254  267  268  284    Account Activity 254  Account Code Costing Log  Outgoing 254  Account Code Log  Outgoing 254  Account Code Recording 217  Account Codes 10  114  217  254  267  284  view 177  Account Codes tab 177  Account Service Report 254  ACD 123  ACM 22 155  219  ACMRFA 219  Acquire Call 106  executing 123  waiting 123  ACSII CSV 262  Active Director
394. t is also used for call back when free and  voicemail ringback calls     This feature is supported across the IP Office Small Community Network       Personalized Ringing    In IP Office the term personalized ringing is used to refer to changing the sound or tone of a phone s ring  On  many Avaya digital phones  the ringer sound can be personalized  Changing the ringer sound does not alter  the ring sequence used for distinctive ringing  This feature is local to the telephone and not supported on all  types of telephones        Message Waiting Indication    Message waiting indication  MWI  is a method IP Office uses to set a lamp or other indication on compatible  telephones when a new message has been left for the user  either in a personal voice mailbox or in a group  mailbox or call back message  When the message has been played or acknowledged  the lamp is turned off     All Avaya digital and IP phones all have in built message waiting lamps  and the IP Office Phone Manager  application provides message waiting indication on screen    For analog phones  from IP Office 3 1 a variety of analog message waiting indication  MWI  methods are  provided  Those methods are 51V Stepped  81V  101V and Line Reversal  The MWI method must be selected  from the IP Office Manager application when configuring a system to match the properties of the analog    phones  Note that the 101V signaling is only available on IP500 Phone cards and modules plus version 2 IP400  Phone 8  16 and 30 mod
395. t user tones for the geography  These tones are generated for all IP Office  extension types  analog  digital and IP   Supported tones are   e Dial  both primary and secondary depending on geography  e Busy  e Unobtainable  e Re order  e Conferencing tone depending on geography  Caller ID  Feature  e Display of the caller   s number on incoming calls  where supplied by the service provider   e Sending of calling number on outgoing external calls   Benefit  e Confirmation and recognition of who is calling   e Storage of Caller ID numbers for return calls   e Directory name matching to Caller ID numbers   e Screen Popping customer records in compatible applications   Description  Where supplied by the service provider  the IP Office can receive and use the callers Caller ID  The Caller ID is  passed through to the answering phone or application and is included in any call log or history supported by  the phone or application  If the Caller ID matches a number in the IP Office s Directory  the matching directory  name is shown instead of the number   Where IP Office Phone Manager  or the TAPI service is used to link to database software on the users PC  it is  possible to have an automatic query performed on the supplied Caller ID and have the caller   s record in front  of the user before the call is answered   For outgoing calls the IP Office can insert a system wide Caller ID or set a flag to have Caller ID withheld  For  users with a direct dial number routed to their extens
396. te     e UMS Web Services Licenses   UMS  Unified Messaging Server  allows users to access the messages in their Voicemail Pro mailbox via  either a web browser  requires IIS on the Voicemail Pro server  or using a IMAP compatible email  application  Note that use of UMS is not supported if using IMS  see below  and vice versa  The total  number of users supported is set by adding combinations of the following licenses  Note that a license is  consumed for each user configured for UMS access    e   UMS Web Services   1 User License   PO LIC VMPRO UMS 1 USER  217880    e   UMS Web Services   5 User License  IPO LIC VMPRO UMS 5 USER  217881    e   UMS Web Services   10 User License  IPO LIC VMPRO UMS 10 USER  217882    e   UMS Web Services   20 User License  IPO LIC VMPRO UMS 20 USER  217883    e   UMS Web Services   50 User License  IPO LIC VMPRO UMS 50 USER  217884     e   VMPro Recordings Administrators License   PO LIC CONTACTSTORE RFA LIC DS  187166   Standard Voicemail Pro supports automatic and or manual call recording to specified mailboxes   This license allows it to support a 3rd party application to support the storage and administration of  call recordings  Currently the supported application for this is ContactStore for IP Office  When used  manual and or automatic records calls can be routed  along with the call details  to the  ContactStore applications database for storage and retrieval when required     e     Voicemail Pro Database Interface License   PO LIC IP
397. te via the LAN  Local Area Network   To support  small networks both Small Office Edition and IP406 incorporate a Layer 2 Ethernet switch  The Small Office  Edition supports 4 ports  with a fifth Ethernet port as a firewalled Layer 3 switch   the IP406 supports 8 ports   The IP412 and IP500 support a firewalled 2 port Layer 3 Ethernet Switch only     When computers on the LAN communicate they do not care where the destination is  they just send messages  with the address of the destination  These messages are likely to be received at all other computers on the  same network but only one   the target destination   will act on the message  Where the destination is on  another network  the router is needed to be the  gateway  to the rest of the world and find the optimum route  to send the message on to the destination  The router alleviates the need to establish and hold a call for the  duration of a communication session  when messages or IP packets are being sent between source and  destination  by automatically establishing a connection only when data is to be passed  Routers may be  connected together using WAN  Wide Area Network  links that could be point to point leased lines  managed  IP networks  Frame Relay networks or exchange lines  Central Office   The IP Office system supports all of  these types of network connections     IP400 systems have a Wide Area Network  WAN  port that can be connected to a digital leased line service  using either X 21 or V 35 interface at
398. tect any incoming fax calls and then direct the call to a predefined location  The benefit to a  business or user is that only one number is required for either voice or fax calls     The VoiceMail Pro can store the default fax location for the automatic routing of fax calls  Alternatively  with  fax tone detection at the voicemail box  each voicemail box can have a fax location number  If a voicemail box  owner has set his or her own fax number  then that number is used instead of the default fax location     Voicemail box subscribers can set their own fax number through their mailbox menus     Most fax solutions can be used in conjunction with IP Office  however the following products have been tested  and verified to operate in the above scenarios     e Equisys   Zetafax  Zetafax for Networks provides versatile network fax software solutions for small businesses  corporate  offices and distributed enterprise businesses  It enables employees to send and receive faxes at their  desktop  without the need to print fax communications  take them to a fax machine and send them  manually  Zetafax can be seamlessly integrated into market leading email systems like Exchange  allowing users to send and receive faxes directly from their Outlook client  In addition Zetafax can be  integrated with other existing applications  such as accounting or CRM systems  for fast  automated  faxing from the desktop or back office  Zetafax for networks is already used by more than 60 000  customers
399. tely turn their voicemail on or off  set their voicemail email forwarding  edit their call forwarding and  follow me numbers  Together these actions provide a comprehensive Personal Numbering service for the user  who needs to remain in contact regardless of their physical location     Users with Mobile Twinning are able to remotely activate their twinning capabilities through VoiceMail Pro call    flow   Incoming  Call    E    In the office Working from home On the road       ISDN    Mobile  Network              Diagram illustrating personal numbering       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 212  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Extended Personal Greetings       In INTUITY emulation mode  the VoiceMail Pro system has the ability to hold a number of greetings within  each user s mailbox that can be played to a caller  In addition to the standard mailbox greetings  the extended  personal greetings provide the ability to present the caller with a greeting that reflects where the call has come  from  internal or external  or why the called party is unable to take the call  A mailbox user can configure the  responses played back to the caller  based upon the reason the caller was routed to the voicemail  The  supported call states are     e Busy Engaged  The user is currently on a call and unable to accept a second call     e No Reply  The user is away from the desk and unable to take a call     e Internal  A greeting to be played to interna
400. tension     e Pick up any call ringing on another extension that is a member of the Hunt group specified     This feature is supported across the IP Office Small Community Network       Call Recording    Where IP Office has VoiceMail Pro installed it is possible to record a call and save the recording to the user   s  mailbox  a group mailbox or the voice recording library  For example  this is useful when a caller is going to  give detailed information like an address or phone number and the caller will hear a warning message or tone  that the call is being recorded in some countries  Where call recording is required for Quality Assurance  it is  possible to set the IP Office system to automatically record a percentage of calls for later review     Beginning with IP Office R4 0  any call  normal  conference  or intrusion  and any phone type  including IP   can be recorded  Where    advice of recording    needs to be played  IP Office will ignore Voicemail port licensing  if an insufficient number of voicemail channels have been licensed     Note  for IP phones  a VCM channel will be required for the duration of the recording        Telecommuter Mode    Phone Manager Pro allows the making and receiving of calls and the retrieving of voicemails from an external  phone number as if they were in the office  with Phone Manager providing the call control  The typical scenario  is the remote worker that occasionally works from home or from a hotel room     This feature also provide
401. tension number from the prompting of  VoiceMail Pro  and then in future dial the extension number  or other pre defined variables  directly  Auto   Attendant operation is also ideal where multiple languages are required  for example  Dial 1 for English  2 for  German  3 for French                   W Yoicemail Pro Client ol 101 x     File Edit Actions Administration Help    IA amp  do Mam  2 7 2      OA Bl 7 M  GE Bw AO    g Specific Start Points Modules  gt  AutoAttend    Users z  Start Point  Groups    Gl Short Codes  g Default Start Points                          Morning   Morning Greeting                Modules                ge Autodtten soc Menu    2 Transfer to Operator Prompt  Timeout   5  Next                      5 Transfer to Operator             Auto Attendant created using VoiceMail Pro Manager       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 209  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Accessing Database Information within Call Flows  IVR        VoiceMail Pro provides the ability to construct powerful interactive systems based upon DTMF telephone key  entry  This is achieved by using the flexibility provided from the built in call flow actions  As a caller passes  through any part of a defined call flow the system is capable of interacting with most third party databases  using the standards based ADO interface  ActiveX Data Objects   The system is capable of retrieving  information from a database and writing information into databases 
402. ter Display   e Two way handsfree speaker phone   e Optional wall mounting desk stand     e Connects to an IP Office DS  Digital Station  port     Note  A maximum of twenty seven 4412D telephones are supported on the IP500 DS30 expansion modules  and on IP400 DS30  version 2  expansion module at PCS level 5  Earlier IP400 DS30 expansion modules will  only support sixteen of these telephones     This phone does not support personalized ringing     This phone is not supported on the IP500 DS8 Extension Card  For the IP500 it will work on external Digital  Station Expansion Modules        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 86  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     4424D Telephone    This range of telephones is only available in North America        The 4424D supports all of the features of the 4406 with the following differences   e 24 Programmable call appearance feature keys with twin lamps   e 8 Fixed Feature Keys  Speaker  Mute  Conference  Transfer  Redial  Hold  Volume Up and Down   e 4 Display Soft Keys below the Display   e 4 Display Navigation Keys  right of the display  Menu  Previous   lt    Next   gt    and Exit   e DSS port to support 2 DSS4450 adjuncts  Auxiliary power required   e 2 x 24 character display   e Connects to an IP Office DS  Digital Station  port     Note     maximum of twenty seven 4424D telephones are supported on the IP500 DS30 expansion modules  and on IP400 DS30  version 2  expansion module at PCS level 5  Earlier I
403. the planned IP Office configuration  as follows     In order to calculate the maximum  that is worst case  amount of heat that can be generated by an IP Office  system  it is assumed that all input power is converted to heat  whether from the PSU itself  the system unit   expansion module and or cabling     Heat dissipation is normally measured in British Thermal Units  BTU s   A heat value expressed in Watts can be  converted to BTU hr by multiplying by 3 41297  As indicated above  you should use the maximum power input  of 115 VA of each power supply to calculate this most accurately     Using the conversion factor     e Heat Dissipation   115 x 3 41297   392 5 BTU hour     The metric equivalent to BTU is a Joule where 1 BTU   1 055 Joules     This calculates the BTU value per power supply  The maximum BTU per system is therefore calculated  based  on total number of power supplies installed in the system  For example  for a IP412  this would be 1 for the  base unit and up to 12 for the expansion modules     e IP412 Maximum Heat Dissipation   13 x 392 5   5 103 BTU hr     Remember to budget for the power requirements of any additional devices that are to be co located with the  IP Office such as server PC s  voicemail  etc      Power Supply  e Input    e Small Office Edition  2 5mm DC inlet socket  24Vdc power input  Rating 24V DC  1 8A maximum     e IP406 V2  IP412 and expansion modules  2 5mm DC inlet socket  24Vdc power input  Rating  24V DC  2A maximum     e IP Office 5
404. they require a quality telephone   they rarely handle large amount of calls at the same time  Cubicle workers and sales staff are examples  of Everyday users for whom the 1608 delivers a productivity enhancing telephone     e The Avaya 1616 IP Telephone is designed for the Receptionist Assistant user  Receptionists  secretaries   and managers are examples of this type of user   people who answer incoming calls  transfer  customers to different departments or extensions  and monitor several line appearances throughout a  typical day  For the Receptionist Assistant user  the 1616 provides the most one touch  line feature speed dial buttons without the need to scroll through on screen lists     All 1600 phones share a consistent design line and feature a button centric layout  With fast access to all  needed features like hold  transfer and conference  easily readable back lit displays and a stylish design  they  are an important addition to the Avaya portfolio of phones for the Small and Medium market     All phones share a number of feature keys with clear  paper labels  On the 1608 and 1616  features are also  available through a feature list on screen that makes selecting features and line appearances easy even when  hotdesking to another phone     The phones are accompanied by a complete set of accessories like cost efficient power supplies  easy to use  paper labels and spare parts  For powering options refer to the section Power Options for IP Telephones  133     For easy
405. tible with Microsoft LCS 2003 and 2005  No additional license is required in IP Office        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 182  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 183  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Chapter 9   SoftConsole       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 184  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     9  SoftConsole    SoftConsole is the PC based Windows Operator Console for IP Office  SoftConsole has been designed to  improve operator service by providing the operator with call information and available call actions to simplify  call handling and give the appropriate response to the caller  With this easy to use software tool the operator  can maintain visibility of the number and type of calls waiting and so ensure that clients are greeted in a  professional manner  SoftConsole has a similar look and feel to the Phone Manger application and can be  minimized in the Windows system tray when not in use  but will pop up on the screen when a call is received               AVAYA                                                    Title Bar   IP Office SoftConsole   Anne Webb  Menu Bar  Tool Bar   Call Information  Calling Name  May Spring  Call Details Calling Number  208 L Abbey Nortin  Called Name  Anne Webb     A Webb  Called Number  209 i sa ten  Call Status  Alerting   l     Directory g A Barry Smith  Queue Panel  Held Call   
406. time profile could be set up to make  Internet Access available to staff only during lunch times  Using time profiles it is also possible to define an  alternative service to operate outside the operational hours of the main service  This may be used to take  advantage of alternative tariffs at off peak periods  Switching to this fallback service can also be controlled  manually by dialing a secure short code from a handset  This can be particularly useful in allowing quick  restoration of service in the event of an ISP failure  This feature also applies to days of the week or specific  calendar dates        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 166  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Password Authentication Protocol  PAP     PAP is a method of authenticating the remote end of a connection using unencrypted passwords        Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol  CHAP     Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol allows an incoming data call to be authenticated using encrypted  passwords  The system also provides the option to periodically reaffirm the authenticity of the caller during the  data call        Data Header Compression    IP Header Compression  IPHC  reduces the header size of the data packet to gain bandwidth efficiency over  Wide Area Networks  but adds to transmission latency        Data Compression    IP Office supports both Microsoft Point to Point Compression and Stac Lemple Ziv to provide greater  throughput on slow 
407. tion    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 188  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     e Park Slot Panel    e Call History    The park slot panel can contain up to 16 system wide park slots with specific Park ID s for each slot     SoftConsole s call history keeps a combined record of up to 100  incoming  outgoing and missed  calls  while the application is active Double clicking any logged call dials that number           l               gt      l   gt               206  210  209  209  206  206  206  209  210    Status Bar    Theresa Green  Paul Jones  Anne Webb  Anne Webb  Theresa Green  Theresa Green  Theresa Green  Anne Webb  Paul Jones    ES RE aa PROMS ee ane Wace ese   Fag    Anne Webb  Anne Webb   4nne Webb    Anne Webb  Anne Webb  Anne Webb  May Spring   Anne Webb       Date  amp  Time   1910 2006 15 12 01  1940 2006 15 12 24  1940 2006 15 12 50  1940 2006 15 14 33  20 40 2006 08 53 50  20 10 2006 08 55 09  20 10 2006 08 56 07  20 10 2006 09 06 28  20 10 2006 09 14 26    This Shows current status of the system and is divided into four sections that display current connection  status  current Profile name  information messages and The number of new voice mail messages for the  operator  Information messages include any alarm conditions that are present within the system        Product Description    IP Office 4 2       2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     Page 189  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        SoftConsole Options       SoftConsole has many configurable option
408. tly to the associated phone     e Requires an Avaya 1151 series power supply  even for IP phones already using Power over Ethernet     PoE      e IP Office supports a maximum of eight EU24 EU24 BL s on each IP Office system     402 5402  410 5410  420 5420  601 5601    602 5602  610 5610  620 5620  621 5621    BIATATATAISINININ ES  D     D  s T   gt   0  3  D          Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved     IP Office 4 2    Page 62  Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        T3 Telephone Range       The T3 range of digital Upn and IP telephones provide European style with context sensitive displays and are  available in select European countries only        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 63  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        T3 Compact       Common Features     Display  1 line with 24 characters alphanumerical plus one line icons  Fixed Feature Buttons  3 keys with printed text labels and 2 for Audio Volume control    Programmable Feature Buttons  3 keys with indicators and printed text labels  2 keys with printed  text labels    Speakerphone  Full duplex handsfree speaker and microphone   Hearing Aid Compatible  Through optional handset   Message Waiting and call log Indicator  Yes   Personalized Ring Patterns  Yes  8 ring patterns    Embedded Applications  Navigation Cursor Control  Call signaling via LED and or ringer   Alphanumeric entry via dialing keypad     Color  Graphite gray or polar white   Mounting  Desk or optiona
409. to take advantage  of VoIP transmissions  It is important to distinguish between basic compliance with the minimal VoIP standards  and validated support for QoS which is needed to run VoIP applications over a data network     With the exception of standalone configurations where IP phones connect directly connected to the ports on IP  Office  Avaya now requires that all customers formally audit their networks for IP telephony readiness before  attempting to install any VoIP application     A network assessment should normally include     e Physical inventory of all equipment inclusive of the current version of code  and configurations as  needed     e An accurate and complete network topology for all networked sites  inclusive of IP addressing and  physical logical connections     e An evaluation of the network s topology to check that the design is both sound and reasonable     e Measurement of packet loss  jitter and delay over the course of multiple days and measured on a per  minute basis  A graphical representation of the data is the preferred output method     e Examination of QoS Class of Service  CoS  parameters in place in the network     e Summary of findings and possible actions to correct problems     The assessment should leave you confident that the implemented network will have the capacity for the  foreseen data and voice traffic  and can support H 323  DHCP  TFTP  and jitter buffers in H 323 applications     With this in mind  if you require support during or
410. tocol  SIP         Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 138  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 139  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Chapter 6   Public and Private Voice  Networks       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 140  P Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     6  Public and Private Voice Networks    With Avaya IP Office you can be networked via T1  PRI and BRI ISDN  including VoIP on the company WAN   Networking maximizes the current potential of your branch maximizes the current potential of your branch  office and remote workers   while building the office and remote workers   while building the best possible  foundation for your future growth  IP Office provides each location with a scalable  up to 360 users  telephony  solution that supports voice networking  and offers     e A uniform dialing plan  making it easy to call co workers anywhere on the network and improve  customer service    e Consistent user experience by sharing the same phones and messaging interface as in headquarters  e A user defined central directory that is automatically synchronized  e Least cost routing and bandwidth on demand    e Centralized voicemail and or the ability to network voicemail systems together    The benefits of networking     e Operate a network of branch offices with a consistent set of communications and services across all  locations  gain t
411. trol     e QoS Options  UDP Port Selection  DiffServ and 802 1p q  VLAN    e SNMP Support  Yes   e IP Address Assignment  Static or dynamic IP address assignment     e Ethernet Ports  Single Ethernet  10 100  line interface     Language Support     e Supports the following languages  English  French  Spanish  German  Italian  Dutch  Portuguese and Russian   English and 4 of the other languages at once in the phone        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 49  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     1608 IP Telephone    Communication  Manager          The Avaya 1608 supports 8 line appearances   feature keys  Each of the buttons includes dual LEDs  red   green  providing explicit status for the user  For a familiar look and feel  the 1608 includes several fixed  feature keys for common telephone tasks including conference  transfer  drop  hold  and mute  In addition  the  1608 includes a high quality two way speakerphone  and supports a broad portfolio of Avaya wired and  wireless headsets through its integrated headset jack     The 1608 features a context sensitive user interface along with three softkeys and a four way navigation  cluster   ideal for scrolling through the local contacts list or call logs  The display on the 1608 measures three  lines by 24 characters and is backlit for easier viewing in all lighting conditions     Common Features    e Display Housing   o Backlit display   3 5    diagonal  3 rows by 24 characters   o Dual position
412. ts End User a license within the scope of the license types described below  The applicable number of licenses and  units of capacity for which the license is granted will be one  1   unless a different number of licenses or units of capacity is  specified in the Documentation or other materials available to End User     Designated Processor    means a single stand alone  computing device     Server    means a Designated Processor that hosts a software application to be accessed by multiple users      Software    means the computer programs in object code  originally licensed by Avaya and ultimately utilized by End User    whether as stand alone Products or pre installed on Hardware     Hardware    means the standard hardware Products  originally  sold by Avaya and ultimately utilized by End User    License Type s   Designated System s  License  DS     End User may install and use each copy of the Software on only one Designated Processor  unless a different number of  Designated Processors is indicated in the Documentation or other materials available to End User  Avaya may require the  Designated Processor s  to be identified by type  serial number  feature key  location or other specific designation  or to be  provided by End User to Avaya through electronic means established by Avaya specifically for this purpose    Copyright   Except where expressly stated otherwise  the Product is protected by copyright and other laws respecting proprietary rights   Unauthorized reprodu
413. tworking with Other Avaya Products       IP Office will support the most appropriate way for communication with any other existing PBX s in a customer  network  whether TDM or IP based  With Avaya DEFINITY  MultiVantage  Avaya Integral Enterprise or Avaya  Communication Manager  ACM   the protocols used will be QSIG or H 323 over T1  E1 or IP links    VoIP networking using H 323    IP Office  since release 1 1 in US and release 1 2 in EMEA  has been successfully tested to be interoperable  over IP trunks with DEFINITY G3si  release 10  and IP600  release 9 5   The protocol supported is H 323 using  industry standard compression codecs  types G 711A  G 711MU  G 729A and G 723 1 6K3   The features  currently supported are as follows     e Desk to desk dialing  basic voice call   e Calling Connected Party ID number   e Calling Connected Name Presentation  e Call Hold    e Call Transfer       IP Office    Communication    Manager    These features allow for simple networking needs between IP Office remote branches to a DEFINITY ACM at  the main site     QSIG networking using T1 E1 links  TDM     Alternatively QSIG may be favored as the chosen signaling standard within multiple vendor environments and  provides the following supplementary services which are also available between IP Office and DEFINITY    MultiVantage  155  ACM  equipped with the relevant RFA licenses         Integral  Communication 55  Manager    IP Office    e Simple Telephony Call Basic call  ETS 300 171 172   
414. ual team  performance  Data is retrieved from the database  which provides a source of data limited only by the hard  disk space available  SQL only   These standard report templates may be formatted by the user to provide  reports daily  weekly  monthly  or any defined time period and by individual  group  or trunk  CCC uses Crystal  Reports    format  which provides ease of use and thin client operation for reporting     Standard Reports List  e Account Code Log by Agent Group  Graphical   e Account Code Log by Agent Group  e Account Code Log by DDI  Graphical    e Account Code Log by DDI   e Account Code Log by Pilot  Graphical   e Account Code Log by Pilot   e Account Code Log by Target  Graphical    e Account Code Log by Target   e Agent Activity Trace   e Agent Activity  e Agent Callback Request   e Agent Group Busy Status   e Agent Group Graphical Summary  All Calls    e Agent Group Graphical Summary     e Agent Group Member Call Duration Report  All  Calls      e Agent Group Member Duration    e Agent Group Tabular Summary  All Calls    e Agent Group Tabular Summary    e Agent Group Tabular    e Agent Individual    e Agent Tabular    e Customer Tracking by Call Identifier   e Customer Tracking by CLI    e DDI Call Duration    e DDI Distribution by Target    e DDI Distribution   e DDI Response   e DDI Routing   e DDI Summary     e External Transferred Account Code     Report Scheduler    Incoming Duration Summary    Incoming Pilot Summary    Lost Call CLI    Outgoing A
415. ules  not on the IP406 system unit        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 103  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Visual Voice    Feature    e Provides interface to voicemail through handset display and buttons e g  Listen  Save  Delete  Fast  Forward     Benefit    e Quick access to voicemails and commonly used messaging features     Description    With IP Office R4 0  you can now access and control voice messages via the display on Digital or IP phones   Visual Voice requires VoiceMail Pro or Embedded Messaging  and can be used with large display LCD sets only   1608  1616  2410  2420  5410  5420  4610  4620  4621  4625  5610  5620  and 5621 phones plus all T3  phones are supported      From release 4 2  the fixed message button on certain phones can be configured to invoke visual voice  This  configurable option frees the button programming required currently for Visual Voice     Features supported are   e access new old saved messages for personal and hunt group mailboxes   e next and previous message   e fast forward and rewind   e pause message   e save  delete and copy message to other users of the system   e change default greeting   e change password     e change email settings  VoiceMail Pro only      Note  Visual Voice is NOT available on VoiceMail Lite        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 104  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Advanced Call Handling       Description   In larger bus
416. und in Compact Contact Center  CCC      Note  on the IP500  VoiceMail Pro is only supported after upgrading to IP Office Professional Edition        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 202    IP Office 4 2    Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Interaction of Voicemail with Email Systems       As standard  VoiceMail Lite and Pro allow for a simple voicemail alert where the entire voicemail is forwarded   copied  as a  WAV attachment to any MAPI or SMTP compliant Email application   Microsoft Outlook   Exchange  Lotus Notes  etc   Forwarding allows emails and voicemail messages to be unified and collected  from a single source  This simple alert option that forwards only the caller   s number in the subject of the  email  and is ideal for use with commercial Short Message System  SMS  or paging services whereby this  information can be forwarded to the display on a Mobile Cell Phone or Pager when the user is away from the  desk  This email notification  forwarding and copying  can be done for all voice messages and can be activated  remotely  This is beneficial if you are working from home and have an email connection available          Incoming    Call SMS alert on GSM    VoiceMail Pro    Listen to email   requires Text to Speech license        Email alert   message  at home or on the road    Oe       Picks up the call  on no answer    In the office      LED on the phone    Alert on Phone Manager    Email notification  Forwarding voicemail to email is one
417. unt Codes tab  Users can easily activate Account codes  before or during the call  through the  Account Codes  tab  This  tags calls with an alphanumeric account code via a single click  Note  Lite users can enter account codes  but cannot view the Account Codes tab     e Queue monitoring  Queue monitoring allows the user to see the number of calls waiting in up to 2 queues  The Phone  Manager Pro user does not need to be part of the hunt groups being monitored        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 178  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     e Door entry control  Door entry control allows the user to open or close the two external relays in the IP Office system  This  can be used to activate an external system such as door entry or security camera     I  Messages  1  Account Codes Speed Dials       e Call History  Phone Manager Pro provides separate tabs for Incoming  Outgoing  Missed and All Calls  Each call log  tab will store the last 100 entries which can be sorted by date and time  caller ID and call duration if  required        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 179  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Phone Manager PC Softphone  IP Softphone     Phone Manager PC Softphone is licensed on a per user basis and provides all of the Phone Manager Pro  functionality  In PC Softphone mode  both audio and call control operations are handled on the PC so no  additional telephone is needed  When using PC Softph
418. up number the same as the digits supplied from the network  but IP Office can convert the  number to what ever number is needed by the business  within limits    In North America  T1 circuits are required for DID        Transfer    Call Transfer allows users to transfer a call in progress to another phone number   either internal extension or  external public number  The caller is placed on hold while the transfer is performed     If the phone is put down before the destination has answered  the original caller will be automatically  transferred  This is called an Unsupervised or Blind Transfer  Alternatively  a user can wait for the destination  to be answered and announce the transfer before hanging up to complete the transfer  This is called a  Supervised Transfer     Unless restricted by the system administrator  the IP Office makes no differentiation between internal or  external call transfers        Distinctive and Personalized Ringing    The IP Office uses different ringing sequences to indicate the type of call  for example whether internal or  external  This feature is called    distinctive ringing     For analog phones the distinctive ringing sequences used  are adjustable  For digital and IP phones the distinctive ringing sequences are fixed as follows     e Internal Call  Repeated single ring   e External Call  Repeated double ring     e Ringback Call  Single ring followed by two short rings     This ring is used for calls returning from park  hold or transfer  I
419. urrent versions of documentation  go to the Avaya Support web site  http  Awww avaya com support  or the IP  Office Knowledge Base  http   marketingtools avaya com knowledgebase      Avaya Support   Avaya provides a telephone number for you to use to report problems or to ask questions about your contact center  The  support telephone number is 1 800 242 2121 in the United States  For additional support telephone numbers  see the Avaya  Web site  http   www avaya com support        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 2  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Contents          Session Initiation Protocol  SIP     147  Contents Packet Based Voice Networking    150  1  Introduction Supplementary Services within IP Networks             152  Avaya IP Office Family    ai SIS OINA NEDMOUAING sities 158        Internetworking with Other Avaya Products              155  What s New in IP Office 4 2    10 c Networking Feat 158  Voice Communication Solution Features    ne e AES ca  Data Communication Solution Features    19 7  Data Networking Services  Applications Platform Features    20 LAN WAN Services    162  Management Tools    eser rer reserse eee 21 internet ACCESS  deacra sn a late nace near ages 162  Scalable Platform    nanana nannan nnnnenenne 21 Remote Access Features    164  Telephone Options    22 LAN to LAN Routing                                              164  Application and Feature Licensing    22 Data Networking Features    165  2  IP Of
420. utomated  leaving agents free to deal with other more complex calls  which require human interaction  A definable sequence of recordings are played to the caller with time in  between each recording to allow the capture of the caller s spoken answers and or the caller s key presses via  DTMF  At the end of the transaction the caller can be thanked and the completed transaction retrieved by an  agent via a web interface or a short code     Campaign Manager allows calls in queue to break out of the queue  or be directed in an overflow situation to   complete their transactions thereby increasing customer satisfaction by effecting an answer to their call  This   ensures that a minimum of customers give up when forced to wait in a queue or even worse  hear a recorded  message stating that they are calling outside of office hours     In a Contact Center environment  when agents are busy  an overflow to Campaign Manager relieves  congestion and pressure on agent groups  An agent can collect the completed transaction via a web browser or  via a short code representing the park slot number of a particular campaign  This number can be pre   programmed under a DSS key and used by agents to access the campaign  If the DSS key incorporates a BLF  lamp  that lamp is lit when new campaign messages have been left  Agents then transcribe the caller s  answers into a database or other records           Campaign Web Interface   Microsoft Internet Explorer      gt     Test    bob jones      Nex
421. ver specifications are as follows     e IP Office Customer Call Reporter server  Intel Pentium D 945 core AMD Athlon 64 4000    with 2GB RAM and 30 GB free hard disk space  Note   The IP Office Customer Call Reporter server can co reside with a VoiceMail Pro of less than 17 ports        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 244  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     IP Office Customer Call Reporter Client Components  The client application consists of a secure thin client web browser session to the IP Office Customer Call  Reporter server that will provide the Supervisor or Agent with a complete view of the Call Center     The following web browsers will be supported as thin clients on a Windows OS   e Microsoft Internet Explorer 7 and above  Internet Explorer 8 recommended   e Mozilla Firefox  version 3 0 and above     e Windows Safari 3 1 and above     IP Office Customer Call Reporter Database   The database has been designed to provide a simple table schema  The database is a Microsoft SQL Server  2005 instance and the IP Office Customer Call Reporter will be packaged with the Microsoft SQL Server 2005  Express edition  It is recommended that any call center that predicts high call usage should understand the  imposed limitations of Microsoft SQL 2005 Express edition and consider using the full version of Microsoft SQL  2005  Microsoft SQL 2000 and 2008 are not supported     The database is a    pre requisite    that must be installed prior to t
422. vice to each  of the clients     IP Office Customer Call Reporter Concept   IP Office Customer Call Reporter is Avaya   s new server based contact center product designed explicitly for  small businesses  Drawing upon the latest web and design technologies the IP Office Customer Call Reporter  introduces significant new capabilities to effectively and efficiently manage a multi site call center  environment  The product focus is on ease of use and deployment simplicity to ensure improved ongoing  productivity and lower support costs     In its native web server environment the IP Office Customer Call Reporter can be simply installed onto a single  server without the need for any client software deployment  Administration and management of the call center  is carried out via a thin client through a secure password protected web browser session     IP Office Customer Call Reporter Key Features  e Real time Call Center activity monitor and historical reporting     e Microsoft server based with thin client  web browser  client connections    e Simplified installation and maintenance    e Six reporting templates provide drag and drop and user defined filter functionality   e Three customizable Supervisor views and summarized Agent views    e Report Scheduler    e Multi lingual capable    e Supports up to 30 Supervisors and 150 Agents    e IP Office 4 2  platform support     IP Office Customer Call Reporter Business Benefits  e Lower TCO  IP Office Customer Call Reporter provides s
423. voice compression channel is required for each        Direct Media    is a VoIP concept that circumvents resources  TDM bus  Gateway  within the system and  improves the voice quality  If two IP devices are connected on the same system  a direct LAN connection  between them will be established once the call has been set up  as long as they use the same Codecs      It is possible for an IP device to be physically located at one site while being registered at a different site  In  this case  even for VoIP across the WAN the VCM would not be used  as long as the two IP devices involved in  a phone call are registered on the same system        Data Channels    A Data Channel is only required for Remote Access  RAS   Internet Access  and Voicemail connections     e 10 PCs accessing the Internet over a single line   1 Data Channel  If multiple lines are used  Multi Link  PPP  then as many data channels are required  e g  128k i e  2B channels requires 2 data channels     e 10 users dialing in from home on 10 separate lines onto the LAN   10 Data Channels    e Voicemail is an IP application on the LAN  i e  one data channel is required for each voicemail port used     Note  IP end points do NOT require data channels       Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 135  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Bandwidth Required For Each Voice Call     The bandwidth used varies depending on the compression method chosen  IP Office supports a wide range of  comp
424. w control is used on Avaya IP telephones operating in full duplex mode  If the receiving device  becomes congested  it sends a pause frame to the transmitting device  The pause frame instructs the  transmitting device to stop sending packets for a specific period of time  The transmitting device waits the  requested time before sending more data        VoIP Standards Supported    IP Office supports the following protocols and standards   e H 323 V2  1998   Packet based multimedia communications systems   e Q 931  ISDN user network interface layer 3 specification for basic call control     e H 225 0  1998   Call signaling protocols and media stream packetization for packet based multimedia  communication systems     e H 245  1998   Control protocol for multimedia communication   e Session Initiation Protocol   e Audio CODECs   e G 711 A law U law   e G 723 1 MP MLQ   e G 729 Annex A   CS ACELP   e Silence Suppression   e Fax Relay  IP Office to IP Office Fax Transport over IP    e Local End Echo Cancellation 25ms   e Out of band DTMF   e Jitter buffer  5 frames of jitter buffer   e Internet Standards Specification  in addition to TCP UDP IP    e RFC 1889   RTP RTCP  Real Time and Real Time Control Protocol   e RFC 2507  2508  2509   Header Compression   e RFC 2474   DiffServ  Type of Service field configurable   e RFC 1990   PPP Fragmentation   e RFC 1490   Encapsulation for Frame Relay   e RFC 2686   Multiclass Extensions to Multilink PPP   e RFC 3261   Session Initiation Pro
425. wed Calls     lt           gt 1 99     Overflowed Calls Waiting    lt         gt 1 999    Queue State Time                gt 1 600    Routed to Other    lt 4      lt     gt 1 99    Routed to Voicemail    lt     lt     gt 1 999    Transferred O CO 7   1000    QIS SIS  4  6  LA LAS LAS ES LS         LA EN LA    Is         ide       Agent View  PC Wallboard    In Small Business Contact Center  the Agent view is part of the agent reporting license  every licensed agent  will be able to run their own view  An Agent is able to login via a thin client web browser session and associate  with a Supervisor  The Agent view also displays any alarms that have been set by the Supervisor and is  featured to act as a PC Wallboard display                                   Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 250  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Call Statistics    The Small Business Contact Center provides detailed statistics to help small businesses understand exactly  where a call has been within the business  Statistics are measured against  also refer to the table below      e Queues  Points in the call center where a queue forms such as Hunt Groups     e Agents  Individuals that are members of queue groups who answer the calls     Statistic Full Name Available for   Call Typel11   Warning    Include Overflow    Queue   Agent Ext     Agent State  Queue      7       None      4     Answered Internal  Queue    4   74     Average Answer     OY   7     Ave
426. while talking  you will find a solution that suits your individual needs        To view the full range of Avaya headsets     1  Go to http   www  avaya com gcm master usa en us headsets index htm        2  Identify the IP Office telephone you are using   3  Choose an amplifier based on compatibility and features     4  Choose the style of headset that best suits your needs  For instance  noise canceling headsets are great  in a busy office or when using VoIP telephones        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 97  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Summar    y       All Avaya telephones are designed to ensure that features and functions are easily accessible to the user    ensuring that  through ease of use  the full benefits of the system are delivered to the desktop     The telephones listed below are the preferred and premier range of telephones for use on the IP Office  These  telephones are sold worldwide in every country that the IP Office is available  This telephone range consists of  both digital and IP telephones     IP Office worldwide digital phones  IP Office worldwide IP phones     e 5402 Telephone 5    e 5410 Telephone 5    e 5420 Telephone  605       5602SW IP Telephone  5610SW IP Telephone       5621 IP Telephone    1603 IP Telephone  474    1608 IP Telephone  47   1616 IP Telephone  474          60        56A   584    In addition to the telephones above  the IP Office supports a wide range of phones as listed below  Howev
427. wire   or circuit   while the call is in  progress  Because the circuit is exclusive to each conversation  PSTN and private branch exchanges  PBXs   must be sized to cope with peak demand and have enough circuits available for all expected conversations   This is not a flexible approach and results in a lot of infrastructure investment that the telephone companies  need to recoup  via the cost of access charges and calls  The Internet has changed this   where data services  have driven down access charges and allowed voice to    travel for free    over a multipurpose data network     Packet Switched Telephony    Unlike circuit switched connections  which always require use of dedicated bi directional circuit for the duration  of a call  VoIP technology has enabled telephony and other new and novel features and services to run over  fixed and wireless networks including private local area networks  These newer network types use packet   switched protocols  Packet switched VoIP puts voice signals into packets  Along with the voice signals  VoIP  packets include both the sender   s and receiver   s network addresses  VoIP packets can traverse any VoIP   compatible network  Along the way  they can choose alternate  shared paths because the destination address  is included in the packet  The routing of the packets is not dependent on any particular network route which  means the network provides can provide a reliable service at a fraction of the cost of circuit switched  provider
428. with  Avaya  With solutions like IP Office  we   re revolutionizing how small and medium businesses communicate   Now is the time to see what an Avaya solution can do for your business     Reduce monthly costs  Now     IP Office will help you lower the cost of communications  with capabilities like conferencing  making calls over  a managed Internet service  Voice over IP  and the    all in one    benefits of a converged communications  system     Leave the office  Be accessible     With easy  flexible options for call message forwarding and one number reachability  IP Office keeps everyone  in touch  Get the freedom to go where you want and never miss important business calls        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 6  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009     Serve better  Sell more     IP Office can give you a customer sales and service center designed for your needs and your budget   with all  the routing and reporting capabilities you need  Deliver the personal service that builds sales and loyalty     Get connected     Talk to your Avaya BusinessPartner  Discuss where you want communications to add value to your business   Learn about the different service and support options that are available  See why thousands of growing  businesses rely on the innovative Avaya IP Office solution     The right choice for you and your business     How we communicate is a personal choice   it has to match the needs of your business  And your needs  change de
429. ws an engineer to select which protocols and interfaces are to be monitored and  decoded  The trace can either be captured directly to screen or as a log file for later analysis  Traces from  different protocols can be color coded to improve the clarity of large log files  In addition to monitoring  the  application captures system alarms and will display an activity log of the last 20 alarms that have occurred      1  SysMonitor v5 2  148321    monitoring 192 168 42 1  00F007020B83     Sal lei xl ie    Ethe    LDAP   PPP   R2   Routing   SNMP   System   T1   VComp   VPN   WAN    ATM Cal   DTE   EConf   Frame Relay   GOD   H 323   Interface   ISDN   Key Lamp      4156189291 Code 0x10      35378m   Events Packets    l Call l Call I Call Detail Records H Oxaaal  V Call Delta M Extension Send ja 4156189291 Code 0x18    V Call Logging M Extension Receive    J    Extension  Extension TxC z  35503n    Basic colors     J    Extension Cut  Extension RxC Hl TEE EEr  I Line Extension TxP ELLE  FN Map Extension RxP ELLE  M MonCM Line Send LR  M MonlVR Line Receive EE EE EEE g   FN Targetting I Short Code Msgs   M IP Dect I IP Dect Tx Extn    3999203    Custom colors   4036603 t TP DectFix Extn BEE EEE Ee I   g IP Dect Tx Line ER    IP Dect Rx Line    Define Custom Colors  gt  gt   Trace Colour  i  40522n      Default All   Clear All   Tab Clear All   Tab Set All   OK   Cancel    IP Header info   Dst 192 168 42 1 Srce 192 168 42 203 vl 0x45 tos 0x00 len 40 id 0xaaa5  ttl 128 flg 0x02 off
430. xporting capabilities into applications     Report Design Solutions    e Professional Edition   For report creation and maintenance based on a large variety of data sources plus  out of the box web report delivery for workgroups     e Standard Edition   For basic report design based on PC based data sources     The chart below illustrates some of the key feature differences between the various Crystal Reports 9 editions              DATA CONNECTIVITY O O O     PC based and Microsoft   ODBC OLE DB for MS Access and SQL Server           XML         OLAP e    ee  Enterprise database servers  ODBC  native        ee  Custom  user defined data through JavaBeans     ADO   NET and COM o     DATA CONNECTIVITY O 80     visual report designer for rapid data access and formatting            Customizable templates for faster  more consistent formatting o O    ee  Repository for reusing common report objects across multiple reports       ee  WEB REPORT DELIVERY      O Q  Crystal Enterprise Express for rapid web report delivery      Introductory workgroup offer   APPLICATION INTEGRATION O        Q  Report viewing APIs  Java   NET and COM SDKs  e     Report creation APIs  Java   NET and COM SDKs  for end user report    creation and modification at runtime   CU ICEUCLEE Custom Java Tag Library for easy customization of the end user report Qo g   bi NES viewing experience  APPLICATION DEPLOYMENT       O Q  Crystal Reports Java   NET and COM reporting components for o    embedded report viewing
431. y 206  ActiveX Data Objects 210  Add Update Conference Participants 233  Additional ISDN 143  Additionally Music On Hold 233  addressing  Domain Name Service 165  voicemails 220  admin 209  268  Admin portion 268  Administration 6  46  118  141  174  191  206  Administrator 10  20  106  119  177  209  210  211   215  218  233  262  269  Change 191  ADMM_ 69  ADO 210  Advanced Small Community 121  153  Advanced Small Community Networking  Advice Of Charge 143  174  181  Alarm Calls 220  Alarm Handling 253  Alarm Reporter 252    121  153    Alert 56  58  60  69  82  107  112  113  120  131   174  177  185  203  261  User 10  124  ALG 147  Algorithmic Delay 136    All Calls 10  113  177  252   All in one 6  21   allocated 165  168  198  232  233  268  User Rights 115   Alpha 65   Alphabetic Keystrokes 190   Alphanumeric 64  75  91  177  220    Alphanumeric Data Collection 220  Alternate Call Routing 18  Alternate Route Selection  Analog 16 21  287  Analog 16 Module 287  Analog Extensions 10  27  41  94  107  124  analog lines 231  278  279   Analog Phone 21  22  30  114  125  129  287  290  Analog Phone Ports 290   Analog Telephone Features 90   Analog Telephones 41  90  98  125  131   Analog Telephones POTS 89   Analog Trunk 16 273   Analog Trunk 16 EU 273   Analog Trunk 16 NZ 273   Analog Trunk 16 port 143   Analog Trunk Module 25  32   Analog Trunk Module 16 25  32   Analog Trunk Ports 290   Analog Trunk Restriction 231    Analog Trunks 25  30  32  34  115  143  158  164   23
432. y Language scripts  SQL   An  administrator can enter SQL script directly into the specific section of the Database Execute action  For  administrators that are not familiar with SQL scripts  a script can be created automatically through the use of a  SQL Query Builder Wizard        Product Description    2009 AVAYA All rights reserved  Page 210  IP Office 4 2 Issue 18 s    22 May 2009        Using Text To Speech  TTS  Facilities within a Call Flow    A Text To Speech  TTS  engine can be added to further enhance IP Office IVR capabilities  TTS facilities can  enhance the callers experience by allowing the system to read back to them any information that has been  extracted from a database  For example  in a Book Shop  the caller dials into the system and is asked for an  ISBN number of the book they require  The caller enters the ISBN through the telephone keypad and the  system locates the title of the book from the database  As well as finding the title  the system could also look  up the author of the book and whether there were any books in stock  By using TTS  the system could now  respond to the call         The book  Lord Of The Rings  costing  6 99  written by J R R Tolkien is in stock      The languages currently supported by the Avaya TTS engine are     e Chinese  Mandarin  e Italian   e Dutch e Korean   e English  UK  e Norwegian   e English  US  e Portuguese  Brazilian   e French  Standard  e Russian   e German e Spanish   e Japanese e Spanish  Latin     TTS Licen
    
Download Pdf Manuals
 
 
    
Related Search
    
Related Contents
ViewSonic VFA724W User's Manual  Method of displaying manufacturer/model code and programmable  Samsung YP-F2J User's Manual  ダウンロード(PDF 1.3MB)  Avaya BCM 2.0 TSP Server Configuration Guide  取扱説明書 WHISPERマスフローメーター  USER MANUAL Brushless Speed Controller  iMS-1 Music Stand Clip for Apple iPad User Manual      Copyright © All rights reserved. 
   Failed to retrieve file